alums parameter dictionary_telecomb10

1176
Alcatel-Lucent GSM Telecom Parameters Dictionary OMC Document Reference Guide Release B10 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Upload: dilip-nayak

Post on 26-Mar-2015

231 views

Category:

Documents


0 download

TRANSCRIPT

Page 1: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

Alcatel-Lucent GSM

Telecom Parameters Dictionary

OMC Document

Reference Guide

Release B10

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 2: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

Status RELEASED

Short title

All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, useand communication of its contents not permitted without writtenauthorization from Alcatel-Lucent.

BLANK PAGE BREAK

2 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 3: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

Contents

Contents

Preface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5

1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71.1 Parameter Classification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81.2 Parameter Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9

2.1 Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393.1 Network (CDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403.2 Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51

4 GSM Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 734.1 Network (CDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 744.2 Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1614.3 System (CST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 722

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7255.1 Network (CDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7265.2 Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 782

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11156.1 Network (CDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11166.2 Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1119

7 DTM Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1135

7.1 Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1136

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11398.1 Network (CDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11408.2 Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1141

9 – Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11759.1 Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1176

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 3 / 1176

Page 4: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

Contents

4 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 5: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

Preface

Preface

Purpose The BSS Parameter Dictionary lists all of the Telecom Parameters for GSMand GPRS.

What’s New In Edition 08This document was generated from the edition 14rl of the BSS TelecomParameters database with “AMR” parameters.

In Edition 07This document was generated from the edition 14rl of the BSS TelecomParameters database.

In Edition 06This document was generated from the edition 11rl of the BSS TelecomParameters database.

In Edition 05This document was generated from the edition 07rl of the BSS TelecomParameters database.

In Edition 04This document was generated from the edition 06rl of the BSS TelecomParameters database.

In Edition 03This document was generated from the edition 05rl of the BSS TelecomParameters database.

In Edition 02This document was generated from the edition 04rl of the BSS TelecomParameters database.

In Edition 01First official release of document.This document was generated from the edition 03rl of the BSS TelecomParameters database.

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 5 / 1176

Page 6: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

Preface

Audience This manual is designed for OMC-R users, O&M technicians and systemdesigners.

Assumed Knowledge Not applicable.

6 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 7: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

1 Introduction

1 Introduction

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 7 / 1176

Page 8: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

1 Introduction

1.1 Parameter ClassificationThe GSM and GPRS parameters are classified into three categories:

Network : customer dependent parameters, related to the network topology,

defined by the customer and valid for the complete network (e.g. BTS name,Cell ID, LAC number ...). They can be adjusted by CDE scripts.

Site : adjustable parameters from one cell to the next or from one BSC to the

next. They are set to a default value. They can be adjusted from the OMC-R.

System : fixed parameters, i.e. BSS system mandatory rules orautomatically populated in the DLS skeleton and let unchanged because

not customer dependent. Some of them are coded in BTS Software andconfiguration files.

1.2 Parameter DescriptionTo each parameter are associated the following characteristics:

Logical Parameter Name : Mnemonic conventionally used in Alcatel

documentation.

Definition : definition/purpose of the parameter.

Coding rules :, Rules of coding, when necessary.

Mandatory rules : Mandatory relationships or inter-dependence of some

data.

Recommended rules : Recommended relationships or inter-dependenceof some data.

Feature : Indicates to which feature the parameter is linked.

Category : Category into which the parameter is classified.

Instance : Possible instance of the parameter.

Value

Min/Max values : Possible range of the parameter values.

Default value : Parameter value in release B9 for a generic configuration.

Modifiable : Indicates if the parameter is modifiable at the OMC-R.

Parameter Access : Indicates where the parameter is accessible at theOMC-R.

External Comments : Specific information, when necessary, relatedto the parameter.

8 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 9: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 9 / 1176

Page 10: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1 Site (CAE)

2.1.1 (CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(n)) -(CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(n))

HMI Name CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(n)Parameter Name

Logical Name CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(n)

Definition Level hysteresis for cell reselection applied when the new cell is ina different location area.

Coding rules step size = 2dB; coded on 3 bits (000 : 0 dB, 111 : 14 dB)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 14 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

10 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 11: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.2 (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET) -(CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(BSC))

HMI Name CELL_RESELECT_OFFSETParameter Name

Logical Name CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(BSC)

Definition Permanent offset to C2 criterion.

Coding rules step size = 2dB; coded on 6 bits (000000:0 dB, 111111 : 126 dB)

Mandatory rules CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(MFS) =CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (n)(BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 126 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 11 / 1176

Page 12: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.3 (EN_INBAND_NOTIF) - (EN_INBAND_NOTIF)

HMI Name EN_INBAND_NOTIFParameter Name

Logical Name EN_INBAND_NOTIF

Definition Flag to disable/enable the in-band notification

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1:enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

12 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 13: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.4 (EN_INBAND_PAGING) - (EN_INBAND_PAGING)

HMI Name EN_INBAND_PAGINGParameter Name

Logical Name EN_INBAND_PAGING

Definition Flag to disable/enable the in-band paging

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 13 / 1176

Page 14: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.5 (EN_UPLINK_REPLY) - (EN_UPLINK_REPLY)

HMI Name EN_UPLINK_REPLYParameter Name

Logical Name EN_UPLINK_REPLY

Definition Flag to disable/enable the uplink reply procedure

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

14 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 15: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.6 (EN_VGCS) - (EN_VGCS)

HMI Name EN_VGCSParameter Name

Logical Name EN_VGCS

Definition Flag to disable/enable the VGCS in the cell

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules EN_VGCS shall be set to disabled for non-Evolium BTS

Recommended rules When the VGCS feature (EN_VGCS) is activated, it is recommendedto- include the Response Request in the HANDOVER REQUIREDmessage (RESP_REQ).- to configure, at least, one TRX withTRX_PREF_MARK <> 0 in the cell.- to set EN_TCH_PREEMPT toenabled, otherwise to set the value of MIN_VGCS_TS to a valuegreater or equal to 2

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 15 / 1176

Page 16: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.7 (INBAND_PAGING_THR) - (INBAND_PAGING_THR)

HMI Name INBAND_PAGING_THRParameter Name

Logical Name INBAND_PAGING_THR

Definition If the eMLPP priority included in the Paging message from the MSCis higher than or equal to this parameter, then the BSS shall triggerin-band paging within cells, that are identified to be paged from thePAGING message, and that have existing VGC active.

Coding rules Coded over 3 bits000 : deactivation of inband paging001 : callpriority level 4 (lowest priority)010 : call priority level 3011 : callpriority level 2100 : call priority level 1101 : call priority level 0110 :call priority level B111 : call priority level A (highest priority)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

16 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 17: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.8 (MAX_VGCS_TS) - (MAX_VGCS_TS)

HMI Name MAX_VGCS_TSParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_VGCS_TS

Definition Maximum number of radio timeslots that can be used by the VGCScalls in the cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules MIN_VGCS_TS <= MAX_VGCS_TSIf EN_VGCS= enabled, then"(MAX_VGCS_TS + MAX_PDCH) < Total number of TCHs of thecell".If EN_VGCS= disabled, then" MAX_VGCS_TS = 0"

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 127 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment 127 is a theoretical value : 16 TRX * 8 PDCH - BCCH.To supportVGCS in a cell, it is mandatory to have Max_VGCS_TS > 0

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 17 / 1176

Page 18: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.9 (MIN_VGCS_TS) - (MIN_VGCS_TS)

HMI Name MIN_VGCS_TSParameter Name

Logical Name MIN_VGCS_TS

Definition Minimum number of radio timeslots that are reserved for the VGCScalls in the cell in normal situation (point-to-point CS call can NOTuse these timeslots).

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules MIN_VGCS_TS <= MAX_VGCS_TS

Recommended rules - The following rules about the upper limit are recommended :i)MIN_VGCS_TS <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0)- 2 if TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF= "1: CCCH combined"ii) MIN_VGCS_TS <= 8*(nb of TRXswith TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0) - 3 if TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0 onBCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "0: CCCH not combined"iii)MIN_VGCS_TS <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0) - 1if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRX.- If EN_VGCS = enabled, then Alcatel recommends to set EN_TCH_PREEMPT to enabled,otherwise to set the value of MIN_VGCS_TS to a value greater orequal to 2

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 31 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment 127 is a theoretical value : 16 TRX * 8 PDCH - BCCH.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

18 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 19: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.10 (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n)(BSC))

HMI Name MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCHParameter Name

Logical Name MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n)(BSC)

Definition Maximum transmission power an MS is allowed to use whenaccessing the cell until otherwise commanded, broadcast on PBCCHfor CS service establishment.

Coding rules P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:stepsize = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range0 to 15, 30, 31; 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm, 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm,..., 15: 0 dBm.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm 5 43 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment According to the 3GPP TS 05.05, if the BCCH frequency band isP-GSM/G1, depending on the version of MS (Phase 1 MS or Phase2/onwards MS), the coded value "0", "1" and "2" are interpreteddifferently:- Coded value "0": (interpreted as 43 dBm by the Phase1 MS; interpreted as 39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Codedvalue "1": (interpreted as 41 dBm by the Phase 1 MS; interpreted as39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded value "2": (interpretedas 39 dBm by both the Phase 1 MS and the Phase 2/onwards MS).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 19 / 1176

Page 20: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.11 (NOTIF_FACCH_OTHER_VGCS_CALL_THR) -(NOTIF_FACCH_OTHER_VGCS_CALL_THR)

HMI Name NOTIF_FACCH_OTHER_VGCS_CALL_THRParameter Name

Logical Name NOTIF_FACCH_OTHER_VGCS_CALL_THR

Definition If the eMLPP priority is higher than or equal to this parameter, theNotifications message shall be sent on FACCH of all other on-goingVGCS call.

Coding rules Coded over 3 bits000 : deactivation of notification on FACCH of otheron-going VGCS calls001 : call priority level 4 (lowest priority)010 :call priority level 3011 : call priority level 2100 : call priority level1101 : call priority level 0110 : call priority level B111 : call prioritylevel A (highest priority)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

20 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 21: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.12 (NOTIF_FACCH_PTP_CALL_THR) -(NOTIF_FACCH_PTP_CALL_THR)

HMI Name NOTIF_FACCH_PTP_CALL_THRParameter Name

Logical Name NOTIF_FACCH_PTP_CALL_THR

Definition If the eMLPP priority is higher than or equal to this parameter, theNotifications message shall be sent on FACCH of all on-going pointto point call whose MS is VGCS capable.

Coding rules Coded over 3 bits000 : deactivation of notification on FACCH of allon going point to point calls in the cell001 : call priority level 4 (lowestpriority)010 : call priority level 3011 : call priority level 2100 : callpriority level 1101 : call priority level 0110 : call priority level B111 :call priority level A (highest priority)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 21 / 1176

Page 22: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.13 (NOTIF_PCH_THR) - (NOTIF_PCH_THR)

HMI Name NOTIF_PCH_THRParameter Name

Logical Name NOTIF_PCH_THR

Definition The priority threshold for notification over PCH.The BSS shallconsider, for Notification/PCH, only VGCS-Calls which have a priority(eMLPP priority) not below this parameter. If more than one isselected, all these voice group calls shall be notified on PCH and allwith the same frequency of occurrence.

Coding rules Coded over 3 bits000 : deactivation of notification on PCH in thecell001 : call priority level 4 (lowest priority)010 : call priority level3011 : call priority level 2100 : call priority level 1101 : call prioritylevel 0110 : call priority level B111 : call priority level A (highestpriority)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

22 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 23: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.14 (NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS) - (NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS)

HMI Name NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKSParameter Name

Logical Name NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS

Definition This parameter defines the maximum number of blocks usable forNCH.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules if EN_VGCS is enabled :- BS_AG_BLKS_RES >=NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS- if BCCH_EXT = true, thenBS_AG_BLKS_RES > NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 7 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The parameter is significant when EN_VGCS is enabled

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 23 / 1176

Page 24: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.15 (NY2) - (NY2)

HMI Name NY2Parameter Name

Logical Name NY2

Definition Maximum number of repetitions for the VGCS UPLINK GRANTmessage during an uplink access procedure

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 7 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

24 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 25: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.16 (PENALTY_TIME) - (PENALTY_TIME(n)(BSC))

HMI Name PENALTY_TIMEParameter Name

Logical Name PENALTY_TIME(n)(BSC)

Definition Time during which MS shall apply TEMPORARY_OFFSET to C2criterion.

Coding rules step size = 20s. 0: 20s, 1: 40s, ..., 30: 620s, 31: TEMPORARYOFFSET ignored and cell_RESELECT_OFFSET has a negativevalue

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 20 620 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Single inhibited (31)

Umbrella inhibited (31)

Concentric inhibited (31)

Concentric Umbrella inhibited (31)

Microcell 20 s (0)

Minicell 20 s (0)

Extended inner cell inhibited (31)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell inhibited (31)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 25 / 1176

Page 26: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.17 (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(BSC))

HMI Name RXLEV_ACCESS_MINParameter Name

Logical Name RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(BSC)

Definition Minimum received level at the MS required for initial access to thecell.

Coding rules Coded on 6 bits, 0=-110 dBm, 63=-47 dBm, step size=1dBm.

Mandatory rules RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(MFS) = RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

26 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 27: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.18 (START_UPLINK_REPLY) - (START_UPLINK_REPLY)

HMI Name START_UPLINK_REPLYParameter Name

Logical Name START_UPLINK_REPLY

Definition Maximum number of repetitions for the UPLINK FREE message (withthe Uplink Access Request bit set to L) during the initial part of theuplink access procedure (i.e. before sending the first UPLINK FREEmessage with the Uplink Access Request bit set to H)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 1024 256

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The parameter is significant only if EN_UPLINK_REPLY is set to true.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 27 / 1176

Page 28: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.19 (T_NOTIF_RESPONSE_DELAY) - (T_NOTIF_RESPONSE_DELAY)

HMI Name T_NOTIF_RESPONSE_DELAYParameter Name

Logical Name T_NOTIF_RESPONSE_DELAY

Definition This Timer is used to delay the Multiple SACCH Info Modify andthe VGCS_ADD_INFO in order to give the MS a chance to receivethe immediately transmitted VGCS_ADD_INFO/FACCH and SI6messages

Coding rules step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 100 1000 200

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

28 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 29: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.20 (T_REPETITION_CHANNEL_RELEASE) -(T_REPETITION_CHANNEL_RELEASE)

HMI Name T_REPETITION_CHANNEL_RELEASEParameter Name

Logical Name T_REPETITION_CHANNEL_RELEASE

Definition This parameter defines the repetition period of CHANNEL RELEASEmessage sent on FACCH

Coding rules step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 200 1000 200

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 29 / 1176

Page 30: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.21 (T_REPETITION_UPLINK_FREE) - (T_REPETITION_UPLINK_FREE)

HMI Name T_REPETITION_UPLINK_FREEParameter Name

Logical Name T_REPETITION_UPLINK_FREE

Definition Delay between consecutive repetitions of the UPLINK FREEmessage, sent to the mobile station. The UPLINK FREE messagesshall be repeated as long as no uplink is granted to a mobile station.

Coding rules step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 20 480 200

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

30 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 31: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.22 (T_WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS) - (T_WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS)

HMI Name T_WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESSParameter Name

Logical Name T_WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS

Definition Guard timer to wait for an Uplink Access. If no such bursts arereceived at this timer expiry, the BSC releases the voice group callchannel in that cell and provide notifications containing no channeldescription.

Coding rules step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T_Wait_Uplink_Access >= [START_UPLINK_REPLY + (10 *WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS)] * T_REPETITION_UPLINK_FREE

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 3 300 60

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The parameter is significant only if EN_UPLINK_REPLY is set to true

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 31 / 1176

Page 32: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.23 (T_WAIT_UPLINK_REQUEST_ACK) -(T_WAIT_UPLINK_REQUEST_ACK)

HMI Name T_WAIT_UPLINK_REQUEST_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name T_WAIT_UPLINK_REQUEST_ACK

Definition Guard timer to wait for UPLINK REQUEST ACK or UPLINKREQUEST REJECT message from the MSC.

Coding rules step size = 500 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 500 5000 500

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

32 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 33: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.24 (T14) - (T14)

HMI Name T14Parameter Name

Logical Name T14

Definition Maximum queuing time for the VGCS Assignment Requests

Coding rules step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 19 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 33 / 1176

Page 34: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.25 (T3115) - (T3115)

HMI Name T3115Parameter Name

Logical Name T3115

Definition This timer is used for the repetition of the VGCS UPLINK GRANTmessage during the uplink access procedure. If the timer expiresbefore the reception of a correctly decoded frame from MS, the BTSrepeats the VGCS UPLINK GRANT message to the requesting MS

Coding rules step size = 20ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 100 480 200

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

34 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 35: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.26 (TEMPORARY_OFFSET) - (TEMPORARY_OFFSET(n))

HMI Name TEMPORARY_OFFSETParameter Name

Logical Name TEMPORARY_OFFSET(n)

Definition Offset applied to C2 criterion for the duration of PENALTY_TIME.

Coding rules step size = 10dB. 0: 0dB, 1:10dB, 6: 60dB, 7: infinity

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 infinity 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Single 0 dB (0)

Umbrella 0 dB (0)

Concentric 0 dB (0)

Concentric Umbrella 0 dB (0)

Microcell infinity (7)

Minicell infinity (7)

Extended inner cell 0 dB (0)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 0 dB (0)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 35 / 1176

Page 36: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.27 (VGCS_FIX_AMR_FR_CODEC) - (VGCS_FIX_AMR_FR_CODEC)

HMI Name VGCS_FIX_AMR_FR_CODECParameter Name

Logical Name VGCS_FIX_AMR_FR_CODEC

Definition This parameter defines the type of FR AMR codec used in thenetwork.

Coding rules 0 : AMR Full Rate Codec 12,2 kbit/s;1 : AMR Full Rate Codec 10,2kbit/s;2 : AMR Full Rate Codec 7,95 kbit/s;3 : AMR Full Rate Codec7,40 kbit/s; 4 : AMR Full Rate Codec 6,70 kbit/s; 5 : AMR Full RateCodec 5,90 kbit/s; 6 : AMR Full Rate Codec 5,15 kbit/s; 7 : AMR FullRate Codec 4,75 kbit/st;

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

36 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 37: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.28 (VGCS_FIX_AMR_HR_CODEC) - (VGCS_FIX_AMR_HR_CODEC)

HMI Name VGCS_FIX_AMR_HR_CODECParameter Name

Logical Name VGCS_FIX_AMR_HR_CODEC

Definition This parameter defines the type of HR AMR codec used in thenetwork.

Coding rules 0 : AMR Half Rate Codec 7,95 kbit/s;1 : AMR Half Rate Codec 7,40kbit/s;2 : AMR Half Rate Codec 6,70 kbit/s;3 : AMR Half Rate Codec5,90 kbit/s;4 : AMR Half Rate Codec 5,15 kbit/s;5 : AMR Half RateCodec 4,75 kbit/s;

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 2 5 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment AMR Half Rate codec mode 7,95 kb/s is not supported by AlcatelBSS.AMR Half Rate codec mode 7,4kb/s is not supported as a"stand-alone" codec

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 37 / 1176

Page 38: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.29 (WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS) - (WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS)

HMI Name WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESSParameter Name

Logical Name WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS

Definition Maximum number of repetitions for the UPLINK FREE message(with the Uplink Access Request bit set to L) per cycle, during thenon-initial part of the uplink access procedure (i.e. after sending thefirst UPLINK FREE message with the Uplink Access Request bit setto H).Each time the value of this counter becomes zero, the BTSsend one UPLINK FREE message with the Uplink Access Requestbit set to H.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 32 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The parameter is significant only if EN_UPLINK_REPLY is set to true.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

38 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 39: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 39 / 1176

Page 40: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1 Network (CDE)

3.1.1 (CONFIDENCE_ORIGIN) - (CONFIDENCE_ORIGIN)

HMI Name CONFIDENCE_ORIGINParameter Name

Logical Name CONFIDENCE_ORIGIN

Definition Confidence origin used in the 3D linear regression of the confidenceof the ellipsoid arc returned by the MFS when providing the referencelocation to the A-GPS server.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 50.7

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

40 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 41: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.2 (CONFIDENCE_VS_ARC_FACTOR_SLOPE) -(CONFIDENCE_VS_ARC_FACTOR_SLOPE)

HMI Name CONFIDENCE_VS_ARC_FACTOR_SLOPEParameter Name

Logical Name CONFIDENCE_VS_ARC_FACTOR_SLOPE

Definition Slope ratio between the confidence and the arc factor used in the 3Dlinear regression of the confidence of the ellipsoid arc returned bythe MFS when providing the reference location to the A-GPS server.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 25

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 41 / 1176

Page 42: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.3 (CONFIDENCE_VS_RADIUS_SLOPE) -(CONFIDENCE_VS_RADIUS_SLOPE)

HMI Name CONFIDENCE_VS_RADIUS_SLOPEParameter Name

Logical Name CONFIDENCE_VS_RADIUS_SLOPE

Definition Slope ratio between the confidence and the sum of minimum radiusfactor and maximum radius factor used in the 3D linear regressionof the confidence of the ellipsoid arc returned by the MFS whenproviding the reference location to the A-GPS server.

Coding rules step size = 0.01

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 15.28

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

42 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 43: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.4 (MS_BASED_AGPS_ASSIST_DATA_LIST) -(MS_BASED_AGPS_ASSIST_DATA_LIST)

HMI Name MS_BASED_AGPS_ASSIST_DATA_LISTParameter Name

Logical Name MS_BASED_AGPS_ASSIST_DATA_LIST

Definition Bitmap (8 bits) defining the types of optional assistance data to beretrieved from the A-GPS server when using the MS based A-GPSpositioning method. The following optional assistance data type areconsidered: Almanac, UTC model, DGPS corrections, referencetime, acquisition assistance, real-time integrity.

Coding rules bit 8 (most significant) and bit 7 are not used (i.e. always set to 0); bit6=1: real-time integrity is retrieived; bit 5=1: acquisition assistanceis retrieived; bit 4=1: reference time is retrieived; bit 3=1: DGPScorrections is retrieived; bit 2=1: UTC model is retrieived; bit 1 (leastsignificant)=1: Almanac is retrieived.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Reference

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 63 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 43 / 1176

Page 44: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.5 (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_1) - (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_1)

HMI Name PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_1Parameter Name

Logical Name PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_1

Definition The most preferred GPS positioning method.

Coding rules It contains a reference to a GPS method: 1 for MS Assisted A-GPS,2 for MS Based A-GPS, 3 for Conventional GPS.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules The same GPS methods reference should not be used for differentpriorities

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

44 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 45: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.6 (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_2) - (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_2)

HMI Name PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_2Parameter Name

Logical Name PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_2

Definition The second preferred GPS positioning method.

Coding rules It contains a reference to a GPS method: 1 for MS Assisted A-GPS,2 for MS Based A-GPS, 3 for Conventional GPS.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules The same GPS methods reference should not be used for differentpriorities.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 45 / 1176

Page 46: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.7 (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_3) - (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_3)

HMI Name PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_3Parameter Name

Logical Name PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_3

Definition The third preferred GPS positioning method.

Coding rules It contains a reference to a GPS method: 1 for MS Assisted A-GPS,2 for MS Based A-GPS, 3 for Conventional GPS.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules The same GPS methods reference should not be used for differentpriorities.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

46 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 47: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.8 (SAGI_TCP_DATA_TIMEOUT) - (SAGI_TCP_DATA_TIMEOUT)

HMI Name SAGI_TCP_DATA_TIMEOUTParameter Name

Logical Name SAGI_TCP_DATA_TIMEOUT

Definition Parameter used in the context of supervision of SAGI based onTCP keep alive mechanism. This timer controls the retransmissiontimeout for the sending of the individual data segments.

Coding rules step size = 1 second

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 4 10 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 47 / 1176

Page 48: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.9 (SAGI_TCP_KEEP_ALIVE_INTERVAL) -(SAGI_TCP_KEEP_ALIVE_INTERVAL)

HMI Name SAGI_TCP_KEEP_ALIVE_INTERVALParameter Name

Logical Name SAGI_TCP_KEEP_ALIVE_INTERVAL

Definition Parameter used in the context of supervision of SAGI based on TCPkeep alive mechanism. This timer determines the interval separatingkeep alive retransmissions until a response is received. Once aresponse is received, the delay until the next keep alive transmissionis again controlled by the value of this timer. The connectionwill be aborted after the number of retransmissions specified bySAGI_TCP_MAX_DATA_RETRANS have gone unanswered.

Coding rules step size = 1 second

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 4 10 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

48 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 49: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.10 (SAGI_TCP_MAX_DATA_RETRANS) -(SAGI_TCP_MAX_DATA_RETRANS)

HMI Name SAGI_TCP_MAX_DATA_RETRANSParameter Name

Logical Name SAGI_TCP_MAX_DATA_RETRANS

Definition Parameter used in the context of supervision of SAGI based on TCPkeep alive mechanism. This parameter controls the number of timesTCP will retransmit an individual data segment before aborting theconnection. The retransmission timeout is given by the parameterSAGI_TCP_DATA_TIMEOUT.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 10 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 49 / 1176

Page 50: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.11 (T_SAGI_GUARD) - (T_SAGI_GUARD)

HMI Name T_SAGI_GUARDParameter Name

Logical Name T_SAGI_GUARD

Definition Timer to guard the response from the A-GPS server (on SAGI:interface with A-GPS server).

Coding rules step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 300 60

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment The timer is meaningful in the MFS when EN_SAGI=1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

50 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 51: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2 Site (CAE)

3.2.1 (ARC_SIZE_FACTOR) - (ARC_SIZE_FACTOR)

HMI Name ARC_SIZE_FACTORParameter Name

Logical Name ARC_SIZE_FACTOR

Definition Factor used in the computation of the width in degree of the ellipsoidarc returned by the MFS when computing location estimate based onTA positionning method.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 1.5 1.2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 51 / 1176

Page 52: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.2 (AZIMUTH) - (LCS_AZIMUTH)

HMI Name AZIMUTHParameter Name

Logical Name LCS_AZIMUTH

Definition Antenna direction orientation for the sector supporting the cell (usedby the MFS to compute location estimate based on TA positionningmethod).

Coding rules 0: 0 degree,, 359: 359 degree, 360: omnidirectional cell

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 360 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit cell / LCS

External Comment 0 corresponds to the North orientation and is counted clockwise.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

52 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 53: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.3 (EN_CONV_GPS) - (EN_CONV_GPS)

HMI Name EN_CONV_GPSParameter Name

Logical Name EN_CONV_GPS

Definition Flag to enable or disable the positioning method Conventional GPS.

Coding rules 0 = disabled; 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit cell / LCS

External Comment The activation of this positioning method is meaningful whenEN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 53 / 1176

Page 54: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.4 (EN_LCS) - (EN_LCS (BSC))

HMI Name EN_LCSParameter Name

Logical Name EN_LCS (BSC)

Definition Enables/Disables the Location Services (LCS) in the BSS.

Coding rules 0 = disabled; 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules Equal to EN_LCS (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

54 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 55: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.5 (EN_LCS) - (EN_LCS (MFS))

HMI Name EN_LCSParameter Name

Logical Name EN_LCS (MFS)

Definition Enables/Disables the Location Services (LCS) in the BSS.

Coding rules 0 = disabled; 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules Equal to EN_LCS (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 55 / 1176

Page 56: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.6 (EN_MS_ASSISTED_AGPS) - (EN_MS_ASSISTED_AGPS)

HMI Name EN_MS_ASSISTED_AGPSParameter Name

Logical Name EN_MS_ASSISTED_AGPS

Definition Flag to enable or disable the positioning method MS Assisted A-GPS.

Coding rules 0 = disabled; 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit cell / LCS

External Comment The activation of this positioning method is meaningful whenEN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

56 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 57: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.7 (EN_MS_BASED_AGPS) - (EN_MS_BASED_AGPS)

HMI Name EN_MS_BASED_AGPSParameter Name

Logical Name EN_MS_BASED_AGPS

Definition Flag to enable or disable the positioning method MS Based A-GPS.

Coding rules 0 = disabled; 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / LCS

External Comment The activation of this positioning method is meaningful whenEN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 57 / 1176

Page 58: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.8 (EN_SAGI) - (EN_SAGI)

HMI Name EN_SAGIParameter Name

Logical Name EN_SAGI

Definition Flag indicating whether SAGI (interface with the A-GPS server) isconfigured or not for this BSS.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

58 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 59: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.9 (Geographical Coordinates) -(GEOGRAPHICAL_COORDINATES_FLAG)

HMI Name Geographical CoordinatesParameter Name

Logical Name GEOGRAPHICAL_COORDINATES_FLAG

Definition Indicates whether latitude and longitude are significant or not.

Coding rules 0: not significant, 1: significant

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / LCS

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 59 / 1176

Page 60: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.10 (HALFPWR_BEAM_WIDTH) - (HALFPWR_BEAM_WIDTH)

HMI Name HALFPWR_BEAM_WIDTHParameter Name

Logical Name HALFPWR_BEAM_WIDTH

Definition Antenna half power beam for the sector supporting the cell (used bythe MFS to compute location estimate based on TA positionningmethod).

Coding rules 0: half power beam width unknown, 1: 1 degree,, 360: 360 degree(omnidirectional cell)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 360 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit cell / LCS

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

60 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 61: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.11 (LATITUDE) - (LCS_LATITUDE)

HMI Name LATITUDEParameter Name

Logical Name LCS_LATITUDE

Definition Latitude of the BTS supporting the cell (used by the MFS to computelocation estimate based on TA positionning method).

Coding rules Sequence of:- number of degrees (from 0 to 90)- number of minutes(from 0 to 59)- number of fractional minutes (from 0 to 9999)-direction (boolean, true for South and false for North)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type List of numbers

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0,0,0,false 90,59,9999,true #

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / LCS

External Comment 1) 0 latitude corresponds to the Equator; 2) The coding for OMC-RHMI is described in the "BSS O&M Parameters" document,parameter "LCS-Latitude".

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 61 / 1176

Page 62: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.12 (LONGITUDE) - (LCS_LONGITUDE)

HMI Name LONGITUDEParameter Name

Logical Name LCS_LONGITUDE

Definition Longitude of the BTS supporting the cell (used by the MFS tocompute location estimate based on TA positionning method).

Coding rules Sequence of:- number of degrees (from 0 to 180)- number of minutes(from 0 to 59)- number of fractional minutes (from 0 to 9999)-direction (boolean, true for West and false for East)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type List of numbers

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0,0,0,false 180,59,9999,true #

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / LCS

External Comment 1) 0 longitude corresponds to the Greenwich Meridian;2) Thecoding for OMC-R HMI is described in the "BSS O&M Parameters"document, parameter "LCS-Longitude".

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

62 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 63: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.13 (MAX_RADIUS_FACTOR) - (MAX_RADIUS_FACTOR)

HMI Name MAX_RADIUS_FACTORParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_RADIUS_FACTOR

Definition Factor used in the computation of the maximum radius of the ellipsoidarc returned by the MFS when computing location estimate based onTA positionning method.

Coding rules step size = 0.05

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.5 1 0.6

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 63 / 1176

Page 64: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.14 (MIN_RADIUS_FACTOR) - (MIN_RADIUS_FACTOR)

HMI Name MIN_RADIUS_FACTORParameter Name

Logical Name MIN_RADIUS_FACTOR

Definition Factor used in the computation of the minimum radius of the ellipsoidarc returned by the MFS when computing location estimate based onTA positionning method.

Coding rules step size = 0.05

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.5 1 0.85

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

64 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 65: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.15 (T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant) - (T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant)

HMI Name T_LCS_Delay_TolerantParameter Name

Logical Name T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant

Definition SMLC timer to guard the calculation of the MS position (including theRRLP message exchange with the target MS) in case of a DelayTolerant Location Request.

Coding rules step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules T_Location + T_Location_Longer > T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant >=T_LCS_Low_Delay

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 300 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSS / LCS

External Comment The timer is meaningful in the MFS when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 65 / 1176

Page 66: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.16 (T_LCS_Low_Delay) - (T_LCS_Low_Delay)

HMI Name T_LCS_Low_DelayParameter Name

Logical Name T_LCS_Low_Delay

Definition SMLC timer to guard the calculation of the MS position (includingthe RRLP message exchange with the target MS) in case of a LowDelay Location Request.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules T_Location + T_Location_Longer > T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant >=T_LCS_Low_Delay

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 180 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSS / LCS

External Comment The timer is meaningful in the MFS when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

66 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 67: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.17 (T_Loc_abort) - (T_Loc_abort)

HMI Name T_Loc_abortParameter Name

Logical Name T_Loc_abort

Definition BSC timer supervising the response from the SMLC in case ofLocation Abort.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T_Loc_abort < T_Location

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 30 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment The timer is meaningful in the BSC when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 67 / 1176

Page 68: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.18 (T_Location) - (T_Location)

HMI Name T_LocationParameter Name

Logical Name T_Location

Definition BSC timer, on a per call basis, supervising the response from theSMLC in case of Location request, when no RRLP exchange istriggered with the MS.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules T_Location + T_Location_Longer > T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant >=T_LCS_Low_Delay

Recommended rules -

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 300 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment The timer is meaningful in the BSC when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

68 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 69: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.19 (T_Location_Longer) - (T_Location_Longer)

HMI Name T_Location_LongerParameter Name

Logical Name T_Location_Longer

Definition BSC timer, on a per call basis, supervising the response from theSMLC in case of Location request, when a RRLP exchange istriggered with the MS.

Coding rules step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules T_Location + T_Location_Longer > T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant >=T_LCS_Low_Delay

Recommended rules T_Location_Longer > T_Location

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 300 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment The timer is meaningful in the BSC when EN_LCS=1, and replacesT_Location timer in case of Conventional GPS, MS Assisted A-GPSand MS Based A-GPS positioning methods.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 69 / 1176

Page 70: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.20 (T_RRLP_Delay_Tolerant) - (T_RRLP_Delay_Tolerant)

HMI Name T_RRLP_Delay_TolerantParameter Name

Logical Name T_RRLP_Delay_Tolerant

Definition SMLC timer to guard the RRLP message exchange between theSMLC and the target MS, in case of a Delay Tolerant LocationRequest.

Coding rules step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant >T_RRLP_Delay_TolerantT_RRLP_Delay_Tolerant >=T_RRLP_Low_Delay

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 300 9

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSS / LCS

External Comment The timer is meaningful in the MFS when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

70 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 71: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.21 (T_RRLP_Low_Delay) - (T_RRLP_Low_Delay)

HMI Name T_RRLP_Low_DelayParameter Name

Logical Name T_RRLP_Low_Delay

Definition SMLC timer to guard the RRLP message exchange between theSMLC and the target MS, in case of a Low Delay Location Request.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules T_Low_Delay > T_RRLP_Low_DelayT_RRLP_Delay_Tolerant >=T_RRLP_Low_Delay

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 120 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / LCS

External Comment The timer is meaningful in the MFS when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 71 / 1176

Page 72: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

72 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 73: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 73 / 1176

Page 74: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1 Network (CDE)

4.1.1 (ADDR_MON) - (ADDR_MON)

HMI Name ADDR_MONParameter Name

Logical Name ADDR_MON

Definition Time it takes to ADDR_TR to be reached to report an alarm. Ontimeout, the address error counter is reset.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

74 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 75: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.2 (ADDR_TR) - (ADDR_TR)

HMI Name ADDR_TRParameter Name

Logical Name ADDR_TR

Definition Address error threshold for alarm detection.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 255 60

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 75 / 1176

Page 76: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.3 (Autocleaning_Timer) - (T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP)

HMI Name Autocleaning_TimerParameter Name

Logical Name T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP

Definition Guard time for detection of SDCCH/TCH autocleaning procedure.

Coding rules step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In micro cells, it is recommended to set N_BAD_SACCH so thatT_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP > N_BAD_SACCH * 480ms + 30seconds if T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP <> 0.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 255 40

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General timers and procedures

External Comment T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP = 0 inhibits the autocleaningprocedure.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

76 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 77: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.4 (BF_HI_RX) - (BF_HI_RX)

HMI Name BF_HI_RXParameter Name

Logical Name BF_HI_RX

Definition Threshold on LAPD RX buffers occupancy for transition from normalto busy condition.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules BF_HI_RX > BF_LO_RX

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 80

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 77 / 1176

Page 78: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.5 (BF_HI_TX) - (BF_HI_TX)

HMI Name BF_HI_TXParameter Name

Logical Name BF_HI_TX

Definition Threshold on LAPD TX buffers occupancy for transition from normalto busy condition.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules BF_HI_TX > BF_LO_TX

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 30 16

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

78 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 79: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.6 (BF_LO_RX) - (BF_LO_RX)

HMI Name BF_LO_RXParameter Name

Logical Name BF_LO_RX

Definition Threshold on LAPD RX buffers occupancy for transition from busyto normal condition.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules BF_LO_RX < BF_HI_RX

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 70

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 79 / 1176

Page 80: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.7 (BF_LO_TX) - (BF_LO_TX)

HMI Name BF_LO_TXParameter Name

Logical Name BF_LO_TX

Definition Threshold on LAPD TX buffers occupancy for transition from busyto normal condition.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules BF_LO_TX < BF_HI_TX

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 30 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

80 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 81: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.8 (CGI_REQUIRED) - (CGI_REQD)

HMI Name CGI_REQUIREDParameter Name

Logical Name CGI_REQD

Definition Controls format of cell identifications sent to the MSC.

Coding rules 0: CGI not used, 1: CGI used

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules Alcatel recommend to set the CGI_REQD parameter to 1 providedthat the MSC supports the CGI format. The CGI_REQD parametershall be set to 1 if the operator wants to allow inter-PLMN 2Gto 2G handovers. If this parameter needs to be changed, it isrecommended to change it during a migration phase to avoid anyadditional Telecom outage.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment Depends on MSC Type. The value indicated here is forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 81 / 1176

Page 82: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.9 (COUNT_DECR) - (COUNT_DECR)

HMI Name COUNT_DECRParameter Name

Logical Name COUNT_DECR

Definition Stepsize by which the leaky bucket counter used during the reactionto TCU overload is decremented upon T_COUNT_I expiry.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

82 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 83: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.10 (COUNT_I_THRESHOLD) - (COUNT_I_THRESHOLD)

HMI Name COUNT_I_THRESHOLDParameter Name

Logical Name COUNT_I_THRESHOLD

Definition Leaky bucket counter threshold used to trigger defense actions uponTCU overload.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 50 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 83 / 1176

Page 84: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.11 (COUNT_INCR_1) - (COUNT_INCR_1)

HMI Name COUNT_INCR_1Parameter Name

Logical Name COUNT_INCR_1

Definition Stepsize by which the leaky bucket counter used during the reactionto TCU overload is incremented upon TCU overload level 1.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules COUNT_INCR_1 <= COUNT_INCR_2

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 10 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

84 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 85: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.12 (COUNT_INCR_2) - (COUNT_INCR_2)

HMI Name COUNT_INCR_2Parameter Name

Logical Name COUNT_INCR_2

Definition Stepsize by which the leaky bucket counter used during the reactionto TCU overload is incremented upon TCU overload level 2.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules COUNT_INCR_2 >= COUNT_INCR_1

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 85 / 1176

Page 86: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.13 (CRC_MON) - (CRC_MON)

HMI Name CRC_MONParameter Name

Logical Name CRC_MON

Definition Time in which CRC_TR is to be reached to report an alarm. Ontimeout, the CRC error counter is reset.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

86 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 87: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.14 (CRC_TR) - (CRC_TR)

HMI Name CRC_TRParameter Name

Logical Name CRC_TR

Definition CRC error threshold for alarm detection.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 255 50

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 87 / 1176

Page 88: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.15 (EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY) -(EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY)

HMI Name EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGYParameter Name

Logical Name EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY

Definition Defines the radio resource allocation strategy used in EGSM cells.

Coding rules 0: Different behaviour for EGSM capable MS: The BSS handlesdifferently EGSM capable MS from PGSM only capable MS in EGSMcells.1: Same behaviour for EGSM capable MS: The BSS handlesin the same way only PGSM capable MS as EGSM capable MS inEGSM cells, i.e. the BSS assumes that all GSM900 MS are EGSMcapable.

Mandatory rules 1) When EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY is set to "Differentbehaviour for EGSM capable MS", the OMC-R does not allow theoperator to define the BCCH, CCCH, SDCCH and CBCH on a G1TRX.2) For a hopping G1 TRX, if EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY =0 then TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

88 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 89: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.16 (EN_FR_IF_HR_PREF) - (EN_FR_IF_HR_PREF)

HMI Name EN_FR_IF_HR_PREFParameter Name

Logical Name EN_FR_IF_HR_PREF

Definition When set, this flag allows, when bugged MS asking for a "dual rate,half-rate preferred", to allocate a full rate channel.

Coding rules 0 : function disabled, 1 : function enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 89 / 1176

Page 90: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.17 (I_TX_LAPD) - (I_TX_LAPD)

HMI Name I_TX_LAPDParameter Name

Logical Name I_TX_LAPD

Definition Maximum LAPD transmission queue length.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 5 204 105

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

90 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 91: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.18 (LB_DECR) - (LB_DECR)

HMI Name LB_DECRParameter Name

Logical Name LB_DECR

Definition Stepsize by which a leaky bucket overload counter in the BSC isdecremented on T_LB_OV expiry.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 91 / 1176

Page 92: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.19 (LB_INCR) - (LB_INCR)

HMI Name LB_INCRParameter Name

Logical Name LB_INCR

Definition Stepsize by which a leaky bucket overload counter in the BSC isincremented each time an OVERLOAD is received from the FU.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

92 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 93: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.20 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [1]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [1])

HMI Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [1]Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [1]

Definition Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded bythe TCU at step I.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 93 / 1176

Page 94: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.21 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [10]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i[10])

HMI Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [10]Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [10]

Definition Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded bythe TCU at step I.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

94 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 95: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.22 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [2]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [2])

HMI Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [2]Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [2]

Definition Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded bythe TCU at step I.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 95 / 1176

Page 96: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.23 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [3]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [3])

HMI Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [3]Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [3]

Definition Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded bythe TCU at step I.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

96 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 97: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.24 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [4]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [4])

HMI Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [4]Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [4]

Definition Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded bythe TCU at step I.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 40

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 97 / 1176

Page 98: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.25 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [5]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [5])

HMI Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [5]Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [5]

Definition Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded bythe TCU at step I.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

98 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 99: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.26 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [6]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [6])

HMI Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [6]Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [6]

Definition Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded bythe TCU at step I.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 99 / 1176

Page 100: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.27 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [7]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [7])

HMI Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [7]Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [7]

Definition Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded bythe TCU at step I.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

100 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 101: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.28 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [8]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [8])

HMI Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [8]Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [8]

Definition Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded bythe TCU at step I.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 101 / 1176

Page 102: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.29 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [9]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [9])

HMI Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [9]Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [9]

Definition Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded bythe TCU at step I.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

102 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 103: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.30 (NBLK) - (NBLK)

HMI Name NBLKParameter Name

Logical Name NBLK

Definition Maximum number of BLOCK messages that can be sent if the ACKfrom the MSC is not received.

Coding rules 255: infinite transmission

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 255 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 103 / 1176

Page 104: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.31 (NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1) - (NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1)

HMI Name NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1Parameter Name

Logical Name NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1

Definition Number of steps needed to reduce the load upon TCU overloadlevel 1.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1 <= NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

104 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 105: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.32 (NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2) - (NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2)

HMI Name NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2Parameter Name

Logical Name NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2

Definition Number of steps to reduce the load upon TCU overload level 2.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2 >= NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 105 / 1176

Page 106: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.33 (NUBLK) - (NUBLK)

HMI Name NUBLKParameter Name

Logical Name NUBLK

Definition Maximum number of UNBLOCK messages that are sent if the ACKfrom the MSC is not received.

Coding rules 255: infinite transmission

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 255 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

106 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 107: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.34 (PROT_MON) - (PROT_MON)

HMI Name PROT_MONParameter Name

Logical Name PROT_MON

Definition Time in which PROT_TH is to be reached to report an alarm. Ontimeout, the protocol error counter is reset.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 107 / 1176

Page 108: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.35 (PROT_TH) - (PROT_TH)

HMI Name PROT_THParameter Name

Logical Name PROT_TH

Definition Protocol error threshold for alarm detection.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 255 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

108 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 109: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.36 (SDCCH_AVG_PERIOD) - (SDCCH_AVG_PERIOD)

HMI Name SDCCH_AVG_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name SDCCH_AVG_PERIOD

Definition Period used to average the processor occupancy measurements.

Coding rules 8 bits, step size=1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 16 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 109 / 1176

Page 110: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.37 (SDCCH_HIGH_DELAY) - (SDCCH_HIGH_DELAY)

HMI Name SDCCH_HIGH_DELAYParameter Name

Logical Name SDCCH_HIGH_DELAY

Definition Delay added to SDCCH internal release when TCU processor loadis high.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 10 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

110 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 111: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.38 (SDCCH_LOW_DELAY) - (SDCCH_LOW_DELAY)

HMI Name SDCCH_LOW_DELAYParameter Name

Logical Name SDCCH_LOW_DELAY

Definition Delay added to SDCCH internal release when TCU processor load islow.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 10 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 111 / 1176

Page 112: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.39 (SMS_INHIBIT) - (SMS_INHIBIT)

HMI Name SMS_INHIBITParameter Name

Logical Name SMS_INHIBIT

Definition This flag enables/disables SMS support.

Coding rules 0: SMS permitted, 1: SMS inhibited

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

112 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 113: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.40 (SSF) - (SSF)

HMI Name SSFParameter Name

Logical Name SSF

Definition This parameter inditifies the numbering plan of the Signalling PointCode.

Coding rules coded over 4 bits.only values 0, 4, 8 and 12 are defined : Value =0, international network; Value = 4, Spare, reserved for internationaluse; Value = 8, National network; Value = 12 , Reserved for nationaluse

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 12 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment SSF (Sub-Service Field) is composed of 4 bits: 2bits for NetworkIndicator and 2 spare bits.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 113 / 1176

Page 114: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.41 (T_BTS_EST_CNF) - (T_BTS_EST_CNF)

HMI Name T_BTS_EST_CNFParameter Name

Logical Name T_BTS_EST_CNF

Definition Supervision of the SAPI 3 Establishment procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

114 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 115: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.42 (T_BTS_RLS_CNF) - (T_BTS_RLS_CNF)

HMI Name T_BTS_RLS_CNFParameter Name

Logical Name T_BTS_RLS_CNF

Definition Supervision of the SAPI 3 Release procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 115 / 1176

Page 116: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.43 (T_CBC_READY) - (T_CBC_READY)

HMI Name T_CBC_READYParameter Name

Logical Name T_CBC_READY

Definition Defines the maximum period during which the BSC tries to connectto the CBC before issueing an alarm or returning CMD-MODE Resp.

Coding rules step size: 1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T_CBC_READY > 8 * T_CONNECT

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 10 600 300

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

116 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 117: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.44 (T_COUNT_I) - (T_COUNT_I)

HMI Name T_COUNT_IParameter Name

Logical Name T_COUNT_I

Definition Supervision of the leaky bucket counter used during the reaction toTCU overload.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 50 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 117 / 1176

Page 118: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.45 (T_i) - (T_i)

HMI Name T_iParameter Name

Logical Name T_i

Definition Duration of SSP or SPI condition that triggers an Internal Resetprocedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules For BSC Evolution, the default value must be increased to 22 sec

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

118 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 119: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.46 (T_LB_OV) - (T_LB_OV)

HMI Name T_LB_OVParameter Name

Logical Name T_LB_OV

Definition Supervision of the leaky bucket counter used during the reactionto FU overload.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 25.5 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 119 / 1176

Page 120: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.47 (T_OVL_MSC) - (T_OVL_MSC)

HMI Name T_OVL_MSCParameter Name

Logical Name T_OVL_MSC

Definition Minimum delay between two consecutive OVERLOAD messagessent to the MSC.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 6553.5 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

120 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 121: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.48 (T_RCR_ACK) - (T_RCR_ACK)

HMI Name T_RCR_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name T_RCR_ACK

Definition Supervision of the RF Channel Release procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 121 / 1176

Page 122: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.49 (T_SMSCB_RESP) - (T_SMSCB_RESP)

HMI Name T_SMSCB_RESPParameter Name

Logical Name T_SMSCB_RESP

Definition Maximum waiting time to get a response from the BTS to a primitive.

Coding rules step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 10 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

122 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 123: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.50 (T1_0858) - (T1_0858)

HMI Name T1_0858Parameter Name

Logical Name T1_0858

Definition Delay during which, after reception of an OVERLOAD from the BTS,a new OVERLOAD is ignored.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules T1_0858 < T2_0858

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 3 6553.5 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 123 / 1176

Page 124: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.51 (T2_0858) - (T2_0858)

HMI Name T2_0858Parameter Name

Logical Name T2_0858

Definition Minimum delay between debarring of an access class, in the casewhere the BTS stops sending OVERLOAD.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules T2_0858 > T1_0858

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 3 6553.5 50

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

124 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 125: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.52 (T9101) - (T9101)

HMI Name T9101Parameter Name

Logical Name T9101

Definition Supervision of the SCCP connection release procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 125 / 1176

Page 126: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.53 (T9103) - (T9103)

HMI Name T9103Parameter Name

Logical Name T9103

Definition Supervision of the Channel Activation procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

126 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 127: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.54 (T9108) - (T9108)

HMI Name T9108Parameter Name

Logical Name T9108

Definition Supervision of the Physical Context procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 127 / 1176

Page 128: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.55 (T9110) - (T9110)

HMI Name T9110Parameter Name

Logical Name T9110

Definition Guards the response of the MSC when no resources areallocated to the SCCP connection (started on the receptionof CONN_IND(SCCP_CON_REQ) not carrying a HANDOVERREQUEST message and stopped when a HANDOVER REQUESTmessage is received on the same SCCP connection as theSCCP_CON_REQ message). Guards also the response of the MSCwhen a HANDOVER FAILURE or ASSIGNMENT FAILURE messagehas been sent (stopped when a HANDOVER REQUEST or CLEARCOMMAND message is received).

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T9110 << max [T(ias), T(iar)].

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

128 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 129: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.56 (TCH_INFO_PERIOD) - (TCH_INFO_PERIOD)

HMI Name TCH_INFO_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name TCH_INFO_PERIOD

Definition Periodicity of TCH usage information update in the BSC.

Coding rules stepsize = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 2 25.5 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: Displayed RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 129 / 1176

Page 130: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.57 (THR_LB_OV) - (THR_LB_OV)

HMI Name THR_LB_OVParameter Name

Logical Name THR_LB_OV

Definition Counter threshold for triggering global defence actions in the BSCupon FU overload.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 50 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

130 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 131: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.58 (THRESHOLD_1_0) - (THRESHOLD_1_0)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_1_0Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_1_0

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 0.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_1_0 >= THRESHOLD_2_0

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 25

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 131 / 1176

Page 132: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.59 (THRESHOLD_1_1) - (THRESHOLD_1_1)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_1_1Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_1_1

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 1.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_1_1 >= THRESHOLD_2_1

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 28

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

132 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 133: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.60 (THRESHOLD_1_10) - (THRESHOLD_1_10)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_1_10Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_1_10

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 10.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_1_10 >= THRESHOLD_2_10

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 55

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 133 / 1176

Page 134: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.61 (THRESHOLD_1_2) - (THRESHOLD_1_2)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_1_2Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_1_2

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 2.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_1_2 >= THRESHOLD_2_2

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 31

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

134 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 135: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.62 (THRESHOLD_1_3) - (THRESHOLD_1_3)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_1_3Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_1_3

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 3.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_1_3 >= THRESHOLD_2_3

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 34

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 135 / 1176

Page 136: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.63 (THRESHOLD_1_4) - (THRESHOLD_1_4)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_1_4Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_1_4

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 4.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_1_4 >= THRESHOLD_2_4

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 37

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

136 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 137: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.64 (THRESHOLD_1_5) - (THRESHOLD_1_5)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_1_5Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_1_5

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 5.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_1_5 >= THRESHOLD_2_5

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 40

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 137 / 1176

Page 138: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.65 (THRESHOLD_1_6) - (THRESHOLD_1_6)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_1_6Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_1_6

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 6.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_1_6 >= THRESHOLD_2_6

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

138 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 139: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.66 (THRESHOLD_1_7) - (THRESHOLD_1_7)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_1_7Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_1_7

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 7.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_1_7 >= THRESHOLD_2_7

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 46

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 139 / 1176

Page 140: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.67 (THRESHOLD_1_8) - (THRESHOLD_1_8)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_1_8Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_1_8

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 8.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_1_8 >= THRESHOLD_2_8

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 49

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

140 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 141: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.68 (THRESHOLD_1_9) - (THRESHOLD_1_9)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_1_9Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_1_9

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 9.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_1_9 >= THRESHOLD_2_9

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 52

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 141 / 1176

Page 142: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.69 (THRESHOLD_2_0) - (THRESHOLD_2_0)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_2_0Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_2_0

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 0.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_2_0 <= THRESHOLD_1_0

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 22

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

142 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 143: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.70 (THRESHOLD_2_1) - (THRESHOLD_2_1)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_2_1Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_2_1

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 1.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_2_1 <= THRESHOLD_1_1

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 25

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 143 / 1176

Page 144: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.71 (THRESHOLD_2_10) - (THRESHOLD_2_10)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_2_10Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_2_10

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 10.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_2_10 <= THRESHOLD_1_10

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 52

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

144 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 145: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.72 (THRESHOLD_2_2) - (THRESHOLD_2_2)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_2_2Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_2_2

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 2.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_2_2 <= THRESHOLD_1_2

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 28

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 145 / 1176

Page 146: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.73 (THRESHOLD_2_3) - (THRESHOLD_2_3)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_2_3Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_2_3

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 3.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_2_3 <= THRESHOLD_1_3

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 31

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

146 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 147: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.74 (THRESHOLD_2_4) - (THRESHOLD_2_4)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_2_4Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_2_4

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 4.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_2_4 <= THRESHOLD_1_4

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 34

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 147 / 1176

Page 148: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.75 (THRESHOLD_2_5) - (THRESHOLD_2_5)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_2_5Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_2_5

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 5.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_2_5 <= THRESHOLD_1_5

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 37

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

148 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 149: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.76 (THRESHOLD_2_6) - (THRESHOLD_2_6)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_2_6Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_2_6

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 6.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_2_6 <= THRESHOLD_1_6

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 40

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 149 / 1176

Page 150: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.77 (THRESHOLD_2_7) - (THRESHOLD_2_7)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_2_7Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_2_7

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 7.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_2_7 <= THRESHOLD_1_7

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

150 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 151: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.78 (THRESHOLD_2_8) - (THRESHOLD_2_8)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_2_8Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_2_8

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 8.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_2_8 <= THRESHOLD_1_8

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 46

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 151 / 1176

Page 152: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.79 (THRESHOLD_2_9) - (THRESHOLD_2_9)

HMI Name THRESHOLD_2_9Parameter Name

Logical Name THRESHOLD_2_9

Definition Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 9.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules THRESHOLD_2_9 <= THRESHOLD_1_9

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 49

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

152 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 153: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.80 (TL_TCUA) - (TL_TCUA)

HMI Name TL_TCUAParameter Name

Logical Name TL_TCUA

Definition Minimum delay between two consecutive TCU load increaseby thelocal overload controller.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules TL_TCUA >TS_TCUA

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 50 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 153 / 1176

Page 154: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.81 (TL0) - (TL0)

HMI Name TL0Parameter Name

Logical Name TL0

Definition Threshold on TCU Processor Occupancy Level. The TCU is in "LowOverload" state if its Processor Occupancy Level is higher or equalto TL0 and less than TL3." The TCU is in "No Overload" state if itsProcessor Occupancy Level is less than TL0.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules TL0 < TL3 < TL4

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 60

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

154 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 155: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.82 (TL1) - (TL1)

HMI Name TL1Parameter Name

Logical Name TL1

Definition BSC processor occupancy threshold used to decrement pointer Pon buffer occupancy thresholds.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules TL1 < TL2

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 70

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 155 / 1176

Page 156: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.83 (TL2) - (TL2)

HMI Name TL2Parameter Name

Logical Name TL2

Definition BSC processor occupancy threshold used to increment pointer Pon buffer occupancy thresholds.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules TL3 > TL4

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 85

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

156 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 157: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.84 (TL3) - (TL3)

HMI Name TL3Parameter Name

Logical Name TL3

Definition Threshold on TCU Processor Occupancy Level:1) In upwarddirection, the TCU Overload State is in "High Overload" state if"TL3 <= TCU Processor Occupancy Level < TL4";2) In downwarddirection, the TCU Overload State is still in "Very High Overload"State if "TL3 <= TCU Processor Occupancy Level < TL4";3) Indownward direction, the TCU Overload State is in "Low Overload"state if "TL0 <= TCU Processor Occupancy Level < TL3.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules T0 < TL3 < TL4

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 75

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 157 / 1176

Page 158: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.85 (TL4) - (TL4)

HMI Name TL4Parameter Name

Logical Name TL4

Definition Threshold on TCU Processor Occupancy Level. The TCU is in "VeryHigh Overload" state if its Processor Occupancy Level is higher orequal to TL4.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules TL4 > TL3 > TL0

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 95

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

158 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 159: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.86 (TRG_SDCCH) - (TRG_SDCCH)

HMI Name TRG_SDCCHParameter Name

Logical Name TRG_SDCCH

Definition Controls if local overload controller is triggered upon SDCCHoverload.

Coding rules 1 for TCU, 0 for others

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC proc

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment This parameter is set by default to 1 for TCUs. It shall be set to 0for other BSC processors

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 159 / 1176

Page 160: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.87 (TS_TCUA) - (TS_TCUA)

HMI Name TS_TCUAParameter Name

Logical Name TS_TCUA

Definition Minimum delay between two consecutive TCU load reduction by thelocal overload controller.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules TS_TCUA < TL_TCUA

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 50 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

160 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 161: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2 Site (CAE)

4.2.1 (A_LEV_HO) - (A_LEV_HO)

HMI Name A_LEV_HOParameter Name

Logical Name A_LEV_HO

Definition Window size for level averages for handover.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_LEV_HO + W_LEV_HO < 32

Recommended rules A_LEV_HO = 2 x A_LEV_PC. A_PBGT_HO = 2 x A_LEV_HO

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 31 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Single 8

Umbrella 8

Concentric 8

Concentric Umbrella 8

Microcell 4

Minicell 8

Extended inner cell 8

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 8

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 161 / 1176

Page 162: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.2 (A_LEV_MCHO) - (A_LEV_MCHO)

HMI Name A_LEV_MCHOParameter Name

Logical Name A_LEV_MCHO

Definition Window size for level averages for microcell handover.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_LEV_MCHO + W_LEV_MCHO < 16

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 15 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters /Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric N/A

Concentric Umbrella N/A

Microcell 2

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

162 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 163: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.3 (A_LEV_PC) - (A_LEV_PC)

HMI Name A_LEV_PCParameter Name

Logical Name A_LEV_PC

Definition Window size for level averages for power control.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_LEV_PC + W_LEV_PC < 32

Recommended rules A_LEV_HO = 2 x A_LEV_PC

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 31 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 163 / 1176

Page 164: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.4 (A_PBGT_DR) - (A_PBGT_DR)

HMI Name A_PBGT_DRParameter Name

Logical Name A_PBGT_DR

Definition Window size for neighbour cell level averages for forced directed retry.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 15 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: DIR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Directed Retry

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

164 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 165: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.5 (A_PBGT_HO) - (A_PBGT_HO)

HMI Name A_PBGT_HOParameter Name

Logical Name A_PBGT_HO

Definition Window size for averaging neighbour cell levels and averagingcurrent cell levels for power budget calculation.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_PBGT_HO + W_PBGT_HO < 32

Recommended rules A_PBGT_HO = 2 x A_LEV_HO

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 31 16

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment should be set to 6 in suburban area, to 8 in urban area and to 12in rural area

Single 12

Umbrella 12

Concentric 12

Concentric Umbrella 12

Microcell 6

Minicell 12

Extended inner cell 12

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 12

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 165 / 1176

Page 166: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.6 (A_QUAL_CA_FR_HR) - (A_QUAL_CA_FR_HR)

HMI Name A_QUAL_CA_FR_HRParameter Name

Logical Name A_QUAL_CA_FR_HR

Definition Quality averaging window size for AMR FR-to-HR channel adaptation.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules A_QUAL_CA_FR_HR >= A_QUAL_CA_HR_FR

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 61 61

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

166 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 167: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.7 (A_QUAL_CA_HR_FR) - (A_QUAL_CA_HR_FR)

HMI Name A_QUAL_CA_HR_FRParameter Name

Logical Name A_QUAL_CA_HR_FR

Definition Quality averaging window size for AMR HR-to-FR channel adaptation.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules A_QUAL_CA_FR_HR >= A_QUAL_CA_HR_FR

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 61 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 167 / 1176

Page 168: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.8 (A_QUAL_HO) - (A_QUAL_HO)

HMI Name A_QUAL_HOParameter Name

Logical Name A_QUAL_HO

Definition Window size for quality averages for handover.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_QUAL_HO + W_QUAL_HO < 32

Recommended rules A_QUAL_HO = 2 x A_QUAL_PC

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 31 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Single 8

Umbrella 8

Concentric 8

Concentric Umbrella 8

Microcell 4

Minicell 8

Extended inner cell 8

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 8

Nb of TRX Dependent No

168 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 169: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.9 (A_QUAL_PC) - (A_QUAL_PC)

HMI Name A_QUAL_PCParameter Name

Logical Name A_QUAL_PC

Definition Window size for quality averages for power control.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_QUAL_PC + W_QUAL_PC < 32

Recommended rules A_QUAL_HO = 2 x A_QUAL_PC

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 31 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 169 / 1176

Page 170: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.10 (A_RANGE_HO) - (A_RANGE_HO)

HMI Name A_RANGE_HOParameter Name

Logical Name A_RANGE_HO

Definition Window size for distance averages.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 31 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

170 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 171: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.11 (A_TRAFFIC_LOAD) - (A_TRAFFIC_LOAD)

HMI Name A_TRAFFIC_LOADParameter Name

Logical Name A_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Definition Window size for load averages.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 16 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

4 4 8 8 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 171 / 1176

Page 172: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.12 (AC 0) - (AC_0)

HMI Name AC 0Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_0

Definition Indicates if Access Class 0 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

172 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 173: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.13 (AC 1) - (AC_1)

HMI Name AC 1Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_1

Definition Indicates if Access Class 1 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 173 / 1176

Page 174: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.14 (AC 11) - (AC_11)

HMI Name AC 11Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_11

Definition Indicates if Access Class 11 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

174 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 175: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.15 (AC 12) - (AC_12)

HMI Name AC 12Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_12

Definition Indicates if Access Class 12 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 175 / 1176

Page 176: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.16 (AC 13) - (AC_13)

HMI Name AC 13Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_13

Definition Indicates if Access Class 13 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

176 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 177: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.17 (AC 14) - (AC_14)

HMI Name AC 14Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_14

Definition Indicates if Access Class 14 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 177 / 1176

Page 178: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.18 (AC 15) - (AC_15)

HMI Name AC 15Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_15

Definition Indicates if Access Class 15 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

178 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 179: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.19 (AC 2) - (AC_2)

HMI Name AC 2Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_2

Definition Indicates if Access Class 2 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 179 / 1176

Page 180: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.20 (AC 3) - (AC_3)

HMI Name AC 3Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_3

Definition Indicates if Access Class 3 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

180 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 181: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.21 (AC 4) - (AC_4)

HMI Name AC 4Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_4

Definition Indicates if Access Class 4 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 181 / 1176

Page 182: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.22 (AC 5) - (AC_5)

HMI Name AC 5Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_5

Definition Indicates if Access Class 5 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

182 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 183: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.23 (AC 6) - (AC_6)

HMI Name AC 6Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_6

Definition Indicates if Access Class 6 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 183 / 1176

Page 184: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.24 (AC 7) - (AC_7)

HMI Name AC 7Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_7

Definition Indicates if Access Class 7 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

184 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 185: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.25 (AC 8) - (AC_8)

HMI Name AC 8Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_8

Definition Indicates if Access Class 8 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 185 / 1176

Page 186: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.26 (AC 9) - (AC_9)

HMI Name AC 9Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_9

Definition Indicates if Access Class 9 is barred.

Coding rules 0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

186 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 187: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.27 (ADDITIONAL_RESELECT_PARAM) -(ADDITIONAL_RESELECT_PARAM)

HMI Name ADDITIONAL_RESELECT_PARAMParameter Name

Logical Name ADDITIONAL_RESELECT_PARAM

Definition Indicates if C2 cell selection parameters are present inSYS_INFO_7&8 or SYS_INFO_4.

Coding rules 1bit; 0= the SI 4 rest octets, if present, are used to derive the value ofPI and possibly C2 parameters.1= the value of PI and possibly C2parameters in a SYS INFO TYPE or message 8 are used

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 187 / 1176

Page 188: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.28 (AG_PREMPT_PCH) - (AG_PREMPT_PCH)

HMI Name AG_PREMPT_PCHParameter Name

Logical Name AG_PREMPT_PCH

Definition Flag to enable pre-emption of Paging sub-channels for Access Grantmessages when there is one remaining free AGCH block.

Coding rules 0 = disabled, 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules Lets define the free AGCH blocks as the number of blocks remainingfor the AGCH messages when the BCCH extended block and NCHblocks have been excluded.- If there is no free AGCH block then theflag is not used (pre-emption mandatory, default value 0 is not used byBTS )- If there is only one free AGCH block then AG_PREMPT_PCH=1 or 0 (pre-emption allowed)- If there is more than one free AGCHthen AG_PREMPT_PCH = 0 (pre-emption forbidden).

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Ctrl Channel

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

188 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 189: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.29 (ALLOC_ANYWAY) - (ALLOC_ANYWAY)

HMI Name ALLOC_ANYWAYParameter Name

Logical Name ALLOC_ANYWAY

Definition Controls whether a queued request can be allocated on freeresource at expiry of its queuing timer independently of the thresholdNUM_TCH_EGNCY_HO.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / General HO Control

External Comment only relevant when NUM_TCH_EGNCY_HO > 0

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 189 / 1176

Page 190: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.30 (AMR_FR_HYST) - (AMR_FR_HYST)

HMI Name AMR_FR_HYSTParameter Name

Logical Name AMR_FR_HYST

Definition Hysteresis for AMR-NB FR codec mode adaptation.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 15 = 7.5 dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_FR_HYST +AMR_FR_THR_i <= 16dB (with i = 13).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 7.5 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset(12.2kbit/s, 7.95kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s).Significant only if EN_AMR_FR isset to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

190 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 191: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.31 (AMR_FR_SUBSET) - (AMR_FR_SUBSET)

HMI Name AMR_FR_SUBSETParameter Name

Logical Name AMR_FR_SUBSET

Definition Bitmap (8 bits) defining the codec subset that shall be used forAMR-NB FR calls (1 to 4 codecs).

Coding rules bit 8 (most significant)=1: 12,2 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 7=1:10,2 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 6=1: 7,95 kbit/s is part of thesubset; bit 5=1: 7,40 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 4=1: 6,70 kbit/sis part of the subset; bit 3=1: 5,90 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit2=1: 5,15 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 1 (least significant)=1: 4,75kbit/s is part of the subset

Mandatory rules In one subset a maximum of 4 codec modes can be chosen (amaximum of 4 bits can be set to 1).

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 240 164

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment Default value corresponds to an optimal codec subset:12.2kbit/s,7.95kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 191 / 1176

Page 192: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.32 (AMR_FR_THR_1) - (AMR_FR_THR_1)

HMI Name AMR_FR_THR_1Parameter Name

Logical Name AMR_FR_THR_1

Definition Threshold for AMR-NB FR codec mode adaptation between lowestcodec mode and second lowest codec mode.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules AMR_FR_THR_1 <= AMR_FR_THR_2

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_FR_HYST +AMR_FR_THR_1 <= 16dB.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 31.5 6.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset(12.2kbit/s, 7.95kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s). AMR_FR_THR_1 is not used ifless than 2 codecs are in the AMR FR subset.Significant only ifEN_AMR_FR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

192 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 193: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.33 (AMR_FR_THR_2) - (AMR_FR_THR_2)

HMI Name AMR_FR_THR_2Parameter Name

Logical Name AMR_FR_THR_2

Definition Threshold for AMR-NB FR codec mode adaptation between secondlowest codec mode and third lowest codec mode.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules AMR_FR_THR_3 >= AMR_FR_THR_2 >= AMR_FR_THR_1

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_FR_HYST +AMR_FR_THR_2 <= 16dB.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 31.5 11.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset(12.2kbit/s, 7.95kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s). AMR_FR_THR_2 is not used ifless than 3 codecs are in the AMR FR subset.Significant only ifEN_AMR_FR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 193 / 1176

Page 194: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.34 (AMR_FR_THR_3) - (AMR_FR_THR_3)

HMI Name AMR_FR_THR_3Parameter Name

Logical Name AMR_FR_THR_3

Definition Threshold for AMR-NB FR codec mode adaptation between thirdlowest codec mode and fourth lowest codec mode.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules AMR_FR_THR_3 >= AMR_FR_THR_2

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_FR_HYST +AMR_FR_THR_3 <= 16dB.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 31.5 11.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset(12.2kbit/s, 7.95kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s). AMR_FR_THR_3 is not used ifless than 4 codecs are in the AMR FR subset.Significant only ifEN_AMR_FR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

194 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 195: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.35 (AMR_HR_HYST) - (AMR_HR_HYST)

HMI Name AMR_HR_HYSTParameter Name

Logical Name AMR_HR_HYST

Definition Hysteresis for AMR-NB HR codec mode adaptation.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 15 = 7.5 dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_HR_HYST +AMR_HR_THR_i <= 16dB (with i = 13).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 7.5 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset(7.4kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s, 5.15kbit/s).Significant only if EN_AMR_HR isset to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 195 / 1176

Page 196: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.36 (AMR_HR_SUBSET) - (AMR_HR_SUBSET)

HMI Name AMR_HR_SUBSETParameter Name

Logical Name AMR_HR_SUBSET

Definition Bitmap (6 bits) defining the codec subset that shall be used forAMR-NB HR calls (1 to 4 codecs).

Coding rules Coded on 1 byte. Bit 8 (most significant) = Bit 7 = 0; bit 6 =1: 7,95kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 5=1: 7,40 kbit/s is part of the subset;bit 4=1: 6,70 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 3=1: 5,90 kbit/s is partof the subset; bit 2=1: 5,15 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 1 (leastsignificant)=1: 4,75 kbit/s is part of the subset;

Mandatory rules In one subset a maximum of 4 codec modes can be chosen (amaximum of 4 bits can be set to 1). The subset shall not contain only7.4 kbit/s codec mode. The codec mode 7.95 kbit/s is not supportedby Alcatel BSS.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 60 22

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset(7.4kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s, 5.15kbit/s).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

196 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 197: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.37 (AMR_HR_THR_1) - (AMR_HR_THR_1)

HMI Name AMR_HR_THR_1Parameter Name

Logical Name AMR_HR_THR_1

Definition Threshold for AMR-NB HR codec mode adaptation between lowestcodec mode and second lowest codec mode.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules AMR_HR_THR_1 <= AMR_HR_THR_2

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_HR_HYST +AMR_HR_THR_1 <= 16dB.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 31.5 11

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset(7.4kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s, 5.15kbit/s). AMR_HR_THR_1 is not used ifless than 2 codecs are in the AMR HR subset.Significant only ifEN_AMR_HR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 197 / 1176

Page 198: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.38 (AMR_HR_THR_2) - (AMR_HR_THR_2)

HMI Name AMR_HR_THR_2Parameter Name

Logical Name AMR_HR_THR_2

Definition Threshold for AMR-NB HR codec mode adaptation between secondlowest codec mode and third lowest codec mode.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules AMR_HR_THR_3 >= AMR_HR_THR_2 >= AMR_HR_THR_1

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_HR_HYST +AMR_HR_THR_2 <= 16dB.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 31.5 12.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset(7.4kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s, 5.15kbit/s). AMR_HR_THR_2 is not used ifless than 3 codecs are in the AMR HR subset.Significant only ifEN_AMR_HR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

198 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 199: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.39 (AMR_HR_THR_3) - (AMR_HR_THR_3)

HMI Name AMR_HR_THR_3Parameter Name

Logical Name AMR_HR_THR_3

Definition Threshold for AMR-NB HR codec mode adaptation between thirdlowest codec mode and fourth lowest codec mode.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules AMR_HR_THR_3 >= AMR_HR_THR_2

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_HR_HYST +AMR_HR_THR_3 <= 16dB.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 31.5 12.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset(7.4kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s, 5.15kbit/s). AMR_HR_THR_3 is not used ifless than 4 codecs are in the AMR HR subset.Significant only ifEN_AMR_HR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 199 / 1176

Page 200: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.40 (AMR_START_MODE_FR) - (AMR_START_MODE_FR)

HMI Name AMR_START_MODE_FRParameter Name

Logical Name AMR_START_MODE_FR

Definition Indicates the codec used at the beginning of a AMR-NB FR call, untilcodec mode adaptation is started by the BTS.

Coding rules 0: implicit rule is used for initial codec mode; 1: lowest codec modeof the subset; 2: second lowest codec mode (used if the subsetcontains more than one codec mode); 3: third lowest codec mode(used if the subset contains more than two codec modes); 4: highestcodec mode (used if the subset contains four codec modes)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 4 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

200 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 201: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.41 (AMR_START_MODE_HR) - (AMR_START_MODE_HR)

HMI Name AMR_START_MODE_HRParameter Name

Logical Name AMR_START_MODE_HR

Definition Indicates the codec used at the beginning of a AMR-NB HR call, untilcodec mode adaptation is started by the BTS.

Coding rules 0: implicit rule is used for initial codec mode; 1: lowest codec modeof the subset; 2: second lowest codec mode (used if the subsetcontains more than one codec mode); 3: third lowest codec mode(used if the subset contains more than two codec modes); 4: highestcodec mode (used if the subset contains four codec modes)

Mandatory rules If AMR_START_MODE_HR is explicit (I.e. not equal to 0), thechosen codec mode shall not correspond to 7.40 kbit/s.

Recommended rules Use codec mode 6.7 kbit/s as start mode for AMR-NB HR shouldbe avoided.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 4 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC &SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 201 / 1176

Page 202: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.42 (AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1) - (AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1)

HMI Name AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1Parameter Name

Logical Name AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1

Definition Hysteresis for AMR-WB GMSK codec mode adaptation, for transitionbetween lowest codec mode and second lowest codec mode.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 15 = 7.5 dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16 dB,following rules is highly recommended : AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1+ AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1 <= 16dB.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 7.5 2.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

202 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 203: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.43 (AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2) - (AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2)

HMI Name AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2Parameter Name

Logical Name AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2

Definition Hysteresis for AMR-WB GMSK codec mode adaptation, for transitionbetween highest codec mode and second lowest codec mode.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 15 = 7.5 dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16 dB,following rules is highly recommended : AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2+ AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2 <= 16dB.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 7.5 2.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 203 / 1176

Page 204: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.44 (AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1) - (AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1)

HMI Name AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1Parameter Name

Logical Name AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1

Definition Threshold for AMR-WB GMSK codec mode adaptation betweenlowest codec mode and second lowest codec mode.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1 < AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16 dB,following rule is highly recommended : AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1 +AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1 <= 16dB.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 31.5 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

204 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 205: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.45 (AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2) - (AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2)

HMI Name AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2Parameter Name

Logical Name AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2

Definition Threshold for AMR-WB GMSK codec mode adaptation betweensecond lowest codec mode and highest codec mode.

Coding rules step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1 < AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2

Recommended rules As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16 dB,following rule is highly recommended : AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2 +AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2 <= 16dB.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 31.5 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 205 / 1176

Page 206: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.46 (AUTO_BAR_BSS_OVERLOAD) - (EN_BSS_OVRL_CLASS_BAR)

HMI Name AUTO_BAR_BSS_OVERLOADParameter Name

Logical Name EN_BSS_OVRL_CLASS_BAR

Definition This flag enables/disables access class automatic barring uponBTS/BSC overload.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

206 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 207: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.47 (AUTO_BAR_CELL) - (AUT_BAR)

HMI Name AUTO_BAR_CELLParameter Name

Logical Name AUT_BAR

Definition This flag enables/inhibits automatic barring of cell.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 207 / 1176

Page 208: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.48 (AUTO_BAR_EC) - (EC_BAR)

HMI Name AUTO_BAR_ECParameter Name

Logical Name EC_BAR

Definition This flag enables/disables automatic barring of Emergency Class.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

208 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 209: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.49 (Automatic AC barring on TCH load) - (EN_LOAD_MNGT)

HMI Name Automatic AC barring on TCH loadParameter Name

Logical Name EN_LOAD_MNGT

Definition This flag enables/disables automatic barring of access classes onTCH load criterion.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 209 / 1176

Page 210: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.50 (B_NUM) - (B_NUM)

HMI Name B_NUMParameter Name

Logical Name B_NUM

Definition Number of BLOCK/UNBLOCK messages sent in one burst.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 35 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

210 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 211: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.51 (BCC) - (BCC (BSC))

HMI Name BCCParameter Name

Logical Name BCC (BSC)

Definition BTS colour code of the cell.

Coding rules coded over 3 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to BCC (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description (+ Edit External cell/ circuit1/2)

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 211 / 1176

Page 212: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.52 (BCC) - (BCC (MFS))

HMI Name BCCParameter Name

Logical Name BCC (MFS)

Definition BTS colour code of the cell.

Coding rules coded over 3 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to BCC (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description (+ Edit External cell/ circuit1/2)

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

212 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 213: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.53 (BCC) - (BCC (n))

HMI Name BCCParameter Name

Logical Name BCC (n)

Definition BTS colour code of the adjacent cell.

Coding rules coded over 3 bits

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit External Cell / Circuit 1/2

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 213 / 1176

Page 214: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.54 (BCCH_ARFCN) - (BCCH_ARFCN(n))

HMI Name BCCH_ARFCNParameter Name

Logical Name BCCH_ARFCN(n)

Definition Absolute Radio Frequency Channel Number of the BCCH of theadjacent cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules - BCCH_FREQUENCY(n) = BCCH_ARFCN(n)- In a cell whereFREQUENCY_RANGE = "EGSM" or "EGSM-DCS1800", theBCCH ARFCN belonging to the G1 band may be selected by theoperator, only if EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY<>0, and, for theconcentric cells, only in the outer zone. These restrictions do notapply to external cells.- for serving cell handled by a pre-MR4BSC: There shall be no more than 31 different BCCH frequenciesfor the set of all cells which are target for reselection of the sameserving cell if EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION(MFS) <>Disabled and FDD_ARFCN_LIST(BSC) is not empty.-for NonEvolium serving cell handled by a BSC from MR4 onwards : Thereshall be no more than 31 different BCCH frequencies for the setof all cells which are target for reselection of that same servingcell if EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION <> Disabled andFDD_ARFCN_LIST(BSC) is not empty.- For Evolium serving cellhandled by a BSC from MR4 onwards : There shall be no more than32 different BCCH frequencies for the set of all target cells.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1023 None

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

214 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 215: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.55 (BCCH_ARFCN) - (BCCH_FREQUENCY(n))

HMI Name BCCH_ARFCNParameter Name

Logical Name BCCH_FREQUENCY(n)

Definition Indicates the frequency used as BCCH.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules - BCCH_FREQUENCY(n) = BCCH_ARFCN(n)- In a cell whereFREQUENCY_RANGE = "EGSM" or "EGSM-DCS1800", theBCCH ARFCN belonging to the G1 band may be selected by theoperator, only if EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY<>0, and, for theconcentric cells, only in the outer zone. These restrictions do notapply to external cells.- for serving cell handled by a pre-MR4BSC: There shall be no more than 31 different BCCH frequenciesfor the set of all cells which are target for reselection of the sameserving cell if EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION(MFS) <>Disabled and FDD_ARFCN_LIST(BSC) is not empty.-for NonEvolium serving cell handled by a BSC from MR4 onwards : Thereshall be no more than 31 different BCCH frequencies for the setof all cells which are target for reselection of that same servingcell if EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION <> Disabled andFDD_ARFCN_LIST(BSC) is not empty.- For Evolium serving cellhandled by a BSC from MR4 onwards : There shall be no more than32 different BCCH frequencies for the set of all target cells.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1023 None

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 215 / 1176

Page 216: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.56 (BCCH_EXT) - (BCCH_EXT)

HMI Name BCCH_EXTParameter Name

Logical Name BCCH_EXT

Definition This flag enables / disables the use of extended BCCH.

Coding rules 0: false, 1:true

Mandatory rules -BCCH_EXT cannot be set to true if the associated BTS is anon-Evolium one.-When EN_SOLSA is enabled, the BCCH_EXTshall be set to true.-When EN_VGCS is disabled :. if BCCH_EXT= true, then BS_AG_BLKS_RES >= 1-When EN_VGCSis enabled : . if BCCH_EXT = false, BS_AG_BLKS_RES>= NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS . if BCCH_EXT = true, thenBS_AG_BLKS_RES > NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS

Recommended rules The support of extended BCCH (parameter BCCH_EXT) is HIGHLYrecommended in cells having adjacent cells in several frequencybands and at least 18 adjacent frequencies within the same band.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Radio Channel Config / TRX Configuration

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

216 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 217: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.57 (BS_AG_BLKS_RES) - (BS_AG_BLKS_RES (BSC))

HMI Name BS_AG_BLKS_RESParameter Name

Logical Name BS_AG_BLKS_RES (BSC)

Definition Number of CCCH blocks reserved for the access grant channel(AGCH).

Coding rules coded on 3 bits (000 : 0, ...111 : 7)

Mandatory rules -BS_AG_BLKS_RES (MFS) = BS_AG_BLKS_RES (BSC) for agiven cell-when CCCH_CONF=0 and CBCH is configured in thecell, BS_AG_BLKS_RES>0- when CCCH_CONF=2, max value ofBS_AG_BLKS_RES is 7 and BS_AG_BLKS_RES must be > 0 ifCBCH is configured in the cell.-When EN_VGCS is disabled :. ifBCCH_EXT = true, then BS_AG_BLKS_RES >= 1-When EN_VGCSis enabled : . if BCCH_EXT = false, then BS_AG_BLKS_RES>= NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS . if BCCH_EXT = true, thenBS_AG_BLKS_RES > NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment Maximum and Default values given for CCCH_CONF=0ForCCCH_CONF=1, max=2, def=1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 217 / 1176

Page 218: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.58 (BS_P_CON_ACK) - (BS_P_CON_ACK)

HMI Name BS_P_CON_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name BS_P_CON_ACK

Definition Supervision of the BS Power Control procedure.

Coding rules step size=1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

2 x Samfr 0 31 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Single 3

Umbrella 3

Concentric 3

Concentric Umbrella 3

Microcell 2

Minicell 3

Extended inner cell 3

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 3

Nb of TRX Dependent No

218 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 219: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.59 (BS_P_CON_INT) - (BS_P_CON_INT)

HMI Name BS_P_CON_INTParameter Name

Logical Name BS_P_CON_INT

Definition Minimum delay between two consecutive BS power commands.

Coding rules step size=1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

2 x Samfr 0 31 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Single 1

Umbrella 1

Concentric 1

Concentric Umbrella 1

Microcell 0

Minicell 1

Extended inner cell 1

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 1

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 219 / 1176

Page 220: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.60 (BS_PA_MFRMS) - (BS_PA_MFRMS (BSC))

HMI Name BS_PA_MFRMSParameter Name

Logical Name BS_PA_MFRMS (BSC)

Definition Number of 51 frame multiframes between consecutive occurrencesof a Paging Group.

Coding rules coded on 3 bits (000 : 2, ... 111: 9)

Mandatory rules BS_PA_MFRMS (BSC) = BS_PA_MFRMS (MFS) for a given cell

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 2 9 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment The bigger this parameter is, the lesser the MS power consumptionis.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

220 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 221: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.61 (BS_TXPWR_MAX) - (BS_TXPWR_MAX (BSC))

When a cell is shared, the BS_TX_POWER_MAX andBS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNER powers must always be defined against theactual physical power of the main sector. If the actual power of the secondarysector is lower than the actual power of the main sector, the operator has toadjust the values of BS_TX_POWER_MAX and BS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNERto avoid requiring too high an output power than is actually available.

HMI Name BS_TXPWR_MAXParameter Name

Logical Name BS_TXPWR_MAX (BSC)

Definition This parameter defines the power reduction relative to the maximumGMSK output power of the BTS.

Coding rules step size = 2dB. 0: 0 dB, 1: -2dB, ..., 15: -30dB

Mandatory rules BS_TXPWR_MAX >= BS_TXPWR_MINEqual to BS_TXPWR_MAX(MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -30 0 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment The BTS maximum allowed transmit power is defined relatively tothe BTS maximum RF transmit power in GMSK (due to hardwarelimitation).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 221 / 1176

Page 222: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.62 (BS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER) - (BS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER (BSC))

When a cell is shared, the BS_TX_POWER_MAX andBS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNER powers must always be defined against theactual physical power of the main sector. If the actual power of the secondarysector is lower than the actual power of the main sector, the operator has toadjust the values of BS_TX_POWER_MAX and BS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNERto avoid requiring too high an output power than is actually available.

HMI Name BS_TXPWR_MAX_INNERParameter Name

Logical Name BS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER (BSC)

Definition This parameter defines the power reduction relative to the maximumGMSK output power of the TRX of the inner zone in a concentricor multi-band cell.

Coding rules step size = 2dB. 0: 0 dB, 1: -2dB, ..., 15: -30dB

Mandatory rules Equal to BS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER (MFS) andBS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER >= BS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -30 0 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment The BTS maximum allowed transmit power is defined relatively tothe BTS maximum RF transmit power in GMSK (due to hardwarelimitation).Default value depends on configuration. The valueindicated here is for implementation purposes.

222 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 223: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric #

Concentric Umbrella #

Microcell N/A

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 223 / 1176

Page 224: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.63 (BS_TXPWR_MIN) - (BS_TXPWR_MIN)

HMI Name BS_TXPWR_MINParameter Name

Logical Name BS_TXPWR_MIN

Definition BTS minimum allowed transmission power.

Coding rules step size = 2dB. 0: 0 dB, 1: -2dB, ..., 15: -30dB

Mandatory rules BS_TXPWR_MIN <= BS_TXPWR_MAXBS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER>= BS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -30 0 -24

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

224 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 225: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.64 (BSC Primary X25 Address) - (BSC_X25_primary_address)

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 AddressParameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address

Definition BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 0 to 15 characters string. *: default = empty string

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem OMC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 *

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 225 / 1176

Page 226: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.65 (BSC Primary X25 Address [1]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [1])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [1]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [1]

Definition First character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

226 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 227: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.66 (BSC Primary X25 Address [10]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i[10])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [10]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [10]

Definition Tenth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 227 / 1176

Page 228: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.67 (BSC Primary X25 Address [11]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i[11])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [11]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [11]

Definition Eleventh character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

228 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 229: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.68 (BSC Primary X25 Address [12]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i[12])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [12]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [12]

Definition Twelfth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 229 / 1176

Page 230: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.69 (BSC Primary X25 Address [13]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i[13])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [13]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [13]

Definition Thirteenth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

230 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 231: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.70 (BSC Primary X25 Address [14]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i[14])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [14]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [14]

Definition Fourteenth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 231 / 1176

Page 232: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.71 (BSC Primary X25 Address [15]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i[15])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [15]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [15]

Definition Fifteenth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

232 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 233: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.72 (BSC Primary X25 Address [2]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [2])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [2]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [2]

Definition Second character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 233 / 1176

Page 234: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.73 (BSC Primary X25 Address [3]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [3])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [3]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [3]

Definition Third character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

234 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 235: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.74 (BSC Primary X25 Address [4]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [4])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [4]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [4]

Definition Fourth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 235 / 1176

Page 236: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.75 (BSC Primary X25 Address [5]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [5])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [5]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [5]

Definition Fifth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

236 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 237: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.76 (BSC Primary X25 Address [6]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [6])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [6]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [6]

Definition Sixth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 237 / 1176

Page 238: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.77 (BSC Primary X25 Address [7]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [7])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [7]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [7]

Definition Seventh character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

238 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 239: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.78 (BSC Primary X25 Address [8]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [8])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [8]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [8]

Definition Eighth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 239 / 1176

Page 240: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.79 (BSC Primary X25 Address [9]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [9])

HMI Name BSC Primary X25 Address [9]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_primary_address_i [9]

Definition Ninth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

240 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 241: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.80 (BSC Secondary X25 Address) - (BSC_X25_secondary_address)

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 AddressParameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address

Definition BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 0 to 15 characters string. *: default = empty string

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem OMC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 *

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 241 / 1176

Page 242: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.81 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [1]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [1])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [1]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [1]

Definition First character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

242 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 243: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.82 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [10]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [10])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [10]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [10]

Definition Tenth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 243 / 1176

Page 244: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.83 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [11]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [11])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [11]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [11]

Definition Eleventh character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

244 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 245: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.84 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [12]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [12])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [12]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [12]

Definition Twelfth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 245 / 1176

Page 246: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.85 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [13]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [13])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [13]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [13]

Definition Thirteenth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

246 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 247: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.86 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [14]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [14])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [14]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [14]

Definition Fourteenth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 247 / 1176

Page 248: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.87 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [15]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [15])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [15]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [15]

Definition Fifteenth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

248 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 249: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.88 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [2]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [2])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [2]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [2]

Definition Second character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 249 / 1176

Page 250: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.89 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [3]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [3])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [3]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [3]

Definition Third character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

250 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 251: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.90 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [4]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [4])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [4]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [4]

Definition Fourth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 251 / 1176

Page 252: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.91 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [5]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [5])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [5]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [5]

Definition Fifth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

252 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 253: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.92 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [6]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [6])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [6]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [6]

Definition Sixth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 253 / 1176

Page 254: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.93 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [7]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [7])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [7]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [7]

Definition Seventh character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

254 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 255: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.94 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [8]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [8])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [8]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [8]

Definition Eighth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 255 / 1176

Page 256: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.95 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [9]) -(BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [9])

HMI Name BSC Secondary X25 Address [9]Parameter Name

Logical Name BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [9]

Definition Ninth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

256 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 257: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.96 (BSC Signalling Point Code) - (OPC)

HMI Name BSC Signalling Point CodeParameter Name

Logical Name OPC

Definition Signalling Point Code of the BSC.

Coding rules coded over 14 bits

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 16383 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: EML RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access BSS parameters / A interface info

External Comment Must be equal to DPC and SSF used by the MSC for adressing theBSC. Default value depends on configuration. The value indicatedhere is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 257 / 1176

Page 258: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.97 (BSC_EN_RF_RES_IND) - (BSC_EN_RF_RES_IND)

HMI Name BSC_EN_RF_RES_INDParameter Name

Logical Name BSC_EN_RF_RES_IND

Definition Enables/disables the RF RESOURCE INDICATION processing bythe BSC.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

258 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 259: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.98 (BSIC) - (BSIC (GSM))

HMI Name BSICParameter Name

Logical Name BSIC (GSM)

Definition Concatenation of the NCC and the BCC.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Abstract

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None # # #

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 259 / 1176

Page 260: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.99 (BTS_Queue_Length) - (BTS_Q_LENGTH)

HMI Name BTS_Queue_LengthParameter Name

Logical Name BTS_Q_LENGTH

Definition Maximum number of Assignment Requests and Handover Requeststhat can be queued simultaneously.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 64 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

4 4 6 6 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

260 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 261: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.100 (CALL_RE_ESTABLISHMENT) - (RE)

HMI Name CALL_RE_ESTABLISHMENTParameter Name

Logical Name RE

Definition This flag indicates to the MS if call reestablishment is allowed in thecell.

Coding rules 0: allowed, 1: not allowed

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 261 / 1176

Page 262: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.101 (Call_User_Data_Selector) - (Call_user_data_sel)

HMI Name Call_User_Data_SelectorParameter Name

Logical Name Call_user_data_sel

Definition Identifies the higher protocol selector for an outgoing connection.

Coding rules 0 to 16 bytes string

Mandatory rules Can be changed only when SMSCB_State is disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here isfor implementation purposes.Each byte of the string can get a valuein the range [0..255].

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

262 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 263: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.102 (Candidate cell priority) - (PRIORITY(0,n))

HMI Name Candidate cell priorityParameter Name

Logical Name PRIORITY(0,n)

Definition Priority of the cell n in the HO candidate cell evaluation process.

Coding rules 0: highest priority, 5: lowest priority

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 5 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 263 / 1176

Page 264: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.103 (CAPTURE_TRAFFIC_CONDITION) -(CAPTURE_TRAFFIC_CONDITION)

HMI Name CAPTURE_TRAFFIC_CONDITIONParameter Name

Logical Name CAPTURE_TRAFFIC_CONDITION

Definition This parameter determines the condition on traffic load in the servingcell to trigger a "general capture" handover.

Coding rules 0: Any load, 1: Not low, 2: High

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

264 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 265: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.104 (CBC Primary X25 Address) - (CBC_X25_primary_address)

HMI Name CBC Primary X25 AddressParameter Name

Logical Name CBC_X25_primary_address

Definition CBC X25 primary address.

Coding rules 0 to 15 characters string. *: default = empty string

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: changeable RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN management/Modify Peer Entities

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 265 / 1176

Page 266: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.105 (CBC Secondary X25 Address) - (CBC_X25_secondary_address)

HMI Name CBC Secondary X25 AddressParameter Name

Logical Name CBC_X25_secondary_address

Definition CBC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules 0 to 15 characters string. *: default = empty string

Mandatory rules changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: changeable RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access DCN management/Modify Peer Entities

External Comment The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

266 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 267: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.106 (CBC_Operator) - (Operator)

HMI Name CBC_OperatorParameter Name

Logical Name Operator

Definition Identifies the CBC operator.

Coding rules 0 to 20 characters string (default = empty string) are sent by theOMC on the OMC/BSC interface . BSC performs the padding ofOMC string with space characters on the right side of the string until20 bytes are reached. At Upload, OMC RNL removes padded spacecharacters from the retrieved BSC value.

Mandatory rules Can be changed only when SMSCB_State is disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 267 / 1176

Page 268: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.107 (CBC_Password) - (Password)

HMI Name CBC_PasswordParameter Name

Logical Name Password

Definition CBC password.

Coding rules 0 to 20 characters string (default = empty string) are sent by theOMC on the OMC/BSC interface. BSC performs the padding of OMCstring with space characters on the right side of the string until 20bytes are reached. At Upload, OMC RNL removes padded spacecharacters from the retrieved BSC value.

Mandatory rules Can be changed only when SMSCB_State is disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

268 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 269: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.108 (CBC_Window) - (CBC_window)

HMI Name CBC_WindowParameter Name

Logical Name CBC_window

Definition Maximum number of outstanding primitives on the BSC/CBCinterface for both incoming and outgoing primitives.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Can be changed only when SMSCB_State is disabledshall be set to"1" when SMSCB_FEATURE_SET="FS1"

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment Default value corresponds to SMSCB_FEATURE_SET = FS1.IfSMSCB_FEATURE_SET = FS2, CBC_Window should be set to 3.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 269 / 1176

Page 270: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.109 (CCCH_LOAD_IND_PERIOD) - (RACHRT)

HMI Name CCCH_LOAD_IND_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name RACHRT

Definition Minimum delay between two consecutive sendings of CCCH LOADINDICATION messages.

Coding rules step size=1 (51mfr)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules RACHRT > RACH_LOAD_MEAS_PER

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

51mfr 1 255 255

Modifiable OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

270 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 271: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.110 (CCCH_LOAD_MEAS_PERIOD) - (RACH_LOAD_MEAS_PER)

HMI Name CCCH_LOAD_MEAS_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name RACH_LOAD_MEAS_PER

Definition Period over which CCCH load measurements are made.

Coding rules step size=1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules RACH_LOAD_MEAS_PER < RACHRT

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

51mfr 1 255 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 271 / 1176

Page 272: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.111 (Cell Type) - (Cell_Type)

HMI Name Cell TypeParameter Name

Logical Name Cell_Type

Definition Combination of CELL_DIMENSION_TYPE, CELL_LAYER_TYPE,CELL_PARTITION_TYPE, CELL_RANGE for an OMC own cell.Used for cell default parameter template.

Coding rules Single (0), Concentric (1), Umbrella (2), Micro (3), UmbrellaConcentric (4), Mini (5), Extended Inner (6), Extended Outer (7),Mini Concentric (8), Micro Concentric (9), Indoor (10), IndoorConcentric(11)

Mandatory rules - EN_SYNCHRONISED_HO shall be set to disabled whenCELL_TYPE is equal to "Extended inner" or "Extended outer".Acouple of mate cells (Extended inner + extended outer) shall havethe same LAC (respectively RAC when they are PS capable).-The "micro concentric", "mini concentric" and "indoor concentric"cells must be multiband (the allowed FREQUENCY_RANGE is"PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800"). This restriction does notapply to the external cells.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Abstract

SubSystem OMC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None * * #

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes:SEL/PAG/RRM/HPC/HOC/DIR/GPR

Parameter Access Create Cell(+ External OMC cell information)

External Comment *: possible values are:- Single- Umbrella- Umbrella Concentric-Micro- Mini- Micro Concentric- Mini Concentric - Indoor- IndoorConcentric (labelled "Indoor Multiband" on the HMI)- Extended Inner-Extended Outer

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

272 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 273: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.112 (CELL_BAR_QUALIFY) - (CELL_BAR_QUALIFY)

HMI Name CELL_BAR_QUALIFYParameter Name

Logical Name CELL_BAR_QUALIFY

Definition Indicates the priority of the cell for cell selection.

Coding rules 0: normal priority, 1: low priority

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 273 / 1176

Page 274: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.113 (CELL_EVALUATION) - (CELL_EV)

HMI Name CELL_EVALUATIONParameter Name

Logical Name CELL_EV

Definition Handover cell evaluation process applied in the cell.

Coding rules 0: Order, 1: Grade

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Single grade (1)

Umbrella grade (1)

Concentric grade (1)

Concentric Umbrella grade (1)

Microcell order (0)

Minicell grade (1)

Extended inner cell grade (1)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell grade (1)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

274 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 275: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.114 (CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS) -(CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS)

HMI Name CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESISParameter Name

Logical Name CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS

Definition Level hysteresis for cell reselection applied when the new cell is in adifferent location area or, for a GPRS MS, in a different routing area,or when a GPRS MS is in GMM ready state.

Coding rules step size = 2dB; coded on 3 bits (000 : 0 dB, 111 : 14 dB)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 14 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment If the VGCS is licensed, the parameter is modifiable only via theprovisioning context of the OMC.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 275 / 1176

Page 276: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.115 (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET) - (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(BSC))

HMI Name CELL_RESELECT_OFFSETParameter Name

Logical Name CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (BSC)

Definition Permanent offset to C2 criterion.

Coding rules step size = 2dB; coded on 6 bits (000000:0 dB, 111111 : 126 dB)

Mandatory rules CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (MFS) = CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 126 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

276 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 277: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.116 (CELL_RESELECT_PARAM_IND) -(CELL_RESELECT_PARAM_IND)

HMI Name CELL_RESELECT_PARAM_INDParameter Name

Logical Name CELL_RESELECT_PARAM_IND

Definition Indicates to the MS if parameters for C2 reselection criterion arebroadcast.

Coding rules 0: not present, 1: present

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 277 / 1176

Page 278: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.117 (Cell_Type) - (Cell_Type (n))

HMI Name Cell_TypeParameter Name

Logical Name Cell_Type (n)

Definition Combination of CELL_DIMENSION_TYPE, CELL_LAYER_TYPE,CELL_PARTITION_TYPE, CELL_RANGE for an adjacent cell (OMCown cell or OMC external cell).

Coding rules Single (0), Concentric (1), Umbrella (2), Micro (3), UmbrellaConcentric (4), Mini (5), Extended Inner (6), Extended Outer (7),Mini Concentric (8), Micro Concentric (9), Indoor (10), IndoorConcentric(11), GAN(12)

Mandatory rules - EN_SYNCHRONISED_HO shall be set to disabled whenCELL_TYPE is equal to "Extended inner" or "Extended outer".Acouple of mate cells (Extended inner + extended outer) shall have thesame LAC (respectively RAC when they are PS capable).- The "microconcentric", "mini concentric" and "indoor concentric" cells must bemultiband (the allowed FREQUENCY_RANGE is "PGSM-DCS1800"or "EGSM-DCS1800"). This restriction does not apply to the externalcells.The "GAN" value is allowed only for external cells.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Abstract

SubSystem OMC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None * * #

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment *: possible values are:- Single- Umbrella- Umbrella Concentric-Micro- Mini- Micro Concentric- Mini Concentric - Indoor- IndoorConcentric (labelled "Indoor Multiband" on the HMI)- Extended Inner-Extended Outer- GAN

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

278 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 279: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.118 (CI) - (CI (BSC))

HMI Name CIParameter Name

Logical Name CI (BSC)

Definition Cell Identity.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual to CI(MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 65535 65535

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description ( + Edit External cell/ circuit1/2)

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 279 / 1176

Page 280: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.119 (CI) - (CI(n)(BSC))

HMI Name CIParameter Name

Logical Name CI(n)(BSC)

Definition Cell Identity of adjacent cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual toCI(n)(MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 65535 65535

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

280 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 281: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.120 (Ciphering Algorithms Priority 1) - (BSS_CIPH_LIST (Priority 1))

HMI Name Ciphering Algorithms Priority 1Parameter Name

Logical Name BSS_CIPH_LIST (Priority 1)

Definition List of encryption algorithms in their prioritized order.

Coding rules coded as an array of 7 bytes. Each byte contains a reference to anencryption algorithm: 1 for A5/1, ... 7 for A5/7.

Mandatory rules The same encryption algorithm reference cannot be used for twodifferent priorities

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type List of numbers

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 2 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Ciphering

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 281 / 1176

Page 282: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.121 (Ciphering Algorithms Priority 2) - (BSS_CIPH_LIST (Priority 2))

HMI Name Ciphering Algorithms Priority 2Parameter Name

Logical Name BSS_CIPH_LIST (Priority 2)

Definition List of encryption algorithms in their prioritized order.

Coding rules coded as an array of 7 bytes. Each byte contains a reference to anencryption algorithm: 1 for A5/1, ... 7 for A5/7.

Mandatory rules The same encryption algorithm reference cannot be used for twodifferent priorities

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type List of numbers

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 2 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

282 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 283: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.122 (ciphering capabilities) - (BTS_CIPH_CAP)

HMI Name ciphering capabilitiesParameter Name

Logical Name BTS_CIPH_CAP

Definition List of flags indicating what are the BTS ciphering capabilities.

Coding rules Coded as a 8 bits bitmap. Each bit indicates if correspondingencryption algorithm is supported.bit 1 (LSB) : no encryption. bit 2 :A5/1. bit 3 : A5/2...bit 8 : A5/7. bit x =0: encryption not supported.bit x =1: encryption supported

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BTS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: Displayed(EML) RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Create/Modify/Copy/Move BTS / Additional information

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 283 / 1176

Page 284: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.123 (Circuit Identity Code) - (CIC)

HMI Name Circuit Identity CodeParameter Name

Logical Name CIC

Definition Circuit Identity Code of an A interface circuit.

Coding rules Coded over 16 bits: top 11 bits = pcm number, remaining 5 bits =TS number

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance A ch

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 65535 65535

Modifiable OMC Changes: displayed(EML) RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access BSS parameters / A interface info

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

284 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 285: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.124 (DELTA_DEC_HO_MARGIN) - (DELTA_DEC_HO_margin)

HMI Name DELTA_DEC_HO_MARGINParameter Name

Logical Name DELTA_DEC_HO_margin

Definition Correction factor favouring handover cause "Power budget" whentraffic is high in the serving cell and low in neighbour cell(s).

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 24 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Single 5 dB (5)

Umbrella 5 dB (5)

Concentric 5 dB (5)

Concentric Umbrella 5 dB (5)

Microcell 4 dB (4)

Minicell 5 dB (5)

Extended inner cell 5 dB (5)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 5 dB (5)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 285 / 1176

Page 286: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.125 (DELTA_INC_HO_MARGIN) - (DELTA_INC_HO_margin)

HMI Name DELTA_INC_HO_MARGINParameter Name

Logical Name DELTA_INC_HO_margin

Definition Correction factor penalizing handover cause "Power budget" whentraffic is low in the serving cell and high in neighbour cell(s).

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 24 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Single 5 dB (5)

Umbrella 5 dB (5)

Concentric 5 dB (5)

Concentric Umbrella 5 dB (5)

Microcell 4 dB (4)

Minicell 5 dB (5)

Extended inner cell 5 dB (5)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 5 dB (5)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

286 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 287: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.126 (Directed_Retry) - (EN_DR)

HMI Name Directed_RetryParameter Name

Logical Name EN_DR

Definition This flag enables/disables the execution of Directed Retry.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: DIR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Directed Retry

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 287 / 1176

Page 288: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.127 (DL_DTX_AMR_WB_GMSK) - (DL_DTX_AMR_WB_GMSK)

HMI Name DL_DTX_AMR_WB_GMSKParameter Name

Logical Name DL_DTX_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition This flag enables / disables the use of downlink DTX for AMR-WBGMSK speech calls.

Coding rules 0 : DL DTX for AMR-WB GMSK disabled, 1 : DL DTX for AMR-WBGMSK enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules The value "1" is recommended when EN_TFO_AMR_WB =1

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

288 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 289: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.128 (Downlink DTX) - (DOWNLINK_DTX_ENABLE)

HMI Name Downlink DTXParameter Name

Logical Name DOWNLINK_DTX_ENABLE

Definition This flag defines if downlink DTX is allowed for FR and EFR calls.

Coding rules 0: DTX not allowed, 1: DTX allowed

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules should be enabled when EN_TFO = 1

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 289 / 1176

Page 290: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.129 (DOWNLINK_DTX_AMR_FR) - (Downlink_DTX_enable_AMR_FR)

HMI Name DOWNLINK_DTX_AMR_FRParameter Name

Logical Name Downlink_DTX_enable_AMR_FR

Definition This flag enables / disables the use of downlink DTX for AMR-NBFR speech calls.

Coding rules 0 : DL DTX for AMR FR disabled, 1 : DL DTX for AMR FR enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

290 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 291: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.130 (DOWNLINK_DTX_AMR_HR) - (Downlink_DTX_enable_AMR_HR)

HMI Name DOWNLINK_DTX_AMR_HRParameter Name

Logical Name Downlink_DTX_enable_AMR_HR

Definition This flag enables / disables the use of downlink DTX for AMR-NBHR speech calls.

Coding rules 0 : DL DTX for AMR HR disabled, 1 : DL DTX for AMR HR enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 291 / 1176

Page 292: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.131 (DOWNLINK_DTX_HR) - (Downlink_DTX_enable_HR)

HMI Name DOWNLINK_DTX_HRParameter Name

Logical Name Downlink_DTX_enable_HR

Definition This flag enables / disables the use of downlink DTX for HR speechcalls.

Coding rules 0 : DL DTX for HR disabled, 1 : DL DTX for HR enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules should be enabled when EN_TFO = 1

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

292 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 293: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.132 (DTX_FR_INDICATOR) - (DTX_INDICATOR_FR)

HMI Name DTX_FR_INDICATORParameter Name

Logical Name DTX_INDICATOR_FR

Definition Controls uplink DTX usage for GSM Phase 1 and 2 for FR. Appliesfor all codecs types except AMR.

Coding rules coding rules : 0: MS May Use DTX for FR 1: MS Shall Use DTX forFR, 2: MS shall not use DTX for FR

Mandatory rules The following combinations between DTX_INDICATOR_FR /DTX_INDICATOR_HR are possible (FR/HR):may/shall, may/shallnot, may/may, shall/shall, shall/shall not, shall/may, shall not/shalland shall not/shall not.The only combination that is NOT allowed is:DTX_INDICATOR_FR = shall not and DTX_INDICATOR_HR = may,I.e. shall not/may.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem OMC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 293 / 1176

Page 294: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.133 (DTX_FR_INDICATOR_AMR) - (DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR)

HMI Name DTX_FR_INDICATOR_AMRParameter Name

Logical Name DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR

Definition Controls uplink DTX usage for GSM phase 2 MS. Applies only forAMR-NB FR.

Coding rules 0: MS May Use DTX for AMR FR 1: MS Shall Use DTX for AMR FR,2: MS shall not use DTX for AMR FR

Mandatory rules The following combinations between DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR/ DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR are possible (FR_AMR /HR_AMR):may/shall, may/shall not, may/may, shall/shall, shall/shallnot, shall/may, shall not/shall and shall not/shall not.The onlycombination that is NOT allowed is: DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR =shall not and DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR = may, I.e. shall not/may.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem OMC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

294 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 295: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.134 (DTX_HR_INDICATOR) - (DTX_INDICATOR_HR)

HMI Name DTX_HR_INDICATORParameter Name

Logical Name DTX_INDICATOR_HR

Definition Controls uplink DTX usage for GSM phase 2 for HR. Applies for allcodecs types except AMR.

Coding rules 0: MS May Use DTX for HR 1: MS Shall Use DTX for HR, 2: MSshall not use DTX for HR

Mandatory rules The following combinations between DTX_INDICATOR_FR /DTX_INDICATOR_HR are possible (FR/HR):may/shall, may/shallnot, may/may, shall/shall, shall/shall not, shall/may, shall not/shalland shall not/shall not.The only combination that is NOT allowed is:DTX_INDICATOR_FR = shall not and DTX_INDICATOR_HR = may,I.e. shall not/may.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem OMC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 295 / 1176

Page 296: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.135 (DTX_HR_INDICATOR_AMR) - (DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR)

HMI Name DTX_HR_INDICATOR_AMRParameter Name

Logical Name DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR

Definition Controls uplink DTX usage for GSM phase 2 MS. Applies only forAMR-NB HR.

Coding rules 0: MS May Use DTX for AMR HR 1: MS Shall Use DTX for AMR HR,2: MS shall not use DTX for AMR HR

Mandatory rules The following combinations between DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR/ DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR are possible (FR_AMR /HR_AMR):may/shall, may/shall not, may/may, shall/shall, shall/shallnot, shall/may, shall not/shall and shall not/shall not.The onlycombination that is NOT allowed is: DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR =shall not and DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR = may, I.e. shall not/may.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem OMC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

296 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 297: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.136 (DWELL_TIME_STEP) - (DWELL_TIME_STEP)

HMI Name DWELL_TIME_STEPParameter Name

Logical Name DWELL_TIME_STEP

Definition Step value for the modification (increasing or decreasing) ofMIN_DWELL_TIME.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 30 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 297 / 1176

Page 298: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.137 (EDR_ASSIGN_FAIL_CAUSE) - (EDR_ASSIGN_FAIL_CAUSE)

HMI Name EDR_ASSIGN_FAIL_CAUSEParameter Name

Logical Name EDR_ASSIGN_FAIL_CAUSE

Definition This parameter determines the cause filled in ASSIGNMENTFAILURE sent in case of External Directed Retry.

Coding rules coded over 8 bits

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 127 13

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / External Direct retry

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

298 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 299: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.138 (EDR_MSG_ORDER) - (EDR_MSG_ORDER)

HMI Name EDR_MSG_ORDERParameter Name

Logical Name EDR_MSG_ORDER

Definition This parameter determines the order of transmission ofASSIGNMENT FAILURE and HANDOVER REQUIRED on the Ainterface in case of an External Directed Retry.

Coding rules 0: Ass Failure before HO Reqd, 1: Ass Failure after HO Reqd

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / External Direct retry

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 299 / 1176

Page 300: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.139 (EDR_QUEUING_MAINTAINED) - (EDR_QUEUING_MAINTAINED)

HMI Name EDR_QUEUING_MAINTAINEDParameter Name

Logical Name EDR_QUEUING_MAINTAINED

Definition This flag indicates whether or not Assignment Request is maintainedin queue during External Directed Retry attempt.

Coding rules 0: Request not maintained in queue, 1: Request maintained in queue

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / External Direct retry

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

300 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 301: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.140 (EDR_SEND_ASSIGN_FAIL) - (EDR_SEND_ASSIGN_FAIL)

HMI Name EDR_SEND_ASSIGN_FAILParameter Name

Logical Name EDR_SEND_ASSIGN_FAIL

Definition This flag indicates whether ASSIGNMENT FAILURE is sent to theMSC in case of External Directed Retry.

Coding rules 0: Assignment Failure not sent, 1: Assignment Failure sent

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / External Direct retry

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 301 / 1176

Page 302: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.141 (EFR_ENABLED) - (EFR_ENABLED)

HMI Name EFR_ENABLEDParameter Name

Logical Name EFR_ENABLED

Definition This flag indicates whether the operation of enhanced full rate (EFR)is allowed in the cell.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

302 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 303: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.142 (EMERGENCY_CALL) - (EC)

HMI Name EMERGENCY_CALLParameter Name

Logical Name EC

Definition Indicates if Emergency calls are allowed for all access classes oronly for access classes 11 to 15.

Coding rules 0: all access classes, 1: access classes 11 to 15 only

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 303 / 1176

Page 304: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.143 (EN_4_DR_TRE_PER_TCU) - (EN_4_DR_TRE_PER_TCU)

HMI Name EN_4_DR_TRE_PER_TCUParameter Name

Logical Name EN_4_DR_TRE_PER_TCU

Definition Defines if the limitation of TRE is static or dynamic. For staticlimitation only Nb FR TRE + 2 x DR TRE < 200 is allowed. Fordynamic limitation only Nb TRE < 200 is allowed.

Coding rules 0: static1:dynamic

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

304 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 305: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.144 (EN_AMR_CA_FR_HR) - (EN_AMR_CA_FR_HR)

HMI Name EN_AMR_CA_FR_HRParameter Name

Logical Name EN_AMR_CA_FR_HR

Definition This flag enables/disables intracell HO for AMR-NB channeladaptation (Handover Cause 27).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules EN_AMR_CA_FR_HR can be enabled only if {EN_AMR_FR=1 ANDEN_AMR_HR=1}

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 305 / 1176

Page 306: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.145 (EN_AMR_CA_HR_FR) - (EN_AMR_CA_HR_FR)

HMI Name EN_AMR_CA_HR_FRParameter Name

Logical Name EN_AMR_CA_HR_FR

Definition This flag enables/disables intracell HO for AMR-NB channeladaptation (Handover Cause 26).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules EN_AMR_CA_HR_FR can be enabled only if {EN_AMR_FR=1 ANDEN_AMR_HR=1}

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

306 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 307: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.146 (EN_AMR_FR) - (EN_AMR_FR)

HMI Name EN_AMR_FRParameter Name

Logical Name EN_AMR_FR

Definition This flag controls whether or not AMR-NB full rate is allowed in thecell.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 307 / 1176

Page 308: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.147 (EN_AMR_HR) - (EN_AMR_HR)

HMI Name EN_AMR_HRParameter Name

Logical Name EN_AMR_HR

Definition This flag controls whether or not AMR-NB half rate is allowed in thecell.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

308 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 309: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.148 (EN_AMR_WB_GMSK) - (EN_AMR_WB_GMSK)

HMI Name EN_AMR_WB_GMSKParameter Name

Logical Name EN_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition This flag controls whether or not AMR WB GMSK is allowed in thecell.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules In front of non-Evolium cells, the parameter value shall be forced to 0.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 309 / 1176

Page 310: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.149 (EN_BALANCED_CI) - (EN_BALANCED_CI)

HMI Name EN_BALANCED_CIParameter Name

Logical Name EN_BALANCED_CI

Definition This flag enables/disables to balance the C/I measure.

Coding rules 0:disable, 1: enable

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X / Description

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

310 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 311: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.150 (EN_BETTER_ZONE_HO) - (EN_BETTER_ZONE_HO)

HMI Name EN_BETTER_ZONE_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_BETTER_ZONE_HO

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "too high level in outerzone" handover cause (cause 13).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric enable (1)

Concentric Umbrella enable (1)

Microcell N/A

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 311 / 1176

Page 312: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.151 (EN_BI-BAND_MS(n)) - (EN_BI-BAND_MS(n))

HMI Name EN_BI-BAND_MS(n)Parameter Name

Logical Name EN_BI-BAND_MS(n)

Definition This flag enables/disables the incoming handovers of bi-band MSsfrom the preferred band.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control (+ Edit Externalcell / circuit1/2)

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

312 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 313: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.152 (EN_BS_PC) - (EN_BS_PC)

HMI Name EN_BS_PCParameter Name

Logical Name EN_BS_PC

Definition This flag enables/disables BS Power Control.

Coding rules 0: disabled1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 313 / 1176

Page 314: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.153 (EN_CIRCUIT_GROUP) - (EN_CIRCUIT_GROUP)

HMI Name EN_CIRCUIT_GROUPParameter Name

Logical Name EN_CIRCUIT_GROUP

Definition This flag enables/disables the sending of Circuit group messages.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

314 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 315: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.154 (EN_DIST_HO) - (EN_DIST_HO)

HMI Name EN_DIST_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_DIST_HO

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "distance" handovercause (cause 6).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Distance

External Comment –

Single enable (1)

Umbrella enable (1)

Concentric enable (1)

Concentric Umbrella enable (1)

Microcell disable (0)

Minicell enable (1)

Extended inner cell enable (1)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell enable (1)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 315 / 1176

Page 316: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.155 (EN_EDR) - (EN_EXT_DR)

HMI Name EN_EDRParameter Name

Logical Name EN_EXT_DR

Definition This flag enables/disables the Outgoing External Directed Retryprocedure.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules EN_EXT_DR should be set to enable when EN_TCH_PREEMPT isset to enable.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / External Direct retry

External Comment For external directed retries, the serving BSC does not know whetheror not the external target cells (towards which the directed retryis triggered) are congested. Therefore, Alcatel recommend to setRESP_REQ to 1 if EN_EDR is enabled in order to get a HandoverReject message from the MSC in case all target cells are congestedand thus to attempt other procedures.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

316 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 317: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.156 (EN_EXT_MEAS_REP) - (EN_EXT_MEAS_REP)

HMI Name EN_EXT_MEAS_REPParameter Name

Logical Name EN_EXT_MEAS_REP

Definition This flag enables/disables the extended measurement reporting forMobile Assisted Frequency Allocation.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / RMS & MAFA

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 317 / 1176

Page 318: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.157 (EN_FAST_TRAFFIC_HO) - (EN_FAST_TRAFFIC_HO)

HMI Name EN_FAST_TRAFFIC_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_FAST_TRAFFIC_HO

Definition This flag enables/disables the use of Fast traffic handovers.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

318 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 319: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.158 (EN_FORCED_DR) - (EN_FORCED_DR)

HMI Name EN_FORCED_DRParameter Name

Logical Name EN_FORCED_DR

Definition This flag enables/disables the "Forced Directed Retry" handovercause detection.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Directed Retry

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 319 / 1176

Page 320: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.159 (EN_GAN_HO) - (EN_GAN_HO)

HMI Name EN_GAN_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_GAN_HO

Definition This flag enables/disables the handover to GAN

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

320 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 321: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.160 (EN_GENERAL_CAPTURE_HO) - (EN_GENERAL_CAPTURE_HO)

HMI Name EN_GENERAL_CAPTURE_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_GENERAL_CAPTURE_HO

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "general capture"handover cause (cause 24).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and Multiband HO ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 321 / 1176

Page 322: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.161 (EN_HSL) - (EN_HSL)

HMI Name EN_HSLParameter Name

Logical Name EN_HSL

Definition Enables SS7 HSL (High speed Signalling Link).

Coding rules 0: HSL disabled1: HSL enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Changeable on the BSC terminal.if EN_HSL = 1 the followingnew Q703 parameters:Q703_N1_HSL, Q_703_N2_HSL,Q703_T1_HSL, Q703_T4E_HSL and Q703_T4N_HSLreplacesthe old ones:Q703_N1, Q_703_N2, Q703_T1, Q703_T4E andQ703_T4N.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

322 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 323: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.162 (EN_IMM_ASS_REJ) - (EN_IM_ASS_REJ)

HMI Name EN_IMM_ASS_REJParameter Name

Logical Name EN_IM_ASS_REJ

Definition This flag indicates if the Immediate Assignment Reject procedureis enabled.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment This parameter is only valid for circuit switched traffic. For packettraffic (GPRS or EGPRS) sending of IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENTREJECT messages cannot be disabled.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 323 / 1176

Page 324: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.163 (EN_INCOMING_HO) - (EN_IC_HO)

HMI Name EN_INCOMING_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_IC_HO

Definition This flag enables/disables incoming handovers in the cell.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

324 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 325: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.164 (EN_INTERBAND_HO) - (EN_INTERBAND_NEIGH)

HMI Name EN_INTERBAND_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_INTERBAND_NEIGH

Definition This flag enables / disables the multiband operation by filtering thesending of SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 2ter/5ter.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 325 / 1176

Page 326: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.165 (EN_INTRA_DL) - (EN_INTRA_DL)

HMI Name EN_INTRA_DLParameter Name

Logical Name EN_INTRA_DL

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell downlink"handover cause (cause 16) for non AMR calls.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

326 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 327: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.166 (EN_INTRA_DL_AMR) - (EN_INTRA_DL_AMR)

HMI Name EN_INTRA_DL_AMRParameter Name

Logical Name EN_INTRA_DL_AMR

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell downlink"handover cause (cause 16) for AMR-NB calls.

Coding rules 0: disable, 1: enable

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to disable this intracell uplink handover whenfrequency hopping is applied

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 327 / 1176

Page 328: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.167 (EN_INTRA_DL_AMR_WB_GMSK) -(EN_INTRA_DL_AMR_WB_GMSK)

HMI Name EN_INTRA_DL_AMR_WB_GMSKParameter Name

Logical Name EN_INTRA_DL_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell downlink"handover cause (cause 16)

Coding rules 0: disable, 1: enable

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to disable this intracell uplink handover whenfrequency hopping is applied.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

328 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 329: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.168 (EN_INTRA_UL) - (EN_INTRA_UL)

HMI Name EN_INTRA_ULParameter Name

Logical Name EN_INTRA_UL

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell uplink" handovercause (cause 15) for non AMR calls.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 329 / 1176

Page 330: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.169 (EN_INTRA_UL_AMR) - (EN_INTRA_UL_AMR)

HMI Name EN_INTRA_UL_AMRParameter Name

Logical Name EN_INTRA_UL_AMR

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell uplink" handovercause (cause 15) for AMR-NB calls.

Coding rules 0: disable, 1: enable

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to disable this intracell uplink handover whenfrequency hopping is applied

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

330 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 331: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.170 (EN_INTRA_UL_AMR_WB_GMSK) -(EN_INTRA_UL_AMR_WB_GMSK)

HMI Name EN_INTRA_UL_AMR_WB_GMSKParameter Name

Logical Name EN_INTRA_UL_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell uplink" handovercause (cause 15) for AMR-WB GMSK calls.

Coding rules 0: disable, 1: enable

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to disable this intracell uplink handover whenfrequency hopping is applied.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 331 / 1176

Page 332: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.171 (EN_INTRACELL_REPEATED) - (EN_INTRACELL_REPEATED)

HMI Name EN_INTRACELL_REPEATEDParameter Name

Logical Name EN_INTRACELL_REPEATED

Definition This flag enables/disables the repetition of intracell handoverattempts.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

332 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 333: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.172 (EN_LOAD_BALANCE) - (EN_LOAD_BALANCE)

HMI Name EN_LOAD_BALANCEParameter Name

Logical Name EN_LOAD_BALANCE

Definition Flag to enable/disable the balancing of load between the inner andouter zone of a multiband cell.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules EN_LOAD_BALANCE & EN_LOAD_OUTER should not be both"Enabled".

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell /HO Parameters / Hierarchical & Multiband HO Control

External Comment EN_LOAD_BALANCE significant only if EN_BETTER_ZONE_HOis enabled

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric disable (0)

Concentric Umbrella disable (0)

Microcell N/A

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 333 / 1176

Page 334: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.173 (EN_LOAD_ORDER) - (EN_LOAD_ORDER)

HMI Name EN_LOAD_ORDERParameter Name

Logical Name EN_LOAD_ORDER

Definition This flag indicates whether or not traffic load has to be taken intoaccount when setting up the list of target cells.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

334 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 335: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.174 (EN_MA_SELECTION) - (EN_MA_SELECTION)

HMI Name EN_MA_SELECTIONParameter Name

Logical Name EN_MA_SELECTION

Definition This flag enables/disables channel selection according to MobileAllocation criterion.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 335 / 1176

Page 336: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.175 (EN_MCHO_H_DL) - (EN_MCHO_H_DL)

HMI Name EN_MCHO_H_DLParameter Name

Logical Name EN_MCHO_H_DL

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "level downlink micro-cell"handover cause (cause 18).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment –

Single disable (0) *

Umbrella disable (0) *

Concentric disable (0) *

Concentric Umbrella disable (0) *

Microcell enable (1)

Minicell disable (0) *

Extended inner cell disable (0) *

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell disable (0) *

Nb of TRX Dependent No

336 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 337: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.176 (EN_MCHO_H_UL) - (EN_MCHO_H_UL)

HMI Name EN_MCHO_H_ULParameter Name

Logical Name EN_MCHO_H_UL

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "level uplink mirco-cell "handover cause (cause 17).

Coding rules 0: disabled1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment –

Single disable (0) *

Umbrella disable (0) *

Concentric disable (0) *

Concentric Umbrella disable (0) *

Microcell enable (1)

Minicell disable (0) *

Extended inner cell disable (0) *

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell disable (0) *

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 337 / 1176

Page 338: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.177 (EN_MCHO_NCELL) - (EN_MCHO_NCELL)

HMI Name EN_MCHO_NCELLParameter Name

Logical Name EN_MCHO_NCELL

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "high level in neighbourlower or indoor cell" handover cause (cause 14).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In a lower layer cell, the flag shall be disabled if there is no indoorlayer.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment –

Single disable (0) *

Umbrella enable (1)

Concentric disable (0) *

Concentric Umbrella enable (1)

Microcell disable (0)

Minicell disable (0)

Extended inner cell disable (0) *

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell disable (0) *

Nb of TRX Dependent No

338 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 339: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.178 (EN_MCHO_RESCUE) - (EN_MCHO_RESCUE)

HMI Name EN_MCHO_RESCUEParameter Name

Logical Name EN_MCHO_RESCUE

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "consecutive bad SACCHframes" handover cause (cause 7).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment –

Single disable (0) *

Umbrella disable (0) *

Concentric disable (0) *

Concentric Umbrella disable (0) *

Microcell enable (1)

Minicell disable (0) *

Extended inner cell disable (0) *

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell disable (0) *

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 339 / 1176

Page 340: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.179 (EN_MS_PC) - (EN_MS_PC)

HMI Name EN_MS_PCParameter Name

Logical Name EN_MS_PC

Definition This flag enables/disables MS Power Control.

Coding rules 0: disabled1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

340 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 341: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.180 (EN_MULTIBAND_PBGT_HO) - (EN_MULTIBAND_PBGT_HO)

HMI Name EN_MULTIBAND_PBGT_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_MULTIBAND_PBGT_HO

Definition This flag enables/disables the power budget handovers Cause 12and the traffic handovers Cause 23 between cells belonging todifferent frequency bands.

Coding rules 0 : function disabled, 1 : function enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 341 / 1176

Page 342: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.181 (EN_PBGT_FILTERING) - (EN_PBGT_FILTERING)

HMI Name EN_PBGT_FILTERINGParameter Name

Logical Name EN_PBGT_FILTERING

Definition This flag enables/disables filtering of candidate neighbour cells onHO_MARGIN_DIST/LEV/QUAL criterion.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules This parameter must be set to disabled in case of extended cell

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Single enable (1)

Umbrella enable (1)

Concentric enable (1)

Concentric Umbrella enable (1)

Microcell disable (0)

Minicell enable (1)

Extended inner cell disable (0)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell disable (0)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

342 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 343: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.182 (EN_PBGT_HO) - (EN_PBGT_HO)

HMI Name EN_PBGT_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_PBGT_HO

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "power budget" handovercause (cause 12).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 343 / 1176

Page 344: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.183 (EN_PREFERRED_BAND_HO) - (EN_PREFERRED_BAND_HO)

HMI Name EN_PREFERRED_BAND_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_PREFERRED_BAND_HO

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of handover cause 21 (highlevel in neighbour cell in the preferred band).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

344 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 345: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.184 (EN_PRIORITY_ORDERING) - (EN_PRIORITY_ORDERING)

HMI Name EN_PRIORITY_ORDERINGParameter Name

Logical Name EN_PRIORITY_ORDERING

Definition This flag enables/disables the use of the parameter PRIORITY(0,n)in the candidate cell evaluation process.

Coding rules 0: Priority(0,n) not taken into account, 1: Priority(0,n) taken intoaccount

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 345 / 1176

Page 346: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.185 (EN_RADIOLINK_RECOVERY) - (EN_RL_RECOV)

HMI Name EN_RADIOLINK_RECOVERYParameter Name

Logical Name EN_RL_RECOV

Definition This flag enables/disables the Radio Link Recovery procedure.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / Radio Link Supervision

External Comment –

Single enable (1)

Umbrella enable (1)

Concentric enable (1)

Concentric Umbrella enable (1)

Microcell enable (1)

Minicell enable (1)

Extended inner cell enable (1)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell enable (1)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

346 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 347: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.186 (EN_RESCUE_UMBRELLA) - (EN_RESCUE_UM)

HMI Name EN_RESCUE_UMBRELLAParameter Name

Logical Name EN_RESCUE_UM

Definition This flag determines if emergency handovers are directedpreferentially to umbrella cells.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled, 2: indefinite

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric N/A

Concentric Umbrella N/A

Microcell enable (1)

Minicell disable (0)

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 347 / 1176

Page 348: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.187 (EN_RETURN_CS_ZONE_HO) - (EN_RETURN_CS_ZONE_HO)

HMI Name EN_RETURN_CS_ZONE_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_RETURN_CS_ZONE_HO

Definition Flag enabling the intracell handovers allowing to move TCH from thePS zone to the CS zone of PDCH/TCH allocation

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

348 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 349: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.188 (EN_RXLEV_DL) - (EN_RXLEV_DL)

HMI Name EN_RXLEV_DLParameter Name

Logical Name EN_RXLEV_DL

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "level downlink" handovercause (cause 5).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 349 / 1176

Page 350: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.189 (EN_RXLEV_UL) - (EN_RXLEV_UL)

HMI Name EN_RXLEV_ULParameter Name

Logical Name EN_RXLEV_UL

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "level uplink" handovercause (cause 3).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

350 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 351: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.190 (EN_RXQUAL_DL) - (EN_RXQUAL_DL)

HMI Name EN_RXQUAL_DLParameter Name

Logical Name EN_RXQUAL_DL

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "quality downlink"handover cause (cause 4).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 351 / 1176

Page 352: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.191 (EN_RXQUAL_UL) - (EN_RXQUAL_UL)

HMI Name EN_RXQUAL_ULParameter Name

Logical Name EN_RXQUAL_UL

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "quality uplink" handovercause (cause 2).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

352 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 353: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.192 (EN_SEND_OLD_CHAN_MODE) - (EN_SEND_OLD_CHAN_MODE)

HMI Name EN_SEND_OLD_CHAN_MODEParameter Name

Logical Name EN_SEND_OLD_CHAN_MODE

Definition This flag controls "Current channel" OIE inclusion in HANDOVERREQUIRED.

Coding rules 0: IE is not included, 1: IE is included

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 353 / 1176

Page 354: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.193 (EN_SEND_SPEECH_VER) - (EN_SEND_SPEECH_VER)

HMI Name EN_SEND_SPEECH_VERParameter Name

Logical Name EN_SEND_SPEECH_VER

Definition This flag controls "Speech version (used)" OIE inclusion inHANDOVER REQUIRED.

Coding rules 0: IE is not included, 1: IE is included

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

354 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 355: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.194 (EN_SOLSA) - (EN_SOLSA)

HMI Name EN_SOLSAParameter Name

Logical Name EN_SOLSA

Definition This flag enables / disables SoLSA feature.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules May be set to Enabled only if BCCH_EXT=TRUE.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 3/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 355 / 1176

Page 356: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.195 (EN_SOLSA) - (EN_SOLSA(n))

HMI Name EN_SOLSAParameter Name

Logical Name EN_SOLSA(n)

Definition This flag enables / disables SoLSA feature.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit External Cell / Circuit 2/2

External Comment This parameter is for every cell. The operator needs only to configurethe value of that parameter for OMC external cells ; the parameteris autonomously filled by the OMC in case the adjacent cell is anOMC internal cell.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

356 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 357: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.196 (EN_SPEED_DISCRIMINATION) - (EN_SPEED_DISC)

HMI Name EN_SPEED_DISCRIMINATIONParameter Name

Logical Name EN_SPEED_DISC

Definition This flag enables/disables the speed discrimination process.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment –

Single disable (0) *

Umbrella disable (0)

Concentric disable (0) *

Concentric Umbrella disable (0)

Microcell disable (0)

Minicell disable (0)

Extended inner cell disable (0) *

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell disable (0) *

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 357 / 1176

Page 358: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.197 (EN_TCH_PREEMPT) - (EN_TCH_PREEMPT)

HMI Name EN_TCH_PREEMPTParameter Name

Logical Name EN_TCH_PREEMPT

Definition This flag enables/disables the TCH/VGCH pre-emption feature. Ifenabled, a point-to-point or voice group call with the pvi (pre-emptionvulnerability indication) bit set might be pre-empted for a point-to-pointor voice group call that has the pci (pre-emption capability indication)bit set if the concerned cell is in congestion state.

Coding rules 0:disabled, 1:enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules - EN_EXT_DR should be set to enable when EN_TCH_PREEMPT isset to enable.- If EN_VGCS = enabled , then Alcatel recommends toset EN_TCH_PREEMPT to enabled, otherwise to set the value ofMIN_VGCS_TS to a value greater or equal to 2.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Gen. Timers & Proc.

External Comment In case one or more TCHs have been reserved for emergencyhandovers (NUM_TCH_EGNCY_HO > 0) in the concerned cell,the BSC will first try to use one of these resources before actuallyreleasing an ongoing call with lower priority and the pvi bit set.Incase the cell is congested, if EN_TCH_PREEMPT is enabled andthe MSC does not allow the queing, the BSC will queue an incomingpoint-to-point request with pre-emption capability indicator set duringat most T11_forced seconds for a normal assignment or during atmost T_qho seconds for an handover request. For the voice groupcall request, the BSC will follow the MSC indicator.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

358 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 359: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.198 (EN_TFO) - (EN_TFO)

HMI Name EN_TFOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_TFO

Definition This flag enables/ disables TFO function for FR, EFR and HR codecs.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 359 / 1176

Page 360: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.199 (EN_TFO_AMR_WB) - (EN_TFO_AMR_WB)

HMI Name EN_TFO_AMR_WBParameter Name

Logical Name EN_TFO_AMR_WB

Definition This flag enables/ disables TFO function for AMR-WB codec.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules -

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

360 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 361: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.200 (EN_TFO_MATCH) - (EN_TFO_MATCH)

HMI Name EN_TFO_MATCHParameter Name

Logical Name EN_TFO_MATCH

Definition This flag enables/disables TFO codec mismatch resolution function(for FR, EFR and HR codecs).

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules may be set to 1 only if EN_TFO=1or if EN_TFO_WB_AMR=1May beset to 0 only if EN_TFO_OPT = 0

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 361 / 1176

Page 362: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.201 (EN_TFO_OPT) - (EN_TFO_OPT)

HMI Name EN_TFO_OPTParameter Name

Logical Name EN_TFO_OPT

Definition This flag enables/disables TFO codec optimisation function.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules may be set to 1 only if EN_TFO_MATCH=1

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

362 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 363: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.202 (EN_TRAFFIC_HO) - (EN_TRAFFIC_HO(0,n))

HMI Name EN_TRAFFIC_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_TRAFFIC_HO(0,n)

Definition This flag enables/disables the detection of "traffic" handover cause(cause 23).

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment As the traffic load of cells external to the BSC is unknown,no HO cause 23 will be triggered towards these cells, even ifEN_TRAFFIC_HO = 1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 363 / 1176

Page 364: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.203 (EN_UNEQUIPPED_CIRCUIT) - (EN_UNEQUIPPED_CIRCUIT)

HMI Name EN_UNEQUIPPED_CIRCUITParameter Name

Logical Name EN_UNEQUIPPED_CIRCUIT

Definition This flag enables/disables the sending of UNEQUIPPED CIRCUITmessage.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

364 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 365: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.204 (EXT_HO_FORCED) - (EXT_HO_FORCED)

HMI Name EXT_HO_FORCEDParameter Name

Logical Name EXT_HO_FORCED

Definition This flag, when set, forces internal intercell handovers to be executedas external HO.

Coding rules 0: BSC performs internal HO, 1: MSC performs internal HO

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 365 / 1176

Page 366: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.205 (Extended CBCH) - (Use_of_Extended_CBCH)

HMI Name Extended CBCHParameter Name

Logical Name Use_of_Extended_CBCH

Definition This flag indicates if the extended CBCH is used.

Coding rules 0: not used, 1: used

Mandatory rules shall be set to "No" when SMSCB_FEATURE_SET="FS1"can bechanged only when SMSCB_STATE="inactive"

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / SMSCB

External Comment Default value correspond to SMSCB_FEATURE_SET = FS1.IfSMSCB_FEATURE_SET = FS2, Use_of_Extended_CBCH shouldbe set to "Yes".

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

366 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 367: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.206 (FORBID_AMR_NS) - (FORBID_AMR_NS)

HMI Name FORBID_AMR_NSParameter Name

Logical Name FORBID_AMR_NS

Definition Flag to forbid / allow AMR noise suppressor in the MS.

Coding rules 0: the MS can use AMR NS, 1: the MS shall not use AMR NS.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment Significant only if EN_AMR_FR, EN_AMR_HR orEN_AMR_WB_GMSK is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 367 / 1176

Page 368: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.207 (FORBID_DTXD_NH_BCCH_F) - (FORBID_DTXD_NH_BCCH_F)

HMI Name FORBID_DTXD_NH_BCCH_FParameter Name

Logical Name FORBID_DTXD_NH_BCCH_F

Definition Forbid use of downlink DTX on non hopping TCH of the BCCH TRX.

Coding rules 0 : DTX DL on non-hopping BCCH TRX is allowed; 1 : DTX DL onnon-hopping BCCH TRX is forbidden

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General timers and procedures

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

368 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 369: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.208 (Force TFO versus AMR) - (FORCE_TFO_VS_AMR)

HMI Name Force TFO versus AMRParameter Name

Logical Name FORCE_TFO_VS_AMR

Definition Flag to enable/disable the basic functions of Tandem Free Operation(TFO) for GSM FR SV1, FR SV2 and HR SV1 codec types when thecurrent codec is AMR-NB FR or AMR-NB HR.

Coding rules 0: disabled (no TFO negotiation if AMR used); 1: enabled (TFOnegotiation will start even if AMR used)

Mandatory rules FORCE_TFO_VS_AMR = 1 only if EN_TFO=1

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment FORCE_TFO_VS_AMR relevant only if (EN_AMR_FR = 1) OR(EN_AMR_HR = 1)

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 369 / 1176

Page 370: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.209 (Forced_Queuing) - (QUEUE_ANYWAY)

HMI Name Forced_QueuingParameter Name

Logical Name QUEUE_ANYWAY

Definition This flag enables/disables forced queuing for Assignment requestswhen queuing is not allowed by the MSC.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

370 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 371: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.210 (Forward_CM_3) - (EN_SEND_CM3)

HMI Name Forward_CM_3Parameter Name

Logical Name EN_SEND_CM3

Definition This flag enables/disables sending of "Classmark 3" IE to the MSC.

Coding rules 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

Mandatory rules EN_SEND_CM3 and STRIP_O5_CM2 shall not be both set to 1 atthe same time.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment The value of this parameter depends on whether the MSC supportsthe MS classmark 3 IE or not: if the MSC supports the MS classmark3 IE then the parameter shall be set to "1", otherwise the parametershall be set to "0".

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 371 / 1176

Page 372: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.211 (Free_Factor_1) - (Freefactor_1)

HMI Name Free_Factor_1Parameter Name

Logical Name Freefactor_1

Definition Correction factor used in the cell evaluation process to take intoaccount the number of free TCHs in the candidate cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Freefactor_1 <= Freefactor_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -16 16 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

372 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 373: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.212 (Free_Factor_2) - (Freefactor_2)

HMI Name Free_Factor_2Parameter Name

Logical Name Freefactor_2

Definition Correction factor used in the cell evaluation process to take intoaccount the number of free TCHs in the candidate cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Freefactor_1 <= Freefactor_2 <= Freefactor_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -16 16 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 373 / 1176

Page 374: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.213 (Free_Factor_3) - (Freefactor_3)

HMI Name Free_Factor_3Parameter Name

Logical Name Freefactor_3

Definition Correction factor used in the cell evaluation process to take intoaccount the number of free TCHs in the candidate cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Freefactor_2 <= Freefactor_3 <= Freefactor_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -16 16 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

374 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 375: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.214 (Free_Factor_4) - (Freefactor_4)

HMI Name Free_Factor_4Parameter Name

Logical Name Freefactor_4

Definition Correction factor used in the cell evaluation process to take intoaccount the number of free TCHs in the candidate cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Freefactor_3 <= Freefactor_4 <= Freefactor_5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -16 16 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 375 / 1176

Page 376: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.215 (Free_Factor_5) - (Freefactor_5)

HMI Name Free_Factor_5Parameter Name

Logical Name Freefactor_5

Definition Correction factor used in the cell evaluation process to take intoaccount the number of free TCHs in the candidate cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Freefactor_5 >= Freefactor_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -16 16 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

376 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 377: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.216 (Free_Level_1) - (Freelevel_1)

HMI Name Free_Level_1Parameter Name

Logical Name Freelevel_1

Definition Boundary on free TCH number for determination of Freefactor ofthe cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Freelevel_1 < Freelevel_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

1 2 3 3 4 5 5 6 7 7 8 8

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 377 / 1176

Page 378: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.217 (Free_Level_2) - (Freelevel_2)

HMI Name Free_Level_2Parameter Name

Logical Name Freelevel_2

Definition Boundary on free TCH number for determination of Freefactor ofthe cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Freelevel_3 > Freelevel_2 > Freelevel_1

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

2 3 5 6 7 9 10 12 13 14 16 17

378 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 379: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.218 (Free_Level_3) - (Freelevel_3)

HMI Name Free_Level_3Parameter Name

Logical Name Freelevel_3

Definition Boundary on free TCH number for determination of Freefactor ofthe cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Freelevel_4 > Freelevel_3 > Freelevel_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

4 7 10 12 14 17 20 23 26 28 31 34

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 379 / 1176

Page 380: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.219 (Free_Level_4) - (Freelevel_4)

HMI Name Free_Level_4Parameter Name

Logical Name Freelevel_4

Definition Boundary on free TCH number for determination of Freefactor ofthe cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Freelevel_4 > Freelevel_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

6 9 12 15 21 26 30 34 38 42 47 51

380 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 381: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.220 (Free_Level_DR) - (Freelevel_DR(n))

HMI Name Free_Level_DRParameter Name

Logical Name Freelevel_DR(n)

Definition Minimum number of free TCHs in neighbour cell n to allow forceddirected retry to cell n.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules Freelevel_DR > N_TCH_HO

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: DIR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Directed Retry (+ Edit External cell /circuit1/2)

External Comment –

Single See TRXnb

Umbrella See TRXnb

Concentric See TRXnb

Concentric Umbrella See TRXnb

Microcell See TRXnb

Minicell See TRXnb

Extended inner cell 255 *

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 255 *

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 381 / 1176

Page 382: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.221 (FREQUENCY_RANGE) - (FREQUENCY_RANGE)

HMI Name FREQUENCY_RANGEParameter Name

Logical Name FREQUENCY_RANGE

Definition This parameter indicates the frequency range of the cell.

Coding rules 0: PGSM (GSM 900), 1: DCS 1800, 2: EGSM, 3: DCS 1900, 4:PGSM-DCS1800, 5: EGSM-DCS1800, 6: GSM 850, 7..255: forfuture use. The parameter shall be coded over 8 bits as a provisionfor future frequency bands support.

Mandatory rules - if FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM-DCS" thenCELL_PARTITION_TYPE must be equal to "Concentric" .-The "micro concentric", "mini concentric" and "indoor concentric"cells must be multiband (the allowed FREQUENCY_RANGE is"PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800"). This restriction does notapply to the external cells.- In a cell where FREQUENCY_RANGE= "EGSM" or "EGSM-DCS1800", the BCCH ARFCN belongingto the G1 band may be selected by the operator, only ifEGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY<>0, and, for the concentric cells,only in the outer zone. These restrictions do not apply to externalcells.- The frequency range of an extended inner cell has to bethe same as the frequency range of the corresponding extendedouter cell, where PGSM (0) and EGSM (2) are here consideredas belonging to the same frequency range.The OMC-R checksthe consistency between the setting of FREQUENCY_RANGEand PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS parameters:- At cellcreation- When the value of FREQUENCY_RANGE parameteris modified.However, no check is performed when thePLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is modified.Only the following valuesof the FREQUENCY_RANGE parameter are allowed dependingon the value of the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS parameter:-FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM (GSM900)" or "EGSM (GSM900)"or "DCS1800" or "PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800" if thePLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM900 and DCS1800bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM850" or "DCS1800" if thePLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM850 and DCS1800bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM850" or "DCS1900" if thePLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM850 and DCS1900bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM (GSM900)" or "EGSM(GSM900)" or "DCS1900" if the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is setto "GSM900 and DCS1900 bands".

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

382 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 383: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 6 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes:SEL/PAG/RRM/HPC/HOC/DIR/GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Description (+ Edit External cell / circuit1/2)

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 383 / 1176

Page 384: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.222 (FREQUENCY_RANGE) - (FREQUENCY_RANGE(n)(MFS))

HMI Name FREQUENCY_RANGEParameter Name

Logical Name FREQUENCY_RANGE(n)(MFS)

Definition This parameter indicates the frequency range of the adjacent cell(GAN cell excluded).

Coding rules 0: PGSM (GSM 900), 1: DCS 1800, 2: EGSM, 3: DCS 1900, 4:PGSM-DCS1800, 5: EGSM-DCS1800, 6: GSM 850, 7..255: forfuture use. The parameter shall be coded over 8 bits as a provisionfor future frequency bands support.

Mandatory rules - If FREQUENCY_RANGE(n) = "GSM-DCS" thenCELL_PARTITION_TYPE(n) must be equal to "Concentric". -The "micro concentric", "mini concentric" and "indoor concentric"cells must be multiband (the allowed FREQUENCY_RANGE(n) is"PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800"). This restriction does notapply to the external cells.- In a cell where FREQUENCY_RANGE(n)= "EGSM" or "EGSM-DCS1800", the BCCH ARFCN belongingto the G1 band may be selected by the operator, only ifEGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY<>0, and, for the concentric cells,only in the outer zone. These restrictions do not apply to externalcells.- The frequency range of an extended inner cell has to bethe same as the frequency range of the corresponding extendedouter cell, where PGSM (0) and EGSM (2) are here considered asbelonging to the same frequency range.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 6 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit external cell / circuit 1/2

External Comment Within the same PLMN, the FREQUENCY_RANGE parameter of agiven cell shall be selected among one of the following values:- PGSM(GSM900) or EGSM (GSM900) or DCS1800 or PGSM-DCS1800or EGSM-DCS1800 if the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is setto "GSM900 and DCS1800 bands",- GSM850 or DCS1800 if thePLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM850 and DCS1800bands",- GSM850 or DCS1900 if the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDSis set to "GSM850 and DCS1900 bands.

384 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 385: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 385 / 1176

Page 386: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.223 (FREQUENCY_RANGE) - (FREQUENCY_RANGE(n)(OMC))

HMI Name FREQUENCY_RANGEParameter Name

Logical Name FREQUENCY_RANGE(n)(OMC)

Definition This parameter indicates the frequency range of the adjacent cell(internal or external to the OMC).

Coding rules 0: PGSM (GSM 900), 1: DCS 1800, 2: EGSM, 3: DCS 1900, 4:PGSM-DCS1800, 5: EGSM-DCS1800, 6: GSM 850, 7: GAN,8..255: for future use. The parameter shall be coded over 8 bits as aprovision for future frequency bands support.

Mandatory rules - if FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM-DCS" thenCELL_PARTITION_TYPE must be equal to "Concentric" .-if FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GAN" then CELL_RANGE mustbe equal to "GAN"- the value GAN is only allowed for theOMC external cells- The "micro concentric", "mini concentric"and "indoor concentric" cells must be multiband (the allowedFREQUENCY_RANGE is "PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800").This restriction does not apply to the external cells.- In a cell whereFREQUENCY_RANGE = "EGSM" or "EGSM-DCS1800", the BCCHARFCN belonging to the G1 band may be selected by the operator,only if EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY<>0, and, for the concentriccells, only in the outer zone. These restrictions do not apply toexternal cells.- The frequency range of an extended inner cell has tobe the same as the frequency range of the corresponding extendedouter cell, where PGSM (0) and EGSM (2) are here consideredas belonging to the same frequency range.The OMC-R checksthe consistency between the setting of FREQUENCY_RANGEand PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS parameters:- At cellcreation- When the value of FREQUENCY_RANGE parameteris modified.However, no check is performed when thePLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is modified.Only the following valuesof the FREQUENCY_RANGE parameter are allowed dependingon the value of the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS parameter:-FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM (GSM900)" or "EGSM (GSM900)"or "DCS1800" or "PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800" if thePLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM900 and DCS1800bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM850" or "DCS1800" if thePLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM850 and DCS1800bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM850" or "DCS1900" if thePLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM850 and DCS1900bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM (GSM900)" or "EGSM(GSM900)" or "DCS1900" if the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is setto "GSM900 and DCS1900 bands".

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem OMC

386 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 387: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Value "7" exists only starting from MR2.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 387 / 1176

Page 388: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.224 (GSM_PHASE) - (GSM_PHASE)

HMI Name GSM_PHASEParameter Name

Logical Name GSM_PHASE

Definition This flag indicates the GSM Phase used by the BSC to formatmessages towards the MSC.

Coding rules 0: GSM Phase 1, 1: GSM Phase 2

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type.The value indicated here is forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

388 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 389: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.225 (H_LOAD_OBJ) - (H_LOAD_OBJ)

HMI Name H_LOAD_OBJParameter Name

Logical Name H_LOAD_OBJ

Definition High threshold on busy TCH timeslots percentage to reduceMIN_DWELL_TIME variable.

Coding rules step size = 10%

Mandatory rules H_LOAD_OBJ >= L_LOAD_OBJ

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 80

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella See TRXnb

Concentric N/A

Concentric Umbrella See TRXnb

Microcell N/A

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 389 / 1176

Page 390: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.226 (H_MIN_DWELL_TIME) - (H_MIN_DWELL_TIME)

HMI Name H_MIN_DWELL_TIMEParameter Name

Logical Name H_MIN_DWELL_TIME

Definition Maximum allowed value for MIN_DWELL_TIME variable.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules H_MIN_DWELL_TIME >= L_MIN_DWELL_TIME

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 120 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

390 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 391: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.227 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P1) -(AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=1))

HMI Name High Priority Access Class Ordering P1Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=1)

Definition List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority, 10(EC) is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (accessclass 12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14(access class 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 10 15 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 391 / 1176

Page 392: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.228 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P2) -(AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=2))

HMI Name High Priority Access Class Ordering P2Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=2)

Definition List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority 10 (EC)is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (access class12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14 (accessclass 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 10 15 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

392 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 393: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.229 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P3) -(AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=3))

HMI Name High Priority Access Class Ordering P3Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=3)

Definition List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority10 (EC)is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (access class12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14 (accessclass 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 10 15 14

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 393 / 1176

Page 394: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.230 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P4) -(AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=4))

HMI Name High Priority Access Class Ordering P4Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=4)

Definition List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority10 (EC)is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (access class12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14 (accessclass 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 10 15 13

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

394 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 395: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.231 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P5) -(AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=5))

HMI Name High Priority Access Class Ordering P5Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=5)

Definition List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority10 (EC)is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (access class12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14 (accessclass 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 10 15 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 395 / 1176

Page 396: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.232 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P6) -(AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=6))

HMI Name High Priority Access Class Ordering P6Parameter Name

Logical Name AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=6)

Definition List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority10 (EC)is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (access class12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14 (accessclass 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 10 15 11

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

396 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 397: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.233 (HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD) - (HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD)

HMI Name HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOADParameter Name

Logical Name HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Definition Load threshold used to determine when traffic load is high for circuitswitched calls.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD >= LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 80

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment Default value depends on the number of TRX in the cell (see TRXnbdefault value). The value indicated here is for implementationpurposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

70 70 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 397 / 1176

Page 398: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.234 (Highest BA range ARFCNs) - (RANGEi_HIGHER (1<=i<=13))

HMI Name Highest BA range ARFCNsParameter Name

Logical Name RANGEi_HIGHER (1<=i<=13)

Definition Highest ARFCN of range i indicated in "BA Range" InformationElement.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules RANGEi_HIGHER >= RANGEi_LOWER

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None -1 1023 -1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Reselection

External Comment RANGEi_HIGHER = -1 means that it shall not be included in "BARange" IE. Moreover, all BA RANGE following this one will beconsidered as not significant by the OMC and not send to the BSC.(i.e. -1 = indicator of end of BA Range)

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

398 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 399: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.235 (HO_ALARM_PERSISTENCE) - (T_FILTER)

HMI Name HO_ALARM_PERSISTENCEParameter Name

Logical Name T_FILTER

Definition Maximum time a handover alarm is maintained while no more alarmcondition is detected.

Coding rules step size = 2 x SACCH frames = 0.96s. Coded over 5 bits:0: 0s, 1:0.96s, , 31: 29.76s

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

2 x Samfr 0 31 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 399 / 1176

Page 400: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.236 (HO_MARGIN) - (HOmargin (0,n))

HMI Name HO_MARGINParameter Name

Logical Name HOmargin (0,n)

Definition Difference in power budget (PBGT) between cell(0) and cell(n) whichis required for a power budget HO.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -127 127 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment –

Single 5 dB

Umbrella 5 dB

Concentric 5 dB

Concentric Umbrella 5 dB

Microcell 4 dB

Minicell 5 dB

Extended inner cell 5 dB

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 5 dB

Nb of TRX Dependent No

400 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 401: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.237 (HO_MARGIN_DIST) - (HO_MARGIN_DIST(0,n))

HMI Name HO_MARGIN_DISTParameter Name

Logical Name HO_MARGIN_DIST(0,n)

Definition Criterion for candidate neighbour cell filtering on distance handovercauses.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -127 127 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment –

Single 2 dB

Umbrella 2 dB

Concentric 2 dB

Concentric Umbrella 2 dB

Microcell 5 dB

Minicell 2 dB

Extended inner cell -29 dB

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 5 dB

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 401 / 1176

Page 402: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.238 (HO_MARGIN_LEV) - (HO_MARGIN_LEV(0,n))

HMI Name HO_MARGIN_LEVParameter Name

Logical Name HO_MARGIN_LEV(0,n)

Definition Criterion for candidate neighbour cell filtering on level handovercauses.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -127 127 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment –

Single 2 dB

Umbrella 2 dB

Concentric 0 dB

Concentric Umbrella 0 dB

Microcell 5 dB

Minicell 0 dB

Extended inner cell -29 dB

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 5 dB

Nb of TRX Dependent No

402 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 403: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.239 (HO_MARGIN_QUAL) - (HO_MARGIN_QUAL(0,n))

HMI Name HO_MARGIN_QUALParameter Name

Logical Name HO_MARGIN_QUAL(0,n)

Definition Criterion for candidate neighbour cell filtering on quality handovercauses

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -127 127 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment –

Single 1 dB

Umbrella 1 dB

Concentric 1 dB

Concentric Umbrella 1 dB

Microcell 5 dB

Minicell 1 dB

Extended inner cell -29 dB

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 5 dB

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 403 / 1176

Page 404: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.240 (HR_ENABLED) - (HR_ENABLED)

HMI Name HR_ENABLEDParameter Name

Logical Name HR_ENABLED

Definition This flag controls if Half Rate TCH is enabled.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

404 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 405: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.241 (IGNORE_2Mbit_FAILURE) - (IGNORE_2MBIT_FAIL)

HMI Name IGNORE_2Mbit_FAILUREParameter Name

Logical Name IGNORE_2MBIT_FAIL

Definition This flag indicates whether or not a transmission alarm triggers thetelecom defence activities (call release, blocking messages towardsMSC). Note that the O&M activities are not dependent on this flag.

Coding rules 0: transmission alarms are not ignored and the telecom defenceactivities (call release, blocking messages towards MSC) aretriggered;1: transmission alarms are ignored and telecom defenceactivities (call release, blocking messages towards MSC) are nottriggered;

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules If BSS_TRANSPORT_MODE = IP, should be set to FALSE. Due toTDM switching on TC side, there is no more interaction betweenAtermux and ATR failures.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 405 / 1176

Page 406: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.242 (IMSI Attach/Detach) - (ATT (BSC))

HMI Name IMSI Attach/DetachParameter Name

Logical Name ATT (BSC)

Definition This flag indicates to the MS if IMSI Attach/detach procedure isallowed in the cell.

Coding rules 0: not allowed, 1: allowed

Mandatory rules Equal to ATT (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

406 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 407: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.243 (IMSI Attach/Detach) - (ATT (MFS))

HMI Name IMSI Attach/DetachParameter Name

Logical Name ATT (MFS)

Definition This flag indicates to the MS whether IMSI Attach/detach procedureis allowed in the cell.

Coding rules 0: not allowed, 1: allowed

Mandatory rules Equal to ATT (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 407 / 1176

Page 408: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.244 (IND_TRAFFIC_LOAD) - (IND_TRAFFIC_LOAD)

HMI Name IND_TRAFFIC_LOADParameter Name

Logical Name IND_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Definition Load threshold used to determine when traffic load is indefinite forcircuit switched calls.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules IND_TRAFFIC_LOAD = 0 OR LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD <=IND_TRAFFIC_LOAD <= HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

45 45 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60

408 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 409: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.245 (INTAVE) - (INTAVE)

HMI Name INTAVEParameter Name

Logical Name INTAVE

Definition Averaging period for interference measurements on idle TCHtimeslots.

Coding rules step size=1 Samfr

Mandatory rules INTAVE < T_INTRF_L3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 31 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 409 / 1176

Page 410: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.246 (INTERCELL_HO) - (HO_INTERCELL_ALLOWED)

HMI Name INTERCELL_HOParameter Name

Logical Name HO_INTERCELL_ALLOWED

Definition This flag enables/disables the execution of all outgoing intercellhandovers.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment Valid for both TCH and SDCCH. This parameter has no influenceon Directed Retry

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

410 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 411: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.247 (Interference bands 1-2 limit) - (INTFBD1)

HMI Name Interference bands 1-2 limitParameter Name

Logical Name INTFBD1

Definition Limit between interference band 1 and interference band 2.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules INTFBD1 < INTFBD2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 411 / 1176

Page 412: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.248 (Interference bands 2-3 limit) - (INTFBD2)

HMI Name Interference bands 2-3 limitParameter Name

Logical Name INTFBD2

Definition Limit between interference band 2 and interference band 3.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules INTFBD3 > INTFBD2 > INTFBD1

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -95

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

412 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 413: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.249 (Interference bands 3-4 limit) - (INTFBD3)

HMI Name Interference bands 3-4 limitParameter Name

Logical Name INTFBD3

Definition Limit between interference band 3 and interference band 4.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules INTFBD4 > INTFBD3 > INTFBD2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -90

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 413 / 1176

Page 414: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.250 (Interference bands 4-5 limit) - (INTFBD4)

HMI Name Interference bands 4-5 limitParameter Name

Logical Name INTFBD4

Definition Limit between interference band 4 and interference band 5.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules INTFBD5 > INTFBD4 > INTFBD3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -85

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

414 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 415: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.251 (INTRACELL_HO) - (HO_INTRACELL_ALLOWED)

HMI Name INTRACELL_HOParameter Name

Logical Name HO_INTRACELL_ALLOWED

Definition This flag enables/disables the execution of intracell handovers.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment Valid for both TCH and SDCCH.The flags specific to the TFOfeature, I.e. EN_TFO, EN_TFO_MATCH, EN_TFO_OPT,EN_IPE_PREF_CODEC_TYPE, are set independently ofthe flag HO_INTRACELL_ALLOWED. Additionally, the flagrelated to handover cause 30, EN_RETURN_CS_ZONE_HO issetindependently of the flag HO_INTRACELL_ALLOWED. Thehandovers for TFO reasons (cause 29) and RAE4 reasons (cause30) can therefore be performed even if HO_INTRACELL_ALLOWED= disabled.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 415 / 1176

Page 416: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.252 (Keep codec on handover) - (KEEP_CODEC_HO)

HMI Name Keep codec on handoverParameter Name

Logical Name KEEP_CODEC_HO

Definition Indicates if the BSC tries to keep the same codec for internalincoming handovers.

Coding rules 0:free choice of the codec ; 1:try to maintain codec for TFO callsonly; 2: try to maintain codec for all calls

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

416 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 417: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.253 (L_LOAD_OBJ) - (L_LOAD_OBJ)

HMI Name L_LOAD_OBJParameter Name

Logical Name L_LOAD_OBJ

Definition Low threshold on busy TCH timeslots percentage to increaseMIN_DWELL_TIME variable.

Coding rules step size = 10%

Mandatory rules L_LOAD_OBJ <= H_LOAD_OBJ

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 60

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella See TRXnb

Concentric N/A

Concentric Umbrella See TRXnb

Microcell N/A

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

0 10 20 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 417 / 1176

Page 418: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.254 (L_MIN_DWELL_TIME) - (L_MIN_DWELL_TIME)

HMI Name L_MIN_DWELL_TIMEParameter Name

Logical Name L_MIN_DWELL_TIME

Definition Minimum allowed value for MIN_DWELL_TIME variable.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules L_MIN_DWELL_TIME <= H_MIN_DWELL_TIME

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 120 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

418 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 419: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.255 (L_RXLEV_CPT_HO) - (L_RXLEV_CPT_HO(0,n))

HMI Name L_RXLEV_CPT_HOParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXLEV_CPT_HO(0,n)

Definition Minimum received downlink level from cell n for umbrella to neighbourlower layer cell n handover or from classical band to preferred bandcell n handover.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -85

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl (+Edit Adjacency)

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 419 / 1176

Page 420: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.256 (L_RXLEV_DL_H) - (L_RXLEV_DL_H)

HMI Name L_RXLEV_DL_HParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXLEV_DL_H

Definition Downlink level threshold for handover.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules L_RXLEV_DL_H < U_RXLEV_DL_P.L_RXLEV_DL_H <RXLEV_DL_IH

Recommended rules L_RXLEV_D_H < L_RXLEV_DL_PIf CELL_PARTITION_TYPE ="Concentric" AND FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM" or "DCS1800"or "EGSM" or "DCS 1900":RXLEV_DL_ZONE >= L_RXLEV_DL_H(This rule only applies to concentric and monoband cell.)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -96

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Single -91 dBm (19)

Umbrella -91 dBm (19)

Concentric -91 dBm (19)

Concentric Umbrella -91 dBm (19)

Microcell -96 dBm (14)

Minicell -91 dBm (19)

Extended inner cell -96 dBm (14)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell -98 dBm (12)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

420 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 421: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.257 (L_RXLEV_DL_P) - (L_RXLEV_DL_P)

HMI Name L_RXLEV_DL_PParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXLEV_DL_P

Definition Lower downlink level threshold for power control.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules L_RXLEV_DL_P < U_RXLEV_DL_P

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -85

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 421 / 1176

Page 422: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.258 (L_RXLEV_NCELL_DR) - (L_RXLEV_NCELL_DR(n))

HMI Name L_RXLEV_NCELL_DRParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXLEV_NCELL_DR(n)

Definition Minimum level received from neighbour cell n to allow forced directedretry to cell n.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits :0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -110

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: DIR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Directed Retry (+ Edit External cell /circuit1/2)

External Comment –

Single -85 dBm (25)

Umbrella -85 dBm (25)

Concentric -85 dBm (25)

Concentric Umbrella -85 dBm (25)

Microcell -70 dBm (40)

Minicell -85 dBm (25)

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

422 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 423: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.259 (L_RXLEV_UL_H) - (L_RXLEV_UL_H)

HMI Name L_RXLEV_UL_HParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXLEV_UL_H

Definition Uplink level threshold for handover.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules L_RXLEV_UL_H < U_RXLEV_UL_P L_RXLEV_UL_H <RXLEV_UL_IH

Recommended rules L_RXLEV_UL_H < L_RXLEV_UL_PIf CELL_PARTITION_TYPE ="Concentric" AND FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM" or "DCS1800"or "EGSM" or "DCS 1900":RXLEV_UL_ZONE >= L_RXLEV_UL_H(This rule only applies to concentric and monoband cell.)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Single -100 dBm (10)

Umbrella -100 dBm (10)

Concentric -100 dBm (10)

Concentric Umbrella -100 dBm (10)

Microcell -100 dBm (10)

Minicell -100 dBm (10)

Extended inner cell -100 dBm (10)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell -100 dBm (10)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 423 / 1176

Page 424: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.260 (L_RXLEV_UL_P) - (L_RXLEV_UL_P)

HMI Name L_RXLEV_UL_PParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXLEV_UL_P

Definition Lower uplink level threshold for power control.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules L_RXLEV_UL_P < U_RXLEV_UL_P

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -90

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Single -95 dBm (15)

Umbrella -95 dBm (15)

Concentric -95 dBm (15)

Concentric Umbrella -95 dBm (15)

Microcell -85 dBm (25)

Minicell -95 dBm (15)

Extended inner cell -95 dBm (15)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell -95 dBm (15)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

424 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 425: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.261 (L_RXQUAL_DL_H) - (L_RXQUAL_DL_H)

HMI Name L_RXQUAL_DL_HParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXQUAL_DL_H

Definition Downlink quality threshold for handover for non AMR calls.

Coding rules step size = 0.1, (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules L_RXQUAL_DL_H >= L_RXQUAL_DL_P

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment Higher value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 425 / 1176

Page 426: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.262 (L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR) - (L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR)

HMI Name L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMRParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR

Definition Downlink quality threshold for handovers (cause 16) on AMR-NBcalls.

Coding rules step size = 0.1, (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

426 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 427: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.263 (L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK) -(L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK)

HMI Name L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR_WB_GMSKParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition Downlink quality threshold for handovers (cause 16) on AMR-WBGMSK calls.

Coding rules step size = 0.1, (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 427 / 1176

Page 428: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.264 (L_RXQUAL_DL_P) - (L_RXQUAL_DL_P)

HMI Name L_RXQUAL_DL_PParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXQUAL_DL_P

Definition Lower downlink quality threshold for power control.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules L_RXQUAL_DL_P > U_RXQUAL_DL_P

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment Higher value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

428 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 429: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.265 (L_RXQUAL_UL_H) - (L_RXQUAL_UL_H)

HMI Name L_RXQUAL_UL_HParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXQUAL_UL_H

Definition Uplink quality threshold for handover for non AMR calls.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules L_RXQUAL_UL_H >= L_RXQUAL_UL_P

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment Higher value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 429 / 1176

Page 430: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.266 (L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR) - (L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR)

HMI Name L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMRParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR

Definition Uplink quality threshold for handovers (cause 15) on AMR-NB calls.

Coding rules step size = 0.1, (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

430 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 431: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.267 (L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK) -(L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK)

HMI Name L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR_WB_GMSKParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition Uplink quality threshold for handovers (cause 15) on AMR-WBGMSK calls.

Coding rules step size = 0.1, (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 431 / 1176

Page 432: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.268 (L_RXQUAL_UL_P) - (L_RXQUAL_UL_P)

HMI Name L_RXQUAL_UL_PParameter Name

Logical Name L_RXQUAL_UL_P

Definition Lower uplink quality threshold for power control.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules L_RXQUAL_UL_P > U_RXQUAL_UL_P

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment Higher value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

432 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 433: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.269 (LAC) - (LAC (BSC))

HMI Name LACParameter Name

Logical Name LAC (BSC)

Definition Location Area Code.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual to LAC(MFS)A couple of mate extended cells (Extended inner + extendedouter) shall have the same LAC.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 65535 65535

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description ( + Edit External cell/ circuit1/2)

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 433 / 1176

Page 434: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.270 (Link_factor) - (Linkfactor (0,n))

HMI Name Link_factorParameter Name

Logical Name Linkfactor (0,n)

Definition Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to handicap orfavour cell n.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -24 24 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

434 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 435: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.271 (Load computation in outer zone) - (EN_LOAD_OUTER)

HMI Name Load computation in outer zoneParameter Name

Logical Name EN_LOAD_OUTER

Definition Flag to enable/disable the load computation on the outer zone of aConcentric/multiband cell instead of the load computation on thewhole cell.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules When enabled, the values of the parameters FREElevel_1 toFREElevel_4 need to be updated to number of TRX considered inthe load computation.EN_LOAD_BALANCE & EN_LOAD_OUTERshould not be both "Enabled".

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO

External Comment significant only for concentric and multiband cells.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 435 / 1176

Page 436: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.272 (LOAD_EV_PERIOD) - (LOAD_EV_PERIOD)

HMI Name LOAD_EV_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name LOAD_EV_PERIOD

Definition Number of load samples (received every TCH_INFO_PERIOD) forload averaging.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 30 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

436 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 437: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.273 (Load_Factor_1) - (Loadfactor_1)

HMI Name Load_Factor_1Parameter Name

Logical Name Loadfactor_1

Definition Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to take into accountthe TCH load in the candidate cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Loadfactor_1 >= Loadfactor_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -16 0 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 437 / 1176

Page 438: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.274 (Load_Factor_2) - (Loadfactor_2)

HMI Name Load_Factor_2Parameter Name

Logical Name Loadfactor_2

Definition Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to take into accountthe TCH load in the candidate cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Loadfactor_1 >= Loadfactor_2 >= Loadfactor_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -16 0 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Single -2

Umbrella -2

Concentric -2

Concentric Umbrella -2

Microcell -2

Minicell -2

Extended inner cell 0

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 0

Nb of TRX Dependent No

438 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 439: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.275 (Load_Factor_3) - (Loadfactor_3)

HMI Name Load_Factor_3Parameter Name

Logical Name Loadfactor_3

Definition Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to take into accountthe TCH load in the candidate cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Loadfactor_2 >= Loadfactor_3 >= Loadfactor_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -16 0 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Single -5

Umbrella -5

Concentric -5

Concentric Umbrella -5

Microcell -4

Minicell -5

Extended inner cell 0

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 0

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 439 / 1176

Page 440: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.276 (Load_Factor_4) - (Loadfactor_4)

HMI Name Load_Factor_4Parameter Name

Logical Name Loadfactor_4

Definition Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to take into accountthe TCH load in the candidate cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Loadfactor_3 >= Loadfactor_4 >= Loadfactor_5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -16 0 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Single -7

Umbrella -7

Concentric -7

Concentric Umbrella -7

Microcell -6

Minicell -7

Extended inner cell 0

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 0

Nb of TRX Dependent No

440 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 441: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.277 (Load_Factor_5) - (Loadfactor_5)

HMI Name Load_Factor_5Parameter Name

Logical Name Loadfactor_5

Definition Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to take into accountthe TCH load in the candidate cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Loadfactor_5 <= Loadfactor_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -16 0 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Single -10

Umbrella -10

Concentric -10

Concentric Umbrella -10

Microcell -8

Minicell -10

Extended inner cell 0

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 0

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 441 / 1176

Page 442: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.278 (Load_Level_1) - (Loadlevel_1)

HMI Name Load_Level_1Parameter Name

Logical Name Loadlevel_1

Definition Boundary on cell load for determination of Loadfactor of the cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Loadlevel_1 < Loadlevel_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 50

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

442 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 443: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.279 (Load_Level_2) - (Loadlevel_2)

HMI Name Load_Level_2Parameter Name

Logical Name Loadlevel_2

Definition Boundary on cell load for determination of Loadfactor of the cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Loadlevel_1 < Loadlevel_2 < Loadlevel_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 60

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 443 / 1176

Page 444: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.280 (Load_Level_3) - (Loadlevel_3)

HMI Name Load_Level_3Parameter Name

Logical Name Loadlevel_3

Definition Boundary on cell load for determination of Loadfactor of the cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Loadlevel_2 < Loadlevel_3 < Loadlevel_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 80

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

444 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 445: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.281 (Load_Level_4) - (Loadlevel_4)

HMI Name Load_Level_4Parameter Name

Logical Name Loadlevel_4

Definition Boundary on cell load for determination of Loadfactor of the cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Loadlevel_4 > Loadlevel_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 90

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 445 / 1176

Page 446: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.282 (LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD) - (LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD)

HMI Name LOW_TRAFFIC_LOADParameter Name

Logical Name LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Definition Load threshold used to determine when traffic load is low for circuitswitched calls.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD <= HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment If LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD is set to 0 in a given cell n, then noHandover Cause 23 (i.e. Traffic Handovers) can be triggered towardsthat cell n.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

20 20 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50

446 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 447: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.283 (LOWER_TIMING_ADVANCE) - (L_TIME_ADVANCE)

HMI Name LOWER_TIMING_ADVANCEParameter Name

Logical Name L_TIME_ADVANCE

Definition Low threshold to trigger handover cause "too short distance" in outercell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 0 63 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Distance

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric N/A

Concentric Umbrella N/A

Microcell N/A

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 0

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 447 / 1176

Page 448: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.284 (Lowest BA range ARFCNs) - (RANGEi_LOWER (1<=i<=13))

HMI Name Lowest BA range ARFCNsParameter Name

Logical Name RANGEi_LOWER (1<=i<=13)

Definition Lowest ARFCN of range i indicated in "BA Range" InformationElement.

Coding rules Coded on 16 bits.

Mandatory rules RANGEi_HIGHER >= RANGEi_LOWER

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None -1 1023 -1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Reselection

External Comment RANGEi_LOWER = -1 means that it shall not be included in "BARange" IE Moreover, all BA RANGE following this one will beconsidered as not significant by the OMC and not send to the BSC.(i.e. -1 = indicator of end of BA Range)

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

448 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 449: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.285 (LSA_ID_I) - (LSA_ID_array (BSC))

HMI Name LSA_ID_IParameter Name

Logical Name LSA_ID_array (BSC)

Definition List of authorised LSAs on a cell (up to 5).

Coding rules coded on 3 bytes max

Mandatory rules Equal to LSA_ID_array (MFS)

Recommended rules The LSA_ID may either be a Universal LSA identity (in case of oddnumber) or a PLMN significant LSA identity (in case of even number),as defined in GSM 03.03.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 16777215 16777215

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 3/3

External Comment The default value depends on the configuration. The value givenhere is for implementation purposes only.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 449 / 1176

Page 450: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.286 (LSA_ID_I) - (LSA_ID_array (MFS))

HMI Name LSA_ID_IParameter Name

Logical Name LSA_ID_array (MFS)

Definition List of authorised LSAs on a cell (up to 5).

Coding rules coded on 3 bytes max

Mandatory rules Equal to LSA_ID_array (BSC)

Recommended rules The LSA_ID may either be a Universal LSA identity (in case of oddnumber) or a PLMN significant LSA identity (in case of even number),as defined in GSM 03.03.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 16777215 16777215

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 3/3

External Comment The default value depends on the configuration. The value givenhere is for implementation purposes only.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

450 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 451: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.287 (LSA_ID_I(n)) - (LSA_ID_array (n))

HMI Name LSA_ID_I(n)Parameter Name

Logical Name LSA_ID_array (n)

Definition List of authorised LSAs on a neighbour cell (up to 5).

Coding rules coded on 3 bytes max

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 16777215 16777215

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access External Cell / Circuit 2/2

External Comment This parameter is for every cell. The operator needs only to configurethe value of that parameter for OMC external cells ; the parameteris autonomously filled by the OMC in case the adjacent cell is anOMC internal cell.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 451 / 1176

Page 452: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.288 (LSA_OFFSET) - (LSA_OFFSET)

HMI Name LSA_OFFSETParameter Name

Logical Name LSA_OFFSET

Definition Offset to be used for LSA cell reselection between cells with thesame LSA priorities.

Coding rules coded from 0 to 7, where 0 = 0 dB, 1 = 4 dB, 2 = 8 dB, 3 = 16 dB,4 = 24 dB, 5 = 32 dB, 6 = 48 dB, 7 = 64 dB.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 64 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 3/3

External Comment The default value corresponds to an unused parameter for the MS.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

452 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 453: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.289 (LSA_PRIO_THR) - (PRIO_THR)

HMI Name LSA_PRIO_THRParameter Name

Logical Name PRIO_THR

Definition Signal threshold for applying LSA cell reselection.

Coding rules coded from 0 to 7; step size = 6 dB (i.e. 0 = 0 dB, 1 = 6 dB, 2 = 12dB, 3 = 18 dB, 4 = 24 dB, 5 = 30 dB, 6 = 36 dB, 7 = infinite = 42 dB).

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 42 42

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 3/3

External Comment The default value corresponds to an unused parameter for theMS.The maximum and default values correspond to an infinitethreshold.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 453 / 1176

Page 454: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.290 (MATE_CI) - (MATE_CI (BSC))

HMI Name MATE_CIParameter Name

Logical Name MATE_CI (BSC)

Definition Cell Identity of the Mate cell

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules MATE_CI (BSC) = MATE_CI (MFS)If one mate cell is configuredwith GPRS (MAX_PDCH > 0) then the other mate cell shall alsobe configured with GPRS (MAX_PDCH > 0)For an extended cell,MATE_LAC and MATE_CI can not be equal to 65535 at the sametime

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 65535 65535

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here isfor implementation purposes.(MATE_LAC + MATE_CI) is relevant forextended cells only

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

454 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 455: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.291 (MATE_LAC) - (MATE_LAC)

HMI Name MATE_LACParameter Name

Logical Name MATE_LAC

Definition Location Area Code of the Mate cell.

Coding rules Step size = 1

Mandatory rules For an extended cell, MATE_LAC and MATE_CI can not be equal to65535 at the same time A couple of mate extended cells (Extendedinner + extended outer) shall have the same LAC

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 65535 65535

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here isfor implementation purposes.(MATE_LAC + MATE_CI) is relevant forextended cells only

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 455 / 1176

Page 456: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.292 (MAX_POW_INC) - (MAX_POW_INC)

HMI Name MAX_POW_INCParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_POW_INC

Definition Maximum Power increase in one power command.

Coding rules step size = 2dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 2 16 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

456 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 457: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.293 (MAX_POW_RED) - (MAX_POW_RED)

HMI Name MAX_POW_REDParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_POW_RED

Definition Maximum Power reduction in one power command.

Coding rules step size = 2dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 2 16 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 457 / 1176

Page 458: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.294 (MAX_RETRANS) - (Max_retrans (BSC))

HMI Name MAX_RETRANSParameter Name

Logical Name Max_retrans (BSC)

Definition Maximum number of CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissions by theMS on the RACH.

Coding rules Possible values are:1, 2 ,4 and 7 respectively binary coded:00, 01,10 and 11

Mandatory rules Max_retrans (BSC) = Max_retrans (MFS) for a given cell

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 7 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

458 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 459: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.295 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_1) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [1])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_1Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [1]

Definition Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands usedfor Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_BFI2 > MEAS_STAT_BFI1

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 24 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 459 / 1176

Page 460: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.296 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_2) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [2])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_2Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [2]

Definition Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands usedfor Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_BFI3 > MEAS_STAT_BFI2 > MEAS_STAT_BFI1

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 24 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

460 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 461: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.297 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_3) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [3])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_3Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [3]

Definition Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands usedfor Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_BFI4 > MEAS_STAT_BFI3 > MEAS_STAT_BFI2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 24 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 461 / 1176

Page 462: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.298 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_4) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [4])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_4Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [4]

Definition Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands usedfor Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_BFI5 > MEAS_STAT_BFI4 > MEAS_STAT_BFI3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 24 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

462 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 463: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.299 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_5) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [5])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_5Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [5]

Definition Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands usedfor Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_BFI6 > MEAS_STAT_BFI5 > MEAS_STAT_BFI4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 24 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 463 / 1176

Page 464: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.300 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_6) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [6])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_6Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [6]

Definition Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands usedfor Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_BFI7 > MEAS_STAT_BFI6 > MEAS_STAT_BFI5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 24 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

464 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 465: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.301 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_7) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [7])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_7Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [7]

Definition Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands usedfor Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_BFI8 > MEAS_STAT_BFI7 > MEAS_STAT_BFI6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 24 14

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 465 / 1176

Page 466: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.302 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_8) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [8])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_8Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [8]

Definition Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands usedfor Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_BFI9 > MEAS_STAT_BFI8 > MEAS_STAT_BFI7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 24 18

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

466 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 467: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.303 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_9) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [9])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_9Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [9]

Definition Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands usedfor Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_BFI9 > MEAS_STAT_BFI8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 24 22

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 467 / 1176

Page 468: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.304 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_1) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [1])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_1Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [1]

Definition Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to definebands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_CI1 < MEAS_STAT_CI2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -62 62 -12

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

468 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 469: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.305 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_2) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [2])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_2Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [2]

Definition Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to definebands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_CI1 < MEAS_STAT_CI2 < MEAS_STAT_CI3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -62 62 -9

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 469 / 1176

Page 470: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.306 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_3) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [3])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_3Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [3]

Definition Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to definebands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_CI2 < MEAS_STAT_CI3 < MEAS_STAT_CI4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -62 62 -6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

470 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 471: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.307 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_4) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [4])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_4Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [4]

Definition Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to definebands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_CI3 < MEAS_STAT_CI4 < MEAS_STAT_CI5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -62 62 -3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 471 / 1176

Page 472: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.308 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_5) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [5])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_5Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [5]

Definition Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to definebands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_CI4 < MEAS_STAT_CI5 < MEAS_STAT_CI6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -62 62 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

472 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 473: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.309 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_6) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [6])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_6Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [6]

Definition Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to definebands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_CI5 < MEAS_STAT_CI6 < MEAS_STAT_CI7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -62 62 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 473 / 1176

Page 474: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.310 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_7) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [7])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_7Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [7]

Definition Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to definebands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_CI6 < MEAS_STAT_CI7 < MEAS_STAT_CI8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -62 62 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

474 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 475: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.311 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_8) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [8])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_8Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [8]

Definition Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to definebands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_CI7 < MEAS_STAT_CI8 < MEAS_STAT_CI9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -62 62 9

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 475 / 1176

Page 476: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.312 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_9) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [9])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_9Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [9]

Definition Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to definebands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_CI8 < MEAS_STAT_CI9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -62 62 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

476 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 477: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.313 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_1) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [1])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_1Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [1]

Definition Threshold on radio level to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_LEV_1 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -109 -48 -53

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 477 / 1176

Page 478: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.314 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_2) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [2])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_2Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [2]

Definition Threshold on radio level to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_LEV_1 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_2 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -109 -48 -60

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

478 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 479: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.315 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_3) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [3])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_3Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [3]

Definition Threshold on radio level to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_LEV_2 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_3 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -109 -48 -66

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 479 / 1176

Page 480: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.316 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_4) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [4])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_4Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [4]

Definition Threshold on radio level to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_LEV_3 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_4 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -109 -48 -72

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

480 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 481: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.317 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_5) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [5])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_5Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [5]

Definition Threshold on radio level to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_LEV_4 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_5 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -109 -48 -79

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 481 / 1176

Page 482: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.318 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_6) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [6])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_6Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [6]

Definition Threshold on radio level to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_LEV_5 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_6 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -109 -48 -85

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

482 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 483: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.319 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_7) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [7])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_7Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [7]

Definition Threshold on radio level to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_LEV_6 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_7 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -109 -48 -91

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 483 / 1176

Page 484: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.320 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_8) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [8])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_8Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [8]

Definition Threshold on radio level to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_LEV_7 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_8 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -109 -48 -97

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

484 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 485: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.321 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_9) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [9])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_9Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [9]

Definition Threshold on radio level to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_LEV_8 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -109 -48 -104

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 485 / 1176

Page 486: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.322 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_1) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [1])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_1Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [1]

Definition Threshold on path balance to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL1 < MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -109 109 -50

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

486 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 487: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.323 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_2) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [2])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_2Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [2]

Definition Threshold on path balance to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL3 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL2 >MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL1

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -109 109 -30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 487 / 1176

Page 488: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.324 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_3) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [3])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_3Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [3]

Definition Threshold on path balance to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL4 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL3 >MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -109 109 -20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

488 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 489: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.325 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_4) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [4])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_4Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [4]

Definition Threshold on path balance to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL5 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL4 >MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -109 109 -10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 489 / 1176

Page 490: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.326 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_5) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [5])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_5Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [5]

Definition Threshold on path balance to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL6 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL5 >MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -109 109 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

490 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 491: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.327 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_6) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [6])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_6Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [6]

Definition Threshold on path balance to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL7 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL6 >MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -109 109 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 491 / 1176

Page 492: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.328 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_7) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [7])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_7Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [7]

Definition Threshold on path balance to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL8 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL7 >MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -109 109 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

492 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 493: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.329 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_8) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [8])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_8Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [8]

Definition Threshold on path balance to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL9 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL8 >MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -109 109 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 493 / 1176

Page 494: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.330 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_9) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [9])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_9Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [9]

Definition Threshold on path balance to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL9 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -109 109 50

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

494 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 495: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.331 (MEAS_STAT_S_1) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [1])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_S_1Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_S_i [1]

Definition Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_S1 < MEAS_STAT_S2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 127 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 495 / 1176

Page 496: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.332 (MEAS_STAT_S_2) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [2])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_S_2Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_S_i [2]

Definition Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_S3 > MEAS_STAT_S2 > MEAS_STAT_S1

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 127 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

496 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 497: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.333 (MEAS_STAT_S_3) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [3])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_S_3Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_S_i [3]

Definition Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_S4 > MEAS_STAT_S3 > MEAS_STAT_S2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 127 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 497 / 1176

Page 498: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.334 (MEAS_STAT_S_4) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [4])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_S_4Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_S_i [4]

Definition Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_S5 > MEAS_STAT_S4 > MEAS_STAT_S3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 127 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

498 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 499: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.335 (MEAS_STAT_S_5) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [5])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_S_5Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_S_i [5]

Definition Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_S6 > MEAS_STAT_S5 > MEAS_STAT_S4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 127 14

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 499 / 1176

Page 500: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.336 (MEAS_STAT_S_6) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [6])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_S_6Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_S_i [6]

Definition Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_S7 > MEAS_STAT_S6 > MEAS_STAT_S5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 127 16

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

500 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 501: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.337 (MEAS_STAT_S_7) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [7])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_S_7Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_S_i [7]

Definition Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_S8 > MEAS_STAT_S7 > MEAS_STAT_S6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 127 18

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 501 / 1176

Page 502: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.338 (MEAS_STAT_S_8) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [8])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_S_8Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_S_i [8]

Definition Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_S9 > MEAS_STAT_S8 > MEAS_STAT_S7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 127 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

502 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 503: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.339 (MEAS_STAT_S_9) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [9])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_S_9Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_S_i [9]

Definition Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_S9 > MEAS_STAT_S8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 127 22

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 503 / 1176

Page 504: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.340 (MEAS_STAT_TA_1) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [1])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_TA_1Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_TA_i [1]

Definition Upper limit of the first TA band, lower limit of the second TA band(for the RMS TA measurements)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules 0 < MEAS_STAT_TA_1 < MEAS_STAT_TA_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 1 62 7

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

504 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 505: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.341 (MEAS_STAT_TA_2) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [2])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_TA_2Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_TA_i [2]

Definition Upper limit of the 2nd TA band, lower limit of the 3rd TA band (for theRMS TA measurements)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_TA_1 < MEAS_STAT_TA_2 < MEAS_STAT_TA_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 1 62 13

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 505 / 1176

Page 506: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.342 (MEAS_STAT_TA_3) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [3])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_TA_3Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_TA_i [3]

Definition Upper limit of the 3rd TA band, lower limit of the 4th TA band (for theRMS TA measurements)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_TA_2 < MEAS_STAT_TA_3 < MEAS_STAT_TA_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 1 62 19

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

506 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 507: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.343 (MEAS_STAT_TA_4) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [4])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_TA_4Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_TA_i [4]

Definition Upper limit of the 4th TA band, lower limit of the 5th TA band (for theRMS TA measurements)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_TA_3 < MEAS_STAT_TA_4 < MEAS_STAT_TA_5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 1 62 25

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 507 / 1176

Page 508: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.344 (MEAS_STAT_TA_5) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [5])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_TA_5Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_TA_i [5]

Definition Upper limit of the 5th TA band, lower limit of the 6th TA band (for theRMS TA measurements)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_TA_4 < MEAS_STAT_TA_5 < MEAS_STAT_TA_6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 1 62 31

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

508 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 509: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.345 (MEAS_STAT_TA_6) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [6])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_TA_6Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_TA_i [6]

Definition Upper limit of the 6th TA band, lower limit of the 7th TA band (for theRMS TA measurements)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_TA_5 < MEAS_STAT_TA_6 < MEAS_STAT_TA_7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 1 62 37

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 509 / 1176

Page 510: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.346 (MEAS_STAT_TA_7) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [7])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_TA_7Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_TA_i [7]

Definition Upper limit of the 7th TA band, lower limit of the 8th TA band (for theRMS TA measurements)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_TA_6 < MEAS_STAT_TA_7 < MEAS_STAT_TA_8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 1 62 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

510 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 511: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.347 (MEAS_STAT_TA_8) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [8])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_TA_8Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_TA_i [8]

Definition Upper limit of the 8th TA band, lower limit of the 9th TA band (for theRMS TA measurements)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_TA_7 < MEAS_STAT_TA_8 < MEAS_STAT_TA_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 1 62 49

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 511 / 1176

Page 512: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.348 (MEAS_STAT_TA_9) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [9])

HMI Name MEAS_STAT_TA_9Parameter Name

Logical Name MEAS_STAT_TA_i [9]

Definition Upper limit of the 9th TA band, lower limit of the 10th TA band (for theRMS TA measurements)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules MEAS_STAT_TA_8 < MEAS_STAT_TA_9 < 63

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 1 62 55

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

512 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 513: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.349 (MIN_CONNECT_TIME) - (MIN_CONNECT_TIME)

HMI Name MIN_CONNECT_TIMEParameter Name

Logical Name MIN_CONNECT_TIME

Definition Maximum connection time after a handover in an overlaid cell todeclare the MS "fast" when leaving the cell with a handover.

Coding rules step size=1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 120 40

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric N/A

Concentric Umbrella N/A

Microcell 20 s

Minicell 40 s

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 513 / 1176

Page 514: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.350 (MIN_RLF_TIME_DL) - (MIN_RLF_TIME_DL)

HMI Name MIN_RLF_TIME_DLParameter Name

Logical Name MIN_RLF_TIME_DL

Definition Minimum time before detecting a radio link failure of a DL TBF,triggered by N3105 or NstagnatingWindowDL.

Coding rules step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to set a value close to the time of temporary verybad radio conditions that the operator would like to support during aDL TBF. Typically, a few seconds.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 0 25000 4000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

514 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 515: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.351 (Mobile Country Code (MCC)) - (MCC (BSC))

HMI Name Mobile Country Code (MCC)Parameter Name

Logical Name MCC (BSC)

Definition Mobile Country Code of the own PLMN.

Coding rules 3 digits BCD

Mandatory rules The OMC-R shall ensure that the following rules are always fulfilled:-MCC (BSC) = MCC (MFS).- The cells belonging to the same BSCshall have the same (MCC,MNC) couple.- The (MCC,MNC) coupleof cells internal to the OMC-R shall be selected from the set of ownPLMNs.- The (MCC,MNC) couple of cells external to the OMC-R canbe selected from the set of own or foreign PLMNs.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 999 999

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Network

External Comment The value depends on the configuration. The default value indicatedhere is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 515 / 1176

Page 516: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.352 (Mobile Network Code (MNC)) - (MNC (BSC))

HMI Name Mobile Network Code (MNC)Parameter Name

Logical Name MNC (BSC)

Definition Mobile Network Code of the own PLMN.

Coding rules 3 digits BCD

Mandatory rules The OMC-R shall ensure that the following rules are always fulfilled:-MNC (BSC) = MNC (MFS).- The cells belonging to the same BSCshall have the same (MCC,MNC) couple.- The (MCC,MNC) coupleof cells internal to the OMC-R shall be selected from the set of ownPLMNs.- The (MCC,MNC) couple of cells external to the OMC-R canbe selected from the set of own or foreign PLMNs.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 999 999

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access RNUSM / Edit Network

External Comment The value depends on configuration. The default value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.The operator is allowed to enter 2 or3 digits MNC in the CDE table.MNC such as yz or Fyz correspondto a 2 digits MNC (y, z = 0..9). (F binary coded 1111)MNC such asxyz correspond to a 3 digits MNC (x = 0..9).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

516 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 517: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.353 (MS_P_CON_ACK) - (MS_P_CON_ACK)

HMI Name MS_P_CON_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name MS_P_CON_ACK

Definition Supervision of the MS Power Control procedure.

Coding rules step size=1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

2 x Samfr 0 31 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Single 3 s

Umbrella 3 s

Concentric 3 s

Concentric Umbrella 3 s

Microcell 2 s

Minicell 3 s

Extended inner cell 3 s

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 3 s

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 517 / 1176

Page 518: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.354 (MS_P_CON_INT) - (MS_P_CON_INT)

HMI Name MS_P_CON_INTParameter Name

Logical Name MS_P_CON_INT

Definition Minimum delay between two consecutive MS power commands.

Coding rules step size=1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

2 x Samfr 0 31 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Single 1 s

Umbrella 1 s

Concentric 1 s

Concentric Umbrella 1 s

Microcell 0 s

Minicell 1 s

Extended inner cell 1 s

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 1 s

Nb of TRX Dependent No

518 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 519: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.355 (MS_TXPWR_MAX) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX)

HMI Name MS_TXPWR_MAXParameter Name

Logical Name MS_TXPWR_MAX

Definition MS maximum allowed transmission power.

Coding rules P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm,...., 19: 5dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:stepsize = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm,..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range 0to 15, 30, 31; 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm, 30: 33 dBm,31: 32 dBm.

Mandatory rules MS_TXPWR_MAX >= MS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm 5 43 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control (+ Edit External cell/ circuit1/2)

External Comment According to the 3GPP TS 05.05, if the BCCH frequency band isP-GSM/G1, depending on the version of MS (Phase 1 MS or Phase2/onwards MS), the coded value "0", "1" and "2" are interpreteddifferently:- Coded value "0": (interpreted as 43 dBm by the Phase1 MS; interpreted as 39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Codedvalue "1": (interpreted as 41 dBm by the Phase 1 MS; interpreted as39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded value "2": (interpretedas 39 dBm by both the Phase 1 MS and the Phase 2/onwards MS).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 519 / 1176

Page 520: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.356 (MS_TXPWR_MAX) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX(n))

HMI Name MS_TXPWR_MAXParameter Name

Logical Name MS_TXPWR_MAX(n)

Definition MS maximum allowed transmission power.

Coding rules P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:stepsize = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range 0to 15, 30, 31; 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm, 30: 33 dBm,31: 32 dBm.

Mandatory rules MS_TXPWR_MAX >= MS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm 5 43 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access External Cell / Circuit 1/2

External Comment According to the 3GPP TS 05.05, if the BCCH frequency band isP-GSM/G1, depending on the version of MS (Phase 1 MS or Phase2/onwards MS), the coded value "0", "1" and "2" are interpreteddifferently:- Coded value "0": (interpreted as 43 dBm by the Phase1 MS; interpreted as 39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Codedvalue "1": (interpreted as 41 dBm by the Phase 1 MS; interpreted as39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);-Coded value "2": (interpretedas 39 dBm by both the Phase 1 MS and the Phase 2/onwards MS).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

520 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 521: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.357 (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH (BSC))

HMI Name MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCHParameter Name

Logical Name MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH (BSC)

Definition Maximum transmission power an MS is allowed to use whenaccessing the cell until otherwise commanded.

Coding rules P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:stepsize = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range 0to 15, 30, 31; 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm, 30: 33 dBm,31: 32 dBm.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm 5 43 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment According to the 3GPP TS 05.05, if the BCCH frequency band isP-GSM/G1, depending on the version of MS (Phase 1 MS or Phase2/onwards MS), the coded value "0", "1" and "2" are interpreteddifferently:- Coded value "0": (interpreted as 43 dBm by the Phase1 MS; interpreted as 39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Codedvalue "1": (interpreted as 41 dBm by the Phase 1 MS; interpreted as39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded value "2": (interpretedas 39 dBm by both the Phase 1 MS and the Phase 2/onwards MS).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 521 / 1176

Page 522: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.358 (MS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER)

HMI Name MS_TXPWR_MAX_INNERParameter Name

Logical Name MS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER

Definition MS maximum allowed transmission power in the inner zone of aconcentric or multiband cell.

Coding rules P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:stepsize = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range 0to 15, 30, 31; 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm, 30: 33 dBm,31: 32 dBm.

Mandatory rules MS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER >= MS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm 5 43 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment According to the 3GPP TS 05.05, if the BCCH frequency band isP-GSM/G1, depending on the version of MS (Phase 1 MS or Phase2/onwards MS), the coded value "0", "1" and "2" are interpreteddifferently:- Coded value "0": (interpreted as 43 dBm by the Phase1 MS; interpreted as 39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Codedvalue "1": (interpreted as 41 dBm by the Phase 1 MS; interpreted as39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded value "2": (interpretedas 39 dBm by both the Phase 1 MS and the Phase 2/onwardsMS).Meaninful only in cells where: CELL_PARTITION_TYPE =concentric.

522 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 523: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric #

Concentric Umbrella #

Microcell N/A

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 523 / 1176

Page 524: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.359 (MS_TXPWR_MIN) - (MS_TXPWR_MIN)

HMI Name MS_TXPWR_MINParameter Name

Logical Name MS_TXPWR_MIN

Definition MS minimum allowed transmission power.

Coding rules P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ...,13: 17 dBm,,19: 5 dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39dBm, 2: 39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 13: 17 dBm,, 19: 5dBm.DCS 1800 coding:step size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 13: 4 dBm,,15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range 0 to 15, 30, 31; 0: 30 dBm, 1:28 dBm, ..., 13: 4 dBm,, 15: 0 dBm, 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm.

Mandatory rules MS_TXPWR_MIN <= MS_TXPWR_MAX andMS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER >= MS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm 5 43 17

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control (+ Edit External cell/ circuit1/2)

External Comment The default value depends on the BCCH frequency band:Defaultvalue for P-GSM/G1: 17 dBmDefault value for GSM850: 17dBmDefault value for DCS1800: 4 dBmDefault value for DCS1900:4 dBm

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

524 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 525: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.360 (MSC Signalling Point Code) - (DPC)

HMI Name MSC Signalling Point CodeParameter Name

Logical Name DPC

Definition Signalling Point Code of the MSC.

Coding rules coded over 14 bits

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 16383 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: EML RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access BSS parameters / A interface info

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 525 / 1176

Page 526: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.361 (MSCR) - (MSCR (BSC))

HMI Name MSCRParameter Name

Logical Name MSCR (BSC)

Definition Year corresponding to the version of ETSI/3GPP recommendationsused to implement MSC software.

Coding rules 0 = MSC is release '98 or older; 1 = MSC is release '99 onwards

Mandatory rules MSCR (BSC) = MSCR (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Internetworking MSC Internetworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

526 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 527: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.362 (MSCR) - (MSCR (MFS))

HMI Name MSCRParameter Name

Logical Name MSCR (MFS)

Definition Year corresponding to the version of ETSI/3GPP recommendationsused to implement MSC software.

Coding rules 0 = MSC is release '98 or older; 1 = MSC is release '99 onwards

Mandatory rules MSCR (BSC) = MSCR (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Internetworking MSC Internetworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 527 / 1176

Page 528: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.363 (MTP_Sequence_Number_Format) -(MTP_Sequence_Number_Format)

HMI Name MTP_Sequence_Number_FormatParameter Name

Logical Name MTP_Sequence_Number_Format

Definition Defines the format to be used for the sequence number of MTP2.

Coding rules 0: Normal1: Extended

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Value "Extended" is refused by the BSC if EN_HSL=0

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

528 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 529: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.364 (MULTIBAND_REPORTING) - (MULTIBAND_REPORTING (BSC))

HMI Name MULTIBAND_REPORTINGParameter Name

Logical Name MULTIBAND_REPORTING (BSC)

Definition Minimum number of cells of each supported frequency band to beincluded in MEASUREMENT REPORT by the MS.

Coding rules Coded over 2 bits:00: normal reporting of the six strongest cells,with known and allowed NCC part of BSIC, irrespective of the bandused;01: the MS shall report the strongest cell, with known andallowed NCC part of BSIC, in each of the frequency bands in the BAlist, excluding the frequency band of the serving cell;10: the MS shallreport the two strongest cells, with known and allowed NCC partof BSIC, in each of the frequency bands in the BA list, excludingthe frequency band of the serving cell; 11: the MS shall report thethree strongest cells, with known and allowed NCC part of BSIC, ineach of the frequency bands in the BA list, excluding the frequencyband of the serving cell.

Mandatory rules Equal to MULTIBAND_REPORTING (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 3 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 529 / 1176

Page 530: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.365 (MULTIBAND_REPORTING) - (MULTIBAND_REPORTING (MFS))

HMI Name MULTIBAND_REPORTINGParameter Name

Logical Name MULTIBAND_REPORTING (MFS)

Definition Minimum number of cells of each supported frequency band to beincluded in MEASUREMENT REPORT by the MS.

Coding rules Coded over 2 bits:00: normal reporting of the six strongest cells,with known and allowed NCC part of BSIC, irrespective of the bandused;01: the MS shall report the strongest cell, with known andallowed NCC part of BSIC, in each of the frequency bands in the BAlist, excluding the frequency band of the serving cell;10: the MS shallreport the two strongest cells, with known and allowed NCC partof BSIC, in each of the frequency bands in the BA list, excludingthe frequency band of the serving cell; 11: the MS shall report thethree strongest cells, with known and allowed NCC part of BSIC, ineach of the frequency bands in the BA list, excluding the frequencyband of the serving cell.

Mandatory rules Equal to MULTIBAND_REPORTING (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 3 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

530 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 531: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.366 (MULTIBAND_TRAFFIC_CONDITION) -(MULTIBAND_TRAFFIC_CONDITION)

HMI Name MULTIBAND_TRAFFIC_CONDITIONParameter Name

Logical Name MULTIBAND_TRAFFIC_CONDITION

Definition This parameter determines the condition on traffic load in the servingcell to trigger a multiband handover.

Coding rules 0: Any load, 1: Not low, 2: High

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 531 / 1176

Page 532: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.367 (N_BAD_SACCH) - (N_BAD_SACCH)

HMI Name N_BAD_SACCHParameter Name

Logical Name N_BAD_SACCH

Definition Number of consecutive bad SACCH frames to trigger a rescuehandover.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules 1) N_BAD_SACCH = RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS - N_BSTXPWR_M+ 12) In micro cells, it is recommended to set N_BAD_SACCH sothat T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP > N_BAD_SACCH * 480ms +30 seconds if T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP <> 0.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 0 128 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric N/A

Concentric Umbrella N/A

Microcell 4

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

532 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 533: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.368 (N_TCH_HO) - (N_TCH_HO)

HMI Name N_TCH_HOParameter Name

Logical Name N_TCH_HO

Definition Number of less interfered Full Rate TCH reserved for handover.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 533 / 1176

Page 534: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.369 (N_TRAFFIC_LOAD) - (N_TRAFFIC_LOAD)

HMI Name N_TRAFFIC_LOADParameter Name

Logical Name N_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Definition Number of consecutive load averages used in traffic load evaluationprocess.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 8 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

6 6 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2

534 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 535: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.370 (NB_CLR_REQ) - (N_CLR_REQ)

HMI Name NB_CLR_REQParameter Name

Logical Name N_CLR_REQ

Definition Maximum number of CLEAR REQUEST message transmission.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 8 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 535 / 1176

Page 536: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.371 (NB_PREF_CELLS) - (N_PREF_CELLS)

HMI Name NB_PREF_CELLSParameter Name

Logical Name N_PREF_CELLS

Definition Maximum number of candidate cells sent in one HANDOVERREQUIRED.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 16 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / Handover Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

536 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 537: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.372 (Nbr AC 11-15 unbarred in one step) - (M2)

HMI Name Nbr AC 11-15 unbarred in one stepParameter Name

Logical Name M2

Definition Number of high priority access classes (11..15) are unbarred in onestep.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 5 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 537 / 1176

Page 538: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.373 (Nbr. AC 0-9 barred in one step) - (N1)

HMI Name Nbr. AC 0-9 barred in one stepParameter Name

Logical Name N1

Definition Number of low priority access classes (0..9) are barred in one step.

Coding rules Value 0 inhibits the automatic barring of low priority access classes.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 10 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

538 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 539: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.374 (Nbr. AC 0-9 unbarred in one step) - (N2)

HMI Name Nbr. AC 0-9 unbarred in one stepParameter Name

Logical Name N2

Definition Number of low priority access classes (0..9) are unbarred in one step.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 539 / 1176

Page 540: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.375 (Nbr. AC 11-15 barred in one step) - (M1)

HMI Name Nbr. AC 11-15 barred in one stepParameter Name

Logical Name M1

Definition Number of high priority access classes (11..15) are barred in onestep.

Coding rules Value 0 inhibits the automatic barring of high priority access classes

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 5 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC /Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

540 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 541: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.376 (NBR_RESET_CIC_REP) - (NBR_RESET_CIC_REP)

HMI Name NBR_RESET_CIC_REPParameter Name

Logical Name NBR_RESET_CIC_REP

Definition Maximum number of RESET CIRCUIT message repetitions whennot acknowledged by the MSC.

Coding rules 255: RESET CIRCUIT message is indefinitely repeated

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 541 / 1176

Page 542: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.377 (NBR_RESET_REP) - (NBR_RESET_REP)

HMI Name NBR_RESET_REPParameter Name

Logical Name NBR_RESET_REP

Definition Number of times the RESET message is sent without beingacknowledged by the MSC before an alarm is reported.

Coding rules If NBR_RESET_REP = 0, RESET message is not sent

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 127 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

542 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 543: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.378 (NCC) - (NCC (BSC))

HMI Name NCCParameter Name

Logical Name NCC (BSC)

Definition Network Colour code of the cell.

Coding rules Coded over 3 bits.

Mandatory rules Equal to NCC (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description (+Edit External cell/ circuit1/2)

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 543 / 1176

Page 544: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.379 (NCC) - (NCC (MFS))

HMI Name NCCParameter Name

Logical Name NCC (MFS)

Definition Network Colour code of the cell.

Coding rules Coded over 3 bits.

Mandatory rules Equal to NCC (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description (+ Edit External cell/ circuit1/2)

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

544 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 545: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.380 (NCC) - (NCC(n))

HMI Name NCCParameter Name

Logical Name NCC(n)

Definition Network Colour code of the neighbour cell.

Coding rules Coded over 3 bits.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description (+ Edit External cell/ circuit1/2)

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here isfor implementation purposes.This parameter is for every cell. Theoperator needs only to configure the value of that parameter for OMCexternal cells ; the parameter is autonomously filled by the OMC incase the adjacent cell is an OMC internal cell

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 545 / 1176

Page 546: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.381 (NCC permitted) - (NCC_permitted)

HMI Name NCC permittedParameter Name

Logical Name NCC_permitted

Definition Indicates which NCC values the MS considers as belonging to thenetwork.

Coding rules Coded over 8 bits. each bit corresponds to a NCC value: MSBcorresponds to NCC = 7, LSB corresponds to NCC = 0. For eachbit:0= NCC not permitted, 1= NCC permitted

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type List of numbers

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment The value depends on configuration. The default value indicatedhere is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

546 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 547: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.382 (NCI) - (NCI)

HMI Name NCIParameter Name

Logical Name NCI

Definition This flag indicates to the MS if it reports a HANDOVER FAILURE incase of out of range timing advance.

Coding rules 0: Out of range timing advance is ignored, 1: Out of range timingadvance triggers a Handover Failure procedure

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 547 / 1176

Page 548: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.383 (NEIGHBOUR_RXLEV) - (NEIGHBOUR_RXLEV(0,n))

HMI Name NEIGHBOUR_RXLEVParameter Name

Logical Name NEIGHBOUR_RXLEV(0,n)

Definition Threshold of maximum received level from the neighbour cells forcause 13.

Coding rules coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -47

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric -47 dBm (63)

Concentric Umbrella -47 dBm (63)

Microcell N/A

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

548 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 549: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.384 (NUM_TCH_EMERGENCY_HO) - (NUM_TCH_EGNCY_HO)

HMI Name NUM_TCH_EMERGENCY_HOParameter Name

Logical Name NUM_TCH_EGNCY_HO

Definition Number of full rate TCH reserved for incoming emergency handovers(plus Cause 12 and Cause 27 handovers).

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / General HO Control

External Comment The Pre-emption procedure (in case EN_TCH_PREEMPT =enabled) might use these reserved TCHs in order to avoid releasingan on-going call unnecessarily.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 549 / 1176

Page 550: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.385 (NY_1) - (NY1)

HMI Name NY_1Parameter Name

Logical Name NY1

Definition Maximum number of repetitions of PHYSICAL INFORMATION.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules For rules, see T3105_D and T3105_F_FR, T3105_F_HR.

Recommended rules For rules, see T3105_D and T3105_F_FR, T3105_F_HR.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 3 35 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

550 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 551: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.386 (OFFSET_CA_HIGH) - (OFFSET_CA_HIGH)

HMI Name OFFSET_CA_HIGHParameter Name

Logical Name OFFSET_CA_HIGH

Definition Offset for AMR channel adaptation hysteresis under high load.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 (0 coded as 0, 0.1 coded as 1 7 coded as 70)

Mandatory rules OFFSET_CA_HIGH >= OFFSET_CA_NORMAL

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 551 / 1176

Page 552: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.387 (OFFSET_CA_NORMAL) - (OFFSET_CA_NORMAL)

HMI Name OFFSET_CA_NORMALParameter Name

Logical Name OFFSET_CA_NORMAL

Definition Offset for AMR channel adaptation hysteresis under normal load.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 (0 coded as 0, 0.1 coded as 1 7 coded as 70)

Mandatory rules OFFSET_CA_HIGH >= OFFSET_CA_NORMAL

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

552 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 553: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.388 (OFFSET_HO_MARGIN_INNER) - (OFFSET_HO_MARGIN_INNER)

HMI Name OFFSET_HO_MARGIN_INNERParameter Name

Logical Name OFFSET_HO_MARGIN_INNER

Definition Offset which allows to take into account the radio differencesbetween the inner and the outer zone (especially in multiband cells).

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -127 127 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 553 / 1176

Page 554: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.389 (OFFSET_HOPPING_HO) - (Offset_Hopping_HO)

HMI Name OFFSET_HOPPING_HOParameter Name

Logical Name Offset_Hopping_HO

Definition Offset applied in the handover quality causes for radio hoppingchannels.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

554 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 555: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.390 (OFFSET_HOPPING_PC) - (Offset_Hopping_PC)

HMI Name OFFSET_HOPPING_PCParameter Name

Logical Name Offset_Hopping_PC

Definition Offset applied in the power control quality causes for hopping radiochannels.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 555 / 1176

Page 556: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.391 (OUTDOOR_UMB_LEV) - (OUTDOOR_UMB_LEV(0,n))

HMI Name OUTDOOR_UMB_LEVParameter Name

Logical Name OUTDOOR_UMB_LEV(0,n)

Definition Minimum received level from umbrella cell n to allow handover cause"level uplink micro-cell" or "level downlink micro-cell".

Coding rules coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -80

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Low Layer HO Ctrl (+ Edit Adjacency)

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric N/A

Concentric Umbrella N/A

Microcell -88 dBm (22)

Minicell -88 dBm (22)

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

556 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 557: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.392 (PAGING) - (PAG_BAR)

HMI Name PAGINGParameter Name

Logical Name PAG_BAR

Definition This flag indicates if transmission of Pagings is allowed in the cell.

Coding rules 0: Pagings are not barred, 1: Pagings are barred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment this flag can be used by an operator to temporarily prevent phonesfrom ringing in specific cells

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 557 / 1176

Page 558: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.393 (PENALTY_TIME) - (PENALTY_TIME(BSC))

HMI Name PENALTY_TIMEParameter Name

Logical Name PENALTY_TIME(BSC)

Definition Time during which MS shall apply TEMPORARY_OFFSET to C2criterion.

Coding rules step size = 20s. 0: 20s, 1: 40s, ..., 30: 620s, 31: TEMPORARYOFFSET ignored and cell_RESELECT_OFFSET has a negativevalue

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 20 620 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment –

Single inhibited (31)

Umbrella inhibited (31)

Concentric inhibited (31)

Concentric Umbrella inhibited (31)

Microcell 20 s (0)

Minicell 20 s (0)

Extended inner cell inhibited (31)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell inhibited (31)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

558 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 559: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.394 (PENALTY_TIME) - (PENALTY_TIME(MFS))

HMI Name PENALTY_TIMEParameter Name

Logical Name PENALTY_TIME(MFS)

Definition Time during which MS shall apply TEMPORARY_OFFSET to C2criterion.

Coding rules step size = 20s. 0: 20s, 1: 40s, ..., 30: 620s, 31: TEMPORARYOFFSET ignored and cell_RESELECT_OFFSET has a negativevalue.

Mandatory rules PENALTY_TIME(MFS) = PENALTY_TIME(BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 20 620 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 559 / 1176

Page 560: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.395 (PENALTY_TIME) - (PENALTY_TIME(n)(MFS))

HMI Name PENALTY_TIMEParameter Name

Logical Name PENALTY_TIME(n)(MFS)

Definition Time during which MS shall apply TEMPORARY_OFFSET to C2criterion.

Coding rules step size = 20s. 0: 20s, 1: 40s, ..., 30: 620s, 31: TEMPORARYOFFSET ignored and cell_RESELECT_OFFSET has a negativevalue

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 20 620 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit external cell / packet

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

560 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 561: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.396 (PING_PONG_HANDICAP) - (PING_PONG_HCP)

HMI Name PING_PONG_HANDICAPParameter Name

Logical Name PING_PONG_HCP

Definition A transient handicap is applied to power budget of previous cell toavoid a "ping-pong" effect.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 127 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 561 / 1176

Page 562: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.397 (POW_INC_FACTOR) - (POW_INC_FACTOR)

HMI Name POW_INC_FACTORParameter Name

Logical Name POW_INC_FACTOR

Definition Weighting factor for power increase.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules POW_INC_FACTOR >= POW_RED_FACTOR

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0.8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

562 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 563: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.398 (POW_INC_STEP_SIZE) - (POW_INC_STEP_SIZE)

HMI Name POW_INC_STEP_SIZEParameter Name

Logical Name POW_INC_STEP_SIZE

Definition Power increase step size in case of power command triggered onquality criterion.

Coding rules step size = 2dB. 1: 2dB, 2: 4dB, ..., 7: 14 dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules POW_INC_STEP_SIZE > POW_RED_STEP_SIZE

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 2 14 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 563 / 1176

Page 564: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.399 (POW_RED_FACTOR) - (POW_RED_FACTOR)

HMI Name POW_RED_FACTORParameter Name

Logical Name POW_RED_FACTOR

Definition Weighting factor for power reduction.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules POW_RED_FACTOR <= POW_INC_FACTOR

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

564 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 565: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.400 (POW_RED_STEP_SIZE) - (POW_RED_STEP_SIZE)

HMI Name POW_RED_STEP_SIZEParameter Name

Logical Name POW_RED_STEP_SIZE

Definition Power reduction step size in case of power command triggered onquality criterion.

Coding rules step size = 2dB. 1: 2dB, 2: 4dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules POW_RED_STEP_SIZE < POW_INC_STEP_SIZE

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 2 4 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 565 / 1176

Page 566: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.401 (Preference Mark) - (TRX_PREF_MARK)

HMI Name Preference MarkParameter Name

Logical Name TRX_PREF_MARK

Definition Preference mark assigned to a given TRX.

Coding rules 0: PS/CS TRX: This TRX can carry PS and CS traffic and has thelowest preference in the TCH sub-channel selection process usedto serve a CS call. 1: CS TRX with preference mark 1: This TRXcan carry only CS traffic and has the preference mark 1 in the TCHsub-channel selection process used to serve a CS call.7: CS TRXwith preference mark 7: This TRX can carry only CS traffic and hasthe highest preference in the TCH sub-channel selection processused to served a CS call. It means that this TRX has the highestpriority for CS traffic.

Mandatory rules 1) For a TRX in the inner zone of a monoband or multiband concentriccell, the parameter TRX_PREF_MARK shall be set to a non-nullvalue.2) For a hopping G1 TRX, if EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY =0 then TRX_PREF_MARK <> 03)The following conditions are verifiedby the OMC-R in order to check the upper limit of MAX_PDCH:i)MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) -1 if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF= "1: CCCH combined"ii) MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs withTRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 2 if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCHTRX and CCCH_CONF = "0: CCCH not combined"iii) MAX_PDCH<= NB_TS_MPDCH + 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0)if TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0 on BCCH TRX.4) In case of cell sharedover 2 BTSs, the GPRS TRXs of the cell (ie TRX_PREF_MARK=0)can be either on the main sector or on the secondary, but not on both.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance TRX

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / TRX Configuration

566 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 567: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

External Comment If EGPRS is activated in the cell, TRX_PREF_MARK (BCCH TRX)= 0 and the BCCH TRX is associated to a TRE hardware and atransmission pool allowing the usage of 8-PSK, the operator shallensure that the difference in the mean output powers between GSMKand 8-PSK signals is less than 2 dB in order to be compliant with3GPP TS 05.05 and 3GPP TS 05.08 requirements (or 4 dB if anSDCCH timeslot is defined in timeslot number 7 of the BCCH TRX).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 567 / 1176

Page 568: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.402 (PREFERRED_BAND) - (PREFERRED_BAND)

HMI Name PREFERRED_BANDParameter Name

Logical Name PREFERRED_BAND

Definition Frequency band to which the multiband MS are preferentiallydirected.

Coding rules 0: none, 1: GSM, 2: DCS

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

568 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 569: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.403 (Preventive cyclic retransmission flag) - (EN_PCR)

HMI Name Preventive cyclic retransmission flagParameter Name

Logical Name EN_PCR

Definition This flag enables preventive cyclic retransmission.

Coding rules 0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment This parameter is set to 1 by the BSC in case the Ater links of a BSSare configured as satellite links.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 569 / 1176

Page 570: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.404 (PWRC) - (PWRC (BSC))

HMI Name PWRCParameter Name

Logical Name PWRC (BSC)

Definition This flag indicates to the MS if it includes measurements made onBCCH frequency in case of frequency hopping channel.

Coding rules 0: measurements made on BCCH frequency are included, 1:measurements made on BCCH frequency are not included.

Mandatory rules Equal to PWRC (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

570 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 571: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.405 (PWRC) - (PWRC (MFS))

HMI Name PWRCParameter Name

Logical Name PWRC (MFS)

Definition This flag indicates to the MS whether or not it shall includemeasurements made on BCCH frequency in case of frequencyhopping channel.

Coding rules 0: measurements made on BCCH frequency shall be included, 1:measurements made on BCCH frequency shall not be included

Mandatory rules Equal to PWRC (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 571 / 1176

Page 572: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.406 (Q703_N1) - (Q703_N1)

HMI Name Q703_N1Parameter Name

Logical Name Q703_N1

Definition Maximum number of MSU available for retransmission.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 127 127

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment not used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

572 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 573: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.407 (Q703_N1_HSL) - (Q703_N1_HSL)

HMI Name Q703_N1_HSLParameter Name

Logical Name Q703_N1_HSL

Definition Maximum number of MSU available for retransmission (if HSL isused).

Coding rules step size 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 4095 4095

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 573 / 1176

Page 574: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.408 (Q703_N2) - (Q703_N2)

HMI Name Q703_N2Parameter Name

Logical Name Q703_N2

Definition Maximum number of MSU octets which are available forretransmission.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bytes 1 8192 4096

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment not used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

574 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 575: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.409 (Q703_N2_HSL) - (Q703_N2_HSL)

HMI Name Q703_N2_HSLParameter Name

Logical Name Q703_N2_HSL

Definition Maximum number of MSU octets which are available forretransmission (if HSL is used).

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bytes 1 65535 32767

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 575 / 1176

Page 576: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.410 (Q703_T1) - (Q703_T1)

HMI Name Q703_T1Parameter Name

Logical Name Q703_T1

Definition MTP2 timer "alignment ready".

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 40 50 50

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment not used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

576 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 577: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.411 (Q703_T1_HSL) - (Q703_T1_HSL)

HMI Name Q703_T1_HSLParameter Name

Logical Name Q703_T1_HSL

Definition MTP2 timer "alignment ready" for 2Mbit/s (if HSL is used).

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 25 350 300

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 577 / 1176

Page 578: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.412 (Q703_T2) - (Q703_T2)

HMI Name Q703_T2Parameter Name

Logical Name Q703_T2

Definition MTP2 timer "not aligned".

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 5 150 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

578 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 579: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.413 (Q703_T3) - (Q703_T3)

HMI Name Q703_T3Parameter Name

Logical Name Q703_T3

Definition MTP2 timer "aligned".

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 2 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 579 / 1176

Page 580: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.414 (Q703_T4E) - (Q703_T4E)

HMI Name Q703_T4EParameter Name

Logical Name Q703_T4E

Definition MTP2 Emergency proving period.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.4 0.6 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment Applicable to LSL and HSL.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

580 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 581: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.415 (Q703_T4N) - (Q703_T4N)

HMI Name Q703_T4NParameter Name

Logical Name Q703_T4N

Definition MTP2 Normal proving period.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 7.5 9.5 8.2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment not used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 581 / 1176

Page 582: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.416 (Q703_T4N_HSL) - (Q703_T4N_HSL)

HMI Name Q703_T4N_HSLParameter Name

Logical Name Q703_T4N_HSL

Definition MTP2 Normal proving period for 2Mbit/s (if HSL is used).

Coding rules step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 3 70 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

582 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 583: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.417 (Q703_T5) - (Q703_T5)

HMI Name Q703_T5Parameter Name

Logical Name Q703_T5

Definition MTP2 timer "sending SIB".

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 80 120 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 583 / 1176

Page 584: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.418 (Q703_T6) - (Q703_T6)

HMI Name Q703_T6Parameter Name

Logical Name Q703_T6

Definition MTP2 timer "remote congestion".

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules Q707_T1 >= Q703_T6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 3 6 5.4

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

584 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 585: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.419 (Q703_T7) - (Q703_T7)

HMI Name Q703_T7Parameter Name

Logical Name Q703_T7

Definition MTP2 timer "excessive delay of acknowledgement".

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 2 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment In case of a Ater satellite connection, this parameter is set to 2seconds by the BSC.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 585 / 1176

Page 586: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.420 (Q704_T2) - (Q704_T2)

HMI Name Q704_T2Parameter Name

Logical Name Q704_T2

Definition MTP3 timer supervising the reception of changeoveracknowledgement.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.7 2 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

586 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 587: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.421 (Q704_T4) - (Q704_T4)

HMI Name Q704_T4Parameter Name

Logical Name Q704_T4

Definition MTP3 timer supervising the reception of changebackacknowledgement (first attempt).

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 1.2 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 587 / 1176

Page 588: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.422 (Q704_T5) - (Q704_T5)

HMI Name Q704_T5Parameter Name

Logical Name Q704_T5

Definition MTP3 timer supervising the reception of changebackacknowledgement (second attempt).

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 1.2 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

588 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 589: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.423 (Q707_T1) - (Q707_T1)

HMI Name Q707_T1Parameter Name

Logical Name Q707_T1

Definition MTP3 timer supervising the reception of signalling link testacknowledgement.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules Q707_T1 >= Q703_T6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 4 12 6.4

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 589 / 1176

Page 590: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.424 (Q707_T2) - (Q707_T2)

HMI Name Q707_T2Parameter Name

Logical Name Q707_T2

Definition MTP3 delay between transmission of consecutive signalling linktest message.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 30 90 60

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

590 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 591: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.425 (RACH/PRACH_TA_FILTER) - (RACH_TA_FILTER (BSC))

HMI Name RACH/PRACH_TA_FILTERParameter Name

Logical Name RACH_TA_FILTER (BSC)

Definition Timing Advance threshold for CHANNEL REQUIRED and PACKETCHANNEL REQUEST filtering.

Coding rules 64: no filtering

Mandatory rules Equal to RACH_TA_FILTER (MFS).

Recommended rules Disable the filtering for extended cells.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 0 64 64

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment One unit corresponds to a distance of about 550m. CHANNELREQUIRED or PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST messages withTiming Advance greater or equal to RACH_TA_FILTER arediscarded.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 591 / 1176

Page 592: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.426 (RACH_BUSY_THRES) - (RACH_BUSY_THRES)

HMI Name RACH_BUSY_THRESParameter Name

Logical Name RACH_BUSY_THRES

Definition Received level above which a RACH TS is deemed busy.

Coding rules This parameter is encoded with a step size of 4 dB as follows:1:-110 dBm5: -106 dBm9: -102 dBm13: -98 dBm17: -94 dBm21:-90 dBm25: -86 dBm29: -82 dBm33: -78 dBm37: -74 dBm41: -70dBm45: -66 dBm49: -62 dBm53: -58 dBm57: -54 dBm61: -50 dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -50 -106

Modifiable OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

592 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 593: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.427 (RADIOLINK_FAILURE_THRES) - (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS)

HMI Name RADIOLINK_FAILURE_THRESParameter Name

Logical Name RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS

Definition Counter threshold to detect a radio link failure on the uplink path.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS > N_BSTXPWR_M

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 128 18

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / Radio Link Supervision

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 593 / 1176

Page 594: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.428 (RADIOLINK_FAILURE_THRES_AMR) -(RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS_AMR)

HMI Name RADIOLINK_FAILURE_THRES_AMRParameter Name

Logical Name RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS_AMR

Definition Counter threshold to detect a radio link failure on the uplink pathfor calls using an AMR codec.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS_AMR > N_BSTXPWR_M

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 128 18

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter applies only to Evolium BTSs.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

594 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 595: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.429 (RADIOLINK_RECOVERY_THRES) - (N_BSTXPWR_M)

HMI Name RADIOLINK_RECOVERY_THRESParameter Name

Logical Name N_BSTXPWR_M

Definition Counter threshold to trigger a radio link recovery.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules N_BSTXPWR_M < RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 0 127 13

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / Radio Link Supervision

External Comment –

Single 13

Umbrella 13

Concentric 13

Concentric Umbrella 13

Microcell 15

Minicell 13

Extended inner cell 13

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 13

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 595 / 1176

Page 596: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.430 (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT) - (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (BSC))

HMI Name RADIOLINK_TIMEOUTParameter Name

Logical Name RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (BSC)

Definition Initial value of MS counter for radio link supervision.

Coding rules step size = 4 Samfr, coded from 0 to 15 (0 == 4 Samfr, 1 == 8 Samfr... 15 == 64 Samfr

Mandatory rules Equal to RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 4 64 16

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

596 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 597: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.431 (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT) - (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (MFS))

HMI Name RADIOLINK_TIMEOUTParameter Name

Logical Name RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (MFS)

Definition Initial value of MS counter for radio link supervision.

Coding rules step size = 4 Samfr, coded from 0 to 15 (0 == 4 Samfr, 1 == 8 Samfr... 15 == 64 Samfr

Mandatory rules Equal to RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 4 64 16

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 597 / 1176

Page 598: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.432 (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_AMR) - (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_AMR)

HMI Name RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_AMRParameter Name

Logical Name RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_AMR

Definition Initial value of MS counter for radio link supervision, when an AMRcodec is used.

Coding rules step size = 4 Samfr, coded from 0 to 15 (0 == 4 Samfr, 1 == 8 Samfr... 15 == 64 Samfr

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 4 64 16

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter applies only to Evolium BTSs.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

598 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 599: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.433 (Reserved Slots Number for Basic CBCH) -(Nb_of_reserved_slots_for_basic_CBCH)

HMI Name Reserved Slots Number for Basic CBCHParameter Name

Logical Name Nb_of_reserved_slots_for_basic_CBCH

Definition This parameter indicates the number of slots reserved for highpriority messages within the schedule period for basic CBCH.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules shall be set to "0" when SMSCB_FEATURE_SET="FS1"

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 40 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / SMSCB

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 599 / 1176

Page 600: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.434 (Reserved Slots Number for Extended CBCH) -(Nb_of_reserved_slots_for_extended_CBCH)

HMI Name Reserved Slots Number for Extended CBCHParameter Name

Logical Name Nb_of_reserved_slots_for_extended_CBCH

Definition This parameter indicates the number of slots reserved for highpriority messages within the schedule period for extended CBCH.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 40 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / SMSCB

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

600 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 601: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.435 (RESET_INDEFINITE) - (RESET_INDEFINITE)

HMI Name RESET_INDEFINITEParameter Name

Logical Name RESET_INDEFINITE

Definition This flag determines whether or not the RESET message shall besent indefinitely (as long as it is not acknowledged).

Coding rules 0: RESET message is sent a maximum of NBR_RESET_REP times,1: The Reset procedure is repeated until a RESET or RESET ACKmessage is received.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 601 / 1176

Page 602: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.436 (RESP_REQ) - (RESP_REQ)

HMI Name RESP_REQParameter Name

Logical Name RESP_REQ

Definition This flag controls "Response request" OIE inclusion in HANDOVERREQUIRED.

Coding rules 0: IE not included, 1: IE included

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules When the VGCS feature (EN_VGCS) is activated, it is recommendedto include the Response Request in the HANDOVER REQUIREDmessage (RESP_REQ).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment Default value depends on MSC typeFor external directed retries,the serving BSC does not know whether or not the external targetcells (towards which the directed retry is triggered) are congested.Therefore, Alcatel recommend to set RESP_REQ to 1 if EN_EXT_DRis set to enabled in order to get a Handover Reject message fromthe MSC in case all target cells are congested and thus to attemptother procedures.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

602 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 603: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.437 (RF_RES_IND_PERIOD) - (T_INTRF_L3)

HMI Name RF_RES_IND_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name T_INTRF_L3

Definition Delay between two consecutive RF RESOURCE INDICATION.

Coding rules step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules T_INTRF_L3 > Max (T11, T_qho, T11_FORCED) & T_INTRF_L3 >INTAVE

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 10 180 60

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 603 / 1176

Page 604: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.438 (RMS_TEMPLATE) - (RMS_TEMPLATE_INDEX)

HMI Name RMS_TEMPLATEParameter Name

Logical Name RMS_TEMPLATE_INDEX

Definition Template of values of RMS parameters to be applied to theconcerned cell (concerns the parameters MEAS_STAT_C_Ix,MEAS_STAT_BFIx, MEAS_STAT_LEVx, MEAS_STAT_PATH_BALx,MEAS_STAT_Sx, EN_BALANCED_CI, VQ_AVERAGE,VQ_BAD_RXFER, VQ_FER_THRESHOLD, VQ_GOOD_RXFER,VQ_INTF_THRESHOLD, VQ_RXLEV, VQ_RXQUAL,VQ_RXQUAL_VS_RXFER).

Coding rules coded from 1 to 16

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 16 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / RMS & MAFA

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

604 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 605: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.439 (ROT) - (ROT)

HMI Name ROTParameter Name

Logical Name ROT

Definition Indicates to the MS whether or not it shall include "Time Difference"IE in HANDOVER COMPLETE.

Coding rules 0: "Mobile Time Difference" IE is NOT included in HANDOVERCOMPLETE, 1: "Mobile Time Difference" IE is included inHANDOVER COMPLETE

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 605 / 1176

Page 606: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.440 (RSL_RATE (BSC)) - (RSL_RATE (BSC))

HMI Name RSL_RATE (BSC)Parameter Name

Logical Name RSL_RATE (BSC)

Definition Rate used on all RSL links towards a BTS.

Coding rules 0: 16 kbit/s, 1: 64 kbit/s

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BTS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

606 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 607: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.441 (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (BSC))

HMI Name RXLEV_ACCESS_MINParameter Name

Logical Name RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (BSC)

Definition Minimum received level at the MS required for initial access to thecell.

Coding rules Coded on 6 bits, 0=-110 dBm, 63=-47 dBm, step size=1dBm.

Mandatory rules RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (MFS) = RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 607 / 1176

Page 608: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.442 (RXLEV_DL_IH) - (RXLEV_DL_IH)

HMI Name RXLEV_DL_IHParameter Name

Logical Name RXLEV_DL_IH

Definition Downlink level threshold for decision between intracell and intercellhandover in case of bad downlink quality.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules RXLEV_DL_IH > L_RXLEV_DL_H

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -65

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Single -65 dBm (45)

Umbrella -65 dBm (45)

Concentric -65 dBm (45)

Concentric Umbrella -65 dBm (45)

Microcell -65 dBm (45)

Minicell -65 dBm (45)

Extended inner cell -70 dBm (40)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell -60 dBm (50)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

608 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 609: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.443 (RXLEV_DL_ZONE) - (RXLEV_DL_ZONE)

HMI Name RXLEV_DL_ZONEParameter Name

Logical Name RXLEV_DL_ZONE

Definition Downlink level threshold for inner to outer zone handover.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules If CELL_PARTITION_TYPE = "Concentric" ANDFREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM" or "DCS1800" or"EGSM" or "DCS 1900":RXLEV_DL_ZONE >= L_RXLEV_DL_H(This rule only applies to concentric and monoband cell.)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -71

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric -71 dBm (39)

Concentric Umbrella -71 dBm (39)

Microcell N/A

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 609 / 1176

Page 610: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.444 (RXLEV_LIMIT_PBGT_HO) - (RXLEV_LIMIT_PBGT_HO)

HMI Name RXLEV_LIMIT_PBGT_HOParameter Name

Logical Name RXLEV_LIMIT_PBGT_HO

Definition Threshold on the downlink received level above which it is notnecessary to trigger a handover on power budget (cause 12).

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits:0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -47

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Single -65 dBm (45)

Umbrella -65 dBm (45)

Concentric -65 dBm (45)

Concentric Umbrella -65 dBm (45)

Microcell -65 dBm (45)

Minicell -65 dBm (45)

Extended inner cell -70 dBm (40)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell -60 dBm (50)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

610 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 611: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.445 (RXLEV_MIN_n) - (RXLEVmin(n))

HMI Name RXLEV_MIN_nParameter Name

Logical Name RXLEVmin(n)

Definition Minimum level received from cell n to allow reception of handover.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -96

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection (+ Edit External cell/ circuit1/2)

External Comment –

Single -100 dBm (10)

Umbrella -100 dBm (10)

Concentric -100 dBm (10)

Concentric Umbrella -100 dBm (10)

Microcell -100 dBm (10)

Minicell -100 dBm (10)

Extended inner cell -100 dBm (10)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell -102 dBm (8)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 611 / 1176

Page 612: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.446 (RXLEV_UL_IH) - (RXLEV_UL_IH)

HMI Name RXLEV_UL_IHParameter Name

Logical Name RXLEV_UL_IH

Definition Uplink level threshold for decision between intracell and intercellhandover in case of bad uplink quality.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules RXLEV_UL_IH > L_RXLEV_UL_H

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -65

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Single -75 dBm (35)

Umbrella -75 dBm (35)

Concentric -75 dBm (35)

Concentric Umbrella -75 dBm (35)

Microcell -65 dBm (45)

Minicell -70 dBm (40)

Extended inner cell -75 dBm (35)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell -75 dBm (35)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

612 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 613: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.447 (RXLEV_UL_ZONE) - (RXLEV_UL_ZONE)

HMI Name RXLEV_UL_ZONEParameter Name

Logical Name RXLEV_UL_ZONE

Definition Uplink level threshold for inner to outer zone handover.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules If CELL_PARTITION_TYPE = "Concentric" ANDFREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM" or "DCS1800" or"EGSM" or "DCS 1900":RXLEV_UL_ZONE >= L_RXLEV_UL_H(This rule only applies to concentric and monoband cell.)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -78

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric -78 dBm (32)

Concentric Umbrella -78 dBm (32)

Microcell N/A

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 613 / 1176

Page 614: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.448 (Schedule Period for Basic CBCH) -(Schedule_period_for_basic_CBCH)

HMI Name Schedule Period for Basic CBCHParameter Name

Logical Name Schedule_period_for_basic_CBCH

Definition Length of the DRX schedule period for the basic CBCH.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

CBper 0 40 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / SMSCB

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

614 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 615: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.449 (Schedule period for Extended CBCH) -(Schedule_period_for_extended_CBCH)

HMI Name Schedule period for Extended CBCHParameter Name

Logical Name Schedule_period_for_extended_CBCH

Definition Length of the DRX schedule period for the extended CBCH.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

CBper 0 40 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / SMSCB

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 615 / 1176

Page 616: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.450 (SDCCH_COUNTER) - (SDCCH_COUNTER)

HMI Name SDCCH_COUNTERParameter Name

Logical Name SDCCH_COUNTER

Definition Time during which SDCCH handovers are forbidden after completionof the Immediate Assignment procedure.

Coding rules step size=1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules SDCCH_COUNTER <= T_SDCCH_PC

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

2 x Samfr 0 31 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment "0" means that SDCCH handover is immediately allowed aftercompletion of the Immediate Assignment procedure.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

616 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 617: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.451 (SDCCH_HO) - (HO_SDCCH_INHIBIT)

HMI Name SDCCH_HOParameter Name

Logical Name HO_SDCCH_INHIBIT

Definition The flag inhibits/enables the execution of SDCCH handovers.

Coding rules 0: SDCCH HO enabled1: SDCCH HO disabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment This parameter has no influence on Directed Retry

Single enable (0)

Umbrella enable (0)

Concentric enable (0)

Concentric Umbrella enable (0)

Microcell enable (0)

Minicell enable (0)

Extended inner cell disabled (1) *

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell disabled (1) *

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 617 / 1176

Page 618: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.452 (Send_CM_Enquiry) - (BSS_SEND_CM_ENQUIRY)

HMI Name Send_CM_EnquiryParameter Name

Logical Name BSS_SEND_CM_ENQUIRY

Definition Controls the trigger of Classmark Enquiry procedure at callestablishment time.

Coding rules 0: the classmark enquiry is never initiated by the BSC;1: onreception of a LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST message with ESIND flag set to 0, the BSC will always initiate a classmark enquiry;2:on reception of a LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST message withES IND flag set to 0, the BSC will initiate the classmark enquiry ifalgorithm A5/1 is not available (information available in MS classmark1 IE sent in the LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST).

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

618 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 619: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.453 (Signalling Link Code) - (SLC)

HMI Name Signalling Link CodeParameter Name

Logical Name SLC

Definition Signalling Link Code.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance N7 ch

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 15 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: EML RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access BSS parameters / A interface info

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 619 / 1176

Page 620: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.454 (SMSCB_Features_Set) - (SMSCB_Features_set)

HMI Name SMSCB_Features_SetParameter Name

Logical Name SMSCB_Features_set

Definition This parameter indicates which features are usable with the SMSCBproduct.

Coding rules 1: Features set 1, 2: Features set 2

Mandatory rules Can be changed only when SMSCB_STATE = "inactive".IfSMSCB_Features_set = FS1, then CBC_Window shall be equalto "1"- If SMSCB_Features_set = FS1, then SMSCB_Recoveryshall be set to "No"- If SMSCB_Features_set = FS1, thenfor all the BSC cells Use_of_Extended_CBCH shall be set to"No"- If SMSCB_Features_set = FS1, then for all the BSC cellsNb_of_reserved_slots_for_basic_CBCH shall be set to "0"

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 2 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment When migrating from FS1 to FS2,USE_OF_EXTENDED_CBCHshall be set to "Yes",CBC_WINDOW shall be set to 4.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

620 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 621: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.455 (SMSCB_Phase) - (SMSCB_Phase)

HMI Name SMSCB_PhaseParameter Name

Logical Name SMSCB_Phase

Definition This parameter indicates whether the feature operates in GSMPhase2 or Phase 2+ mode.

Coding rules 0: Phase 2, 1: Phase 2+

Mandatory rules If SMSCB_FEATURES_SET="FS1", SMSCB_PHASE shall be setto "phase2"'If SMSCB_FEATURES_SET="FS2", SMSCB_PHASEshall be set to "phase2+"SMSCB_Phase can be changed only whenSMSCB_STATE="inactive"

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 621 / 1176

Page 622: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.456 (SMSCB_Recovery) - (SMSCB_Recovery)

HMI Name SMSCB_RecoveryParameter Name

Logical Name SMSCB_Recovery

Definition This parameter indicates if the CBC accepts the recovery-indicationin Restart-Indication message.

Coding rules 0: No, 1: Yes

Mandatory rules shall be set to "No" when SMSCB_FEATURE_SET="FS1"can bechanged only when SMSCB_STATE="inactive"

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

622 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 623: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.457 (SMSCB_State) - (SMSCB_State)

HMI Name SMSCB_StateParameter Name

Logical Name SMSCB_State

Definition This flag indicates if the feature is activated or deactivated.

Coding rules 0: activated, 1: deactivated

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 623 / 1176

Page 624: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.458 (Strip_Octet_5_In_CM2) - (STRIP_O5_CM2)

HMI Name Strip_Octet_5_In_CM2Parameter Name

Logical Name STRIP_O5_CM2

Definition This flag controls the format of the "Classmark 2" IE sent to the MSC.

Coding rules 0: no modification on "Classmark2" IE, 1: octet 5 of "Classmark2" IEis stripped out

Mandatory rules EN_SEND_CM3 and STRIP_O5_CM2 shall not be both set to 1 atthe same time.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type.The value indicated here is forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

624 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 625: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.459 (SYNCHRONISED_HO) - (EN_SYNCHRONISED_HO)

HMI Name SYNCHRONISED_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_SYNCHRONISED_HO

Definition This flag enables/disables synchronous handovers betweensynchronized cells.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules EN_SYNCHRONISED_HO shall be set to disabled whenCELL_TYPE is equal to "Extended inner" or "Extended outer".

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 625 / 1176

Page 626: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.460 (T(conn est)) - (T(conn est))

HMI Name T(conn est)Parameter Name

Logical Name T(conn est)

Definition SCCP timer supervising the reception of Connection Confirmmessage.

Coding rules step size = 0.5sec

Mandatory rules T(conn est) < T9105

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 10 127.5 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

626 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 627: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.461 (T(iar)) - (T(iar))

HMI Name T(iar)Parameter Name

Logical Name T(iar)

Definition SCCP timer supervising the activity on SCCP connection.

Coding rules step size = 6sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules Must be greater than T(ias) used by the MSCIt is recommended toconfigure T(iar) > (2 x T(ias) used by the MSC) + 1 min

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 402 1530 1260

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 627 / 1176

Page 628: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.462 (T(ias)) - (T(ias))

HMI Name T(ias)Parameter Name

Logical Name T(ias)

Definition SCCP timer supervising the sending of Inactivity Test message.

Coding rules step size = 6sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules Must be less than T(iar) used by the MSCIt is recommended toconfigure T(ias) < (T(iar) used by the MSC - 1 min) / 2

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 96 450 300

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

628 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 629: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.463 (T(rel)) - (T(rel))

HMI Name T(rel)Parameter Name

Logical Name T(rel)

Definition SCCP timer supervising the reception of Release Completemessage.

Coding rules step size = 0.5sec, coded from 16 to 255, 16 == 8 sec, 255 == 127.5sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 8 127.5 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 629 / 1176

Page 630: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.464 (T(sst)) - (T(sst))

HMI Name T(sst)Parameter Name

Logical Name T(sst)

Definition SCCP delay between sending of consecutive Subsystem Status Testmessages.

Coding rules step size = 6sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 6 1200 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

630 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 631: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.465 (T_BIND_CNF) - (T_BIND_CNF)

HMI Name T_BIND_CNFParameter Name

Logical Name T_BIND_CNF

Definition Maximum waiting time to get a response to a CBSE-BIND primitive.

Coding rules step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules Can be changed only when SMSCB_State is disabled

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 10 300 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 631 / 1176

Page 632: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.466 (T_BURST) - (T_BURST)

HMI Name T_BURSTParameter Name

Logical Name T_BURST

Definition Delay between consecutive bursts of BLOCK or UNBLOCKmessages.

Coding rules step size =0.1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules (31 x T_BURST) / B_NUM < T1_short

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 25.5 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

632 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 633: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.467 (T_HCP) - (T_HCP)

HMI Name T_HCPParameter Name

Logical Name T_HCP

Definition Time during which PING_PONG_HCP is applied after handover.

Coding rules step size= 1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 240 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 633 / 1176

Page 634: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.468 (T_HO_REQD_LOST) - (T_HO_REQD_LOST)

HMI Name T_HO_REQD_LOSTParameter Name

Logical Name T_HO_REQD_LOST

Definition Supervision of the MSC response after sending of HANDOVERREQUIRED.

Coding rules step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules T_HO_REQD_LOST > T7

Recommended rules T_HO_REQD_LOST value shall be greater than the maximum timefor external handover execution

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 6 120 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment Depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

634 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 635: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.469 (T_IA) - (T_IA)

HMI Name T_IAParameter Name

Logical Name T_IA

Definition Indicates the maximum time a CS IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENTmessage remains in the AGCH queue.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules T_IA<T3101

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 5 2.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 635 / 1176

Page 636: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.470 (T_INHIBIT_CPT) - (T_INHIBIT_CPT)

HMI Name T_INHIBIT_CPTParameter Name

Logical Name T_INHIBIT_CPT

Definition Time during which the HO Causes 14, 21, and 24 are inhibited.

Coding rules step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 240 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Hierarchical & Multiband HO Control

External Comment T_INHIBIT_CPT = 0 inhibits the anti ping-pong function.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

636 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 637: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.471 (T_MS_CELL_REJ) - (T_MS_CELL_REJ)

HMI Name T_MS_CELL_REJParameter Name

Logical Name T_MS_CELL_REJ

Definition Delay where the cells the MS failed to handover, cannot be selectedas targets in subsequent handover attempts.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 20 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 637 / 1176

Page 638: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.472 (T_PAG_CS) - (T_PAG_CS (BSC))

HMI Name T_PAG_CSParameter Name

Logical Name T_PAG_CS (BSC)

Definition This timer indicates the maximum time a CS PAGING message canremain in a Paging Group Queue. It includes the round-trip delay onA and A-bis or Gs/Gb and A-bis interface.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules Equal to T_PAG_CS (MFS)

Recommended rules T_PAG_CS<T3113 (MSC timer)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

638 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 639: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.473 (T_PAG_CS) - (T_PAG_CS (MFS))

HMI Name T_PAG_CSParameter Name

Logical Name T_PAG_CS (MFS)

Definition This timer indicates the maximum time a CS PAGING message canremain in a Paging Group Queue. It includes the round-trip delay onA and A-bis or Gs/Gb and A-bis interface.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules Equal to T_PAG_CS (BSC)

Recommended rules T_PAG_CS<T3113 (MSC timer)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 639 / 1176

Page 640: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.474 (T_QHO) - (T_qho)

HMI Name T_QHOParameter Name

Logical Name T_qho

Definition Maximum queuing time for Handover Requests.

Coding rules step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules T_INTRF_L3 > Max (T11, T_qho, T11_FORCED)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 20 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

640 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 641: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.475 (T_SDCCH_PC) - (T_SDCCH_PC)

HMI Name T_SDCCH_PCParameter Name

Logical Name T_SDCCH_PC

Definition Time during which power control on SDCCH is inhibited aftercompletion of the Immediate Assignment procedure.

Coding rules step size = 1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T_SDCCH_PC >= SDCCH_COUNTER

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

2 x Samfr 0 31 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 641 / 1176

Page 642: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.476 (T1) - (T1_short)

HMI Name T1Parameter Name

Logical Name T1_short

Definition Supervision of the Blocking/Unblocking procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T1_short > (31 x T_BURST) / B_NUM

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 10 25.5 16

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

642 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 643: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.477 (T11) - (T11)

HMI Name T11Parameter Name

Logical Name T11

Definition Maximum queuing time for Assignment Requests.

Coding rules step size = 1 s

Mandatory rules T_INTRF_L3 > Max (T11, T_qho, T11_FORCED)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 19 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 643 / 1176

Page 644: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.478 (T11_FORCED) - (T11_FORCED)

HMI Name T11_FORCEDParameter Name

Logical Name T11_FORCED

Definition Maximum queuing time for Assignment Requests where queuing isnot allowed by the MSC.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules T_INTRF_L3 > Max (T11, T_qho, T11_FORCED)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 19 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

644 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 645: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.479 (T13) - (T13)

HMI Name T13Parameter Name

Logical Name T13

Definition Delay for acknowledgement of RESET received from MSC.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 645 / 1176

Page 646: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.480 (T17) - (T17)

HMI Name T17Parameter Name

Logical Name T17

Definition Period of time where a new OVERLOAD that is received from theMSC, is not processed after reception of a processed OVERLOAD.

Coding rules step size: 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules T17 < T18_overload

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

646 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 647: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.481 (T18) - (T18)

HMI Name T18Parameter Name

Logical Name T18

Definition Delay between consecutive debarring actions after a BSS outage.

Coding rules Step size: 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 50

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 647 / 1176

Page 648: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.482 (T18_OVERLOAD) - (T18_Overload)

HMI Name T18_OVERLOADParameter Name

Logical Name T18_Overload

Definition Delay between the latest MSC OVERLOAD message or DTCinternal overload detection and debarring action. Also delay betweenconsecutive debarring actions for overload procedure and Telecomglobal reset procedure.

Coding rules step size: 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules T18_OVERLOAD > T17

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 6553.5 50

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Barring

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

648 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 649: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.483 (T19) - (T19)

HMI Name T19Parameter Name

Logical Name T19

Definition Supervision of the Reset Circuit procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 25.5 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 649 / 1176

Page 650: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.484 (T20) - (T20)

HMI Name T20Parameter Name

Logical Name T20

Definition Supervision of Circuit Group Blocking procedure.

Coding rules step size=0.1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 10 25.5 16

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

650 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 651: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.485 (T200 (BSC)) - (T200 (BSC))

HMI Name T200 (BSC)Parameter Name

Logical Name T200 (BSC)

Definition Supervision of acknowledgements.

Coding rules step size: 100ms; (1: 100ms, 2: 200ms, 3: 300ms, 4: 400ms, .. ., 10: 1000ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules The recommended value for Abis via satellite is 1000 ms.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance A-bis link

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 300 1000 300

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment The value of T200 (BSC) is driven by the associated Abis connectiontype.It can be changed indirectly from the OMC (through the changeof Abis connection type)The default value 300 ms corresponds toAbis terrestrial link.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 651 / 1176

Page 652: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.486 (T200_TF) - (T200_TF)

HMI Name T200_TFParameter Name

Logical Name T200_TF

Definition Supervision of acknowledgements for FACCH (TCH FR associated)SAPI 0.

Coding rules Step size = 20 msec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 200 1000 200

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment Modification of the value of this parameter will trigger an automaticrestart of all TREs of the cell, leading to a release of all ongoing calls.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

652 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 653: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.487 (T200_TH) - (T200_TH)

HMI Name T200_THParameter Name

Logical Name T200_TH

Definition Supervision of acknowledgements for FACCH (TCH HR associated)SAPI 0.

Coding rules step size = 20 msec.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 180 1000 180

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment Modification of the value of this parameter will trigger an automaticrestart of all TREs of the cell, leading to a release of all ongoing calls.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 653 / 1176

Page 654: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.488 (T3101) - (T3101)

HMI Name T3101Parameter Name

Logical Name T3101

Definition Supervision of the Immediate Assignment procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T3101 > 2s

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

654 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 655: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.489 (T3103) - (T3103)

HMI Name T3103Parameter Name

Logical Name T3103

Definition Supervision of the Internal Handover procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules T3103 > Ny1 x T3105_D. T3103 > Ny1 x T3105_F_FR. T3103 > Ny1x T3105_F_HR.T3103 > T3106_D.T3103 > T3106_F

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 16.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 655 / 1176

Page 656: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.490 (T3105D) - (T3105_D)

HMI Name T3105DParameter Name

Logical Name T3105_D

Definition Delay between consecutive repetitions of PHYSICAL INFORMATIONon SDCCH.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules T3105_D x Ny1 < T3103T3105_D x Ny1 < T9113

Recommended rules T3105_D x Ny1 > T3124T3105_D << T3124 (T3124 = 675 ms onSDCCH)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 200 220 200

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

656 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 657: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.491 (T3105D_STOP) - (T3105_D_STOP)

HMI Name T3105D_STOPParameter Name

Logical Name T3105_D_STOP

Definition Criterion to stop T3105_D timer.

Coding rules 0: stopped on reception of SABM frame, 1: stopped on reception ofany correct L2 signalling frame

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 657 / 1176

Page 658: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.492 (T3105F_FR) - (T3105_F_FR)

HMI Name T3105F_FRParameter Name

Logical Name T3105_F_FR

Definition Delay between consecutive repetitions of PHYSICAL INFORMATIONon FACCH for FR channels.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules T3105_F_FR x Ny1 < T3103 T3105_F_FR x Ny1 < T9113

Recommended rules T3105_F_FR x Ny1 > T3124 T3105_F_FR << T3124 (T3124 = 320ms on TCH)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 20 250 50

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

658 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 659: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.493 (T3105F_HR) - (T3105_F_HR)

HMI Name T3105F_HRParameter Name

Logical Name T3105_F_HR

Definition Delay between consecutive repetitions of PHYSICAL INFORMATIONon FACCH for HR channels.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules T3105_F_HR x Ny1 < T3103 T3105_F_HR x Ny1 < T9113

Recommended rules T3105_F_HR x Ny1 > T3124 T3105_F_HR << T3124 (T3124 = 320ms on TCH)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 20 250 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 659 / 1176

Page 660: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.494 (T3105F_STOP) - (T3105_F_STOP)

HMI Name T3105F_STOPParameter Name

Logical Name T3105_F_STOP

Definition Criterion to stop T3105_F timer.

Coding rules 0: stopped on reception of SABM frame, 1: stopped on reception ofany correct L2 signalling frame or of a correct traffic frame

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

660 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 661: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.495 (T3106D) - (T3106_D)

HMI Name T3106DParameter Name

Logical Name T3106_D

Definition Supervision of the reception of valid frame from the MS on the targetcell in case of SDCCH synchronous handover.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules T3106_D < T3103T3106_D < T9113

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 1100 1500 1200

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 661 / 1176

Page 662: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.496 (T3106D_STOP) - (T3106_D_STOP)

HMI Name T3106D_STOPParameter Name

Logical Name T3106_D_STOP

Definition Criterion to stop T3106_D timer.

Coding rules 0: stopped on reception of SABM frame, 1: stopped on reception ofany correct L2 signalling frame

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

662 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 663: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.497 (T3106F) - (T3106_F)

HMI Name T3106FParameter Name

Logical Name T3106_F

Definition Supervision of the reception of valid frame from the MS on the targetcell in case of TCH synchronous handover.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules T3106_F < T3103T3106_F < T9113

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 500 1000 1000

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 663 / 1176

Page 664: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.498 (T3106F_STOP) - (T3106_F_STOP)

HMI Name T3106F_STOPParameter Name

Logical Name T3106_F_STOP

Definition Criterion to stop T3106_F timer.

Coding rules 0: stopped on reception of SABM frame, 1: stopped on reception ofany correct L2 signalling frame or of a correct traffic frame

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

664 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 665: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.499 (T3107) - (T3107)

HMI Name T3107Parameter Name

Logical Name T3107

Definition Supervision of the Assignment procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 14

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 665 / 1176

Page 666: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.500 (T3109) - (T3109)

HMI Name T3109Parameter Name

Logical Name T3109

Definition Supervision of the Channel Release procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T3109 > RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT + 1s

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 35 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

666 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 667: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.501 (T3111) - (T3111)

HMI Name T3111Parameter Name

Logical Name T3111

Definition Delay of the RF Channel Release procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T3111 > 2 x T200_D. T3111 > 2 x T200_TH. T3111 = T3110 (MS)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 2 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 667 / 1176

Page 668: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.502 (T3212) - (T3212 (BSC))

HMI Name T3212Parameter Name

Logical Name T3212 (BSC)

Definition This timer indicates to the MS the delay between two consecutivePeriodic Location Update procedures.

Coding rules 0: no periodic location update

Mandatory rules Equal to T3212 (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

6 mn 0 255 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

668 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 669: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.503 (T4) - (T4)

HMI Name T4Parameter Name

Logical Name T4

Definition Supervision of RESET message sent to the MSC.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 2 6553.5 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment T4 shall be set greater than T2 (timer in MSC).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 669 / 1176

Page 670: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.504 (T7) - (T7)

HMI Name T7Parameter Name

Logical Name T7

Definition Timer controlling the repetition of HANDOVER REQUIRED.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules T7 < T_HO_REQD_LOST

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 20 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / Handover Control

External Comment Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

670 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 671: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.505 (T8) - (T8)

HMI Name T8Parameter Name

Logical Name T8

Definition Supervision of the External Handover procedure in the serving BSC.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 14

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / Handover Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 671 / 1176

Page 672: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.506 (T9104) - (T9104)

HMI Name T9104Parameter Name

Logical Name T9104

Definition Supervision of the call clearing procedure when triggered by the BSC.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

672 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 673: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.507 (T9105) - (T9105)

HMI Name T9105Parameter Name

Logical Name T9105

Definition Supervision of the SCCP Connection procedure.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules T9105 > T(conn est)

Recommended rules T9105 > max T3210. T9105 > max T3220. T9105 > max T3230

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 11 6553,5 31

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 673 / 1176

Page 674: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.508 (T9112) - (T9112)

HMI Name T9112Parameter Name

Logical Name T9112

Definition Supervision of the channel modification in the MS.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T9112 >= 15s. T9112 <= T9114. T9112 is inferior to the MSC timersupervising the Modify procedure.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 6553.5 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

674 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 675: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.509 (T9113) - (T9113)

HMI Name T9113Parameter Name

Logical Name T9113

Definition Supervision of the External Handover procedure in the target BSC.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules T9113 > T3105_D x Ny1. T9113 > T3105_F x Ny1. T9113 >T3106_D. T9113 > T3106_F

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / Handover Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 675 / 1176

Page 676: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.510 (TA_STAT) - (TA_STAT)

HMI Name TA_STATParameter Name

Logical Name TA_STAT

Definition Threshold on timing advance to define the cell limit used for RadioMeasurements Statistics.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 0 63 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / RMS & MAFA

External Comment 1 bper corresponds to about 550m

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

676 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 677: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.511 (TCH load threshold for Auto AC) - (N_threshold)

HMI Name TCH load threshold for Auto ACParameter Name

Logical Name N_threshold

Definition Threshold on busy TCH timeslots percentage for automatic barringof access classes.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 677 / 1176

Page 678: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.512 (TEMPORARY_OFFSET) - (TEMPORARY_OFFSET)

HMI Name TEMPORARY_OFFSETParameter Name

Logical Name TEMPORARY_OFFSET

Definition Offset applied to C2 criterion for the duration of PENALTY_TIME.

Coding rules step size = 10dB. 0: 0dB, 1:10dB, 6: 60dB, 7: infinity

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 infinity 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment If the VGCS is licensed, the parameter is modifiable only via theprovisioning context of the OMC.

Single 0 dB (0)

Umbrella 0 dB (0)

Concentric 0 dB (0)

Concentric Umbrella 0 dB (0)

Microcell infinity (7)

Minicell infinity (7)

Extended inner cell 0 dB (0)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 0 dB (0)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

678 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 679: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.513 (TFO HR when loaded) - (FORCE_TFO_HR_WHEN_LOADED)

HMI Name TFO HR when loadedParameter Name

Logical Name FORCE_TFO_HR_WHEN_LOADED

Definition Flag to control the establishment of TFO in Half rate when the cell isloaded.

Coding rules 0 : TFO HR not forced, 1 : TFO HR only, 2 : TFO HR preferred

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules If FORCE_TFO_HR_WHEN_LOADED=2, EN_TFO_MATCH shouldbe set to 1

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment If this flag is set to 1, and if for load reasons the call is establishedwith HR codec, it will stay in HR.If this flag is set to 2, if for loadreasons the call is established with HR codec, and if TFO is notpossible in HR, the BSC will try to establish TFO with AMR-WB, FRor EFR codec, provided that EN_TFO_MATCH=1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 679 / 1176

Page 680: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.514 (THR_CCCH_LOAD) - (THR_CCCH_LOAD)

HMI Name THR_CCCH_LOADParameter Name

Logical Name THR_CCCH_LOAD

Definition Threshold triggering the sending of CCCH LOAD INDICATIONmessage.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 100 3000 500

Modifiable OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

680 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 681: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.515 (THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1) - (THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1)

HMI Name THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1Parameter Name

Logical Name THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1

Definition Lower load threshold for allocation policy definition in dual rate cell.

Coding rules step size = 10%

Mandatory rules THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1 <= THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1 &THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1>=THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3

Recommended rules When choosing the THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1 value, it isrecommanded to check that the number of DR TCH in the cell isgreater than (100 - THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1) /100*total number ofTCH in the cell.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

0 20 30 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 681 / 1176

Page 682: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.516 (THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3) - (THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3)

HMI Name THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3Parameter Name

Logical Name THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3

Definition Lower load threshold for allocation policy of AMR-NB HR in a dualrate cell supporting AMR-NB HR.

Coding rules Step size = 10%

Mandatory rules THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3 <= THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3 &THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3<=THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1

Recommended rules When choosing the THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3 value, it isrecommended to check that the number of DR TCH in the cell isgreater than (100 - THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3) /100*total number ofTCH in the cell.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

0 20 30 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40

682 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 683: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.517 (THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1) - (THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1)

HMI Name THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1Parameter Name

Logical Name THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1

Definition Higher load threshold for allocation policy definition in dual rate cell.

Coding rules Step size = 10%

Mandatory rules THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1 >= THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1 &THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1>=THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3

Recommended rules When choosing the THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1 value, it isrecommanded to check that the number of DR TCH in the cell isgreater than (100 - THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1) /100*total number ofTCH in the cell.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 683 / 1176

Page 684: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.518 (THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3) - (THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3)

HMI Name THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3Parameter Name

Logical Name THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3

Definition Higher load threshold for allocation policy of AMR-NB HR in a dualrate cell supporting AMR-NB HR.

Coding rules Step size = 10%

Mandatory rules THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3 >= THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3 &THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3<=THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1

Recommended rules When choosing the THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3 value, it isrecommended to check that the number of DR TCH in the cell isgreater than (100 - THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3) /100*total number ofTCH in the cell.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70

684 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 685: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.519 (THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGH) - (THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGH)

HMI Name THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGHParameter Name

Logical Name THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGH

Definition Threshold for channel adaptation under high load.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 (0 coded as 0, 0.1 coded as 1 7 coded as 70)

Mandatory rules THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGH >= THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMAL

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 685 / 1176

Page 686: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.520 (THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMAL) - (THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMAL)

HMI Name THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMALParameter Name

Logical Name THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMAL

Definition Threshold for channel adaptation under normal load.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 (0 coded as 0, 0.1 coded as 1 7 coded as 70)

Mandatory rules THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGH >= THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMAL

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

686 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 687: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.521 (TRAFFIC_EV_PERIOD) - (TRAFFIC_EV_PERIOD)

HMI Name TRAFFIC_EV_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name TRAFFIC_EV_PERIOD

Definition Periodicity of traffic load update in resource allocation algorithms =N_TRAFFIC_LOAD x A_TRAFFIC_LOAD x TCH_INFO_PERIOD.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem OMC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 2 3264 120

Modifiable OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment The given default value corresponds to the value calculated by theOMC, based on the values of N_TRAFFIC_LOAD (which dependson the nb of TRX in the cell, not reflected by DLS default value),A_TRAFFIC_LOAD (which depends on the nb of TRX in the cell, notreflected by DLS default value), TCH_INFO_PERIOD.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 687 / 1176

Page 688: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.522 (TRX zone) - (ZONE_TYPE)

HMI Name TRX zoneParameter Name

Logical Name ZONE_TYPE

Definition Determines which TRX(s) belong to the inner zone and which TRX(s)belong to the outer zone of a concentric cell.

Coding rules Coded as a 16 bits bitmap. Each bit specifies the zone thecorresponding TRX (if declared) belongs to. 0: Outer zone, 1: Innerzone.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type List of numbers

SubSystem BSC

Instance TRX

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 65535 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Radio Channel Config. / TRX Configuration

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric #

Concentric Umbrella #

Microcell N/A

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

688 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 689: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.523 (TSC) - (TSC)

HMI Name TSCParameter Name

Logical Name TSC

Definition Training Sequence Code for any (packet) channel except for BCCH,CCCH and CBCH

Coding rules coded over 3 bits

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here isfor implementation purposes.Two training sequence codes are usedin Alcatel BSS:*) TSC for BCCH, CCCH and CBCH: the BSS setsthe TSC to the O&M parameter BCC. This behaviour is compliant to3GPP TS 05.02 which states that for BCCH and CCCH, the TSCmust be equal to the BCC. In Alcatel BSS, for CBCH, the TSC is alsoset to BCC.**) TSC for any other (packet) channel: the BSS sets theTSC to the O&M parameter TSC.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 689 / 1176

Page 690: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.524 (TX_INTEGER) - (Tx_integer (BSC))

HMI Name TX_INTEGERParameter Name

Logical Name Tx_integer (BSC)

Definition Number of RACH timeslots that spread transmission of CHANNELREQUEST.

Coding rules Possible values are:3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 14, 16, 20, 25, 32,50 respectively binary coded from 0000 to 1111

Mandatory rules Equal to Tx_integer (MFS)

Recommended rules When the GPRS is supported through Abis or Ater terrestriallinks, it is recommended to set:TX_INTEGER = 32 if the CCCHis not combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 0TX_INTEGER = 12 if theCCCH is combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 1.When the GPRS issupported through Abis or Ater satellite links, it is recommended toset:TX_INTEGER = 32 whatever the configuration of the CCCH.Thenumber of slots belonging to the MSs RACH between 2 successiveChannel Request messages is a random value drawn randomlyfor each new retransmission with uniform distribution in the set(S, S+1, ...,S+T-1). With T = Tx_Integer and S depending on theCCCH configuration as shown below:1) for non combined CCCH:-Tx_Integer = 3, 8, 14, 50 –> S = 55 RACH frames (i.e. 253.8ms)- Tx_Integer = 4, 9, 16 –> S = 76 RACH frames (i.e. 349.6ms)- Tx_Integer = 5, 10, 20 –> S = 109 RACH frames (i.e. 501.4ms)- Tx_Integer = 6, 11, 25 –> S = 163 RACH frames (i.e. 749.8ms)Tx_Integer = 7, 12, 32 –> S = 217 RACH frames (i.e. 998.2 ms)2)for combined CCCH:- Tx_Integer = 3, 8, 14, 50 –> S = 41 RACHframes (i.e. 357.5 ms)- Tx_Integer = 4, 9, 16 –> S = 52 RACH frames(i.e. 453.4 ms)- Tx_Integer = 5, 10, 20 –> S = 58 RACH frames (i.e.505.7 ms)- Tx_Integer = 6, 11, 25 –> S = 86 RACH frames (i.e.749.9 ms)- Tx_Integer = 7, 12, 32 –> S = 115 RACH frames (i.e.1002.8 ms)Note: - In the non-combined CCCH configuration, thereare 51 RACH frames per 51-multiframe- In the combined CCCHconfiguration, there are 27 RACH frames per 51-multiframe.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 3 50 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

690 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 691: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

External Comment When EN_GPRS=1, it is recommended to set: TX_INTEGER = 32 ifthe CCCH is not combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 0TX_INTEGER =12 if the CCCH is combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 691 / 1176

Page 692: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.525 (U_RXLEV_DL_MCHO) - (U_RXLEV_DL_MCHO)

HMI Name U_RXLEV_DL_MCHOParameter Name

Logical Name U_RXLEV_DL_MCHO

Definition Downlink level threshold for Microcell to Macrocell handover.

Coding rules coded over 6 bits :0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -47

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric N/A

Concentric Umbrella N/A

Microcell -91 dBm (19)

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

692 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 693: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.526 (U_RXLEV_DL_P) - (U_RXLEV_DL_P)

HMI Name U_RXLEV_DL_PParameter Name

Logical Name U_RXLEV_DL_P

Definition Upper downlink level threshold for power control.

Coding rules coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules U_RXLEV_DL_P > L_RXLEV_DL_P

Recommended rules U_RXLEV_DL_P >= L_RXLEV_DL_P + 10 dB

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -75

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 693 / 1176

Page 694: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.527 (U_RXLEV_UL_MCHO) - (U_RXLEV_UL_MCHO)

HMI Name U_RXLEV_UL_MCHOParameter Name

Logical Name U_RXLEV_UL_MCHO

Definition Uplink level threshold for Microcell to Macrocell handover.

Coding rules coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -47

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric N/A

Concentric Umbrella N/A

Microcell -98 dBm (12)

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

694 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 695: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.528 (U_RXLEV_UL_P) - (U_RXLEV_UL_P)

HMI Name U_RXLEV_UL_PParameter Name

Logical Name U_RXLEV_UL_P

Definition Upper uplink level threshold for power control.

Coding rules coded over 6 bits :0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules U_RXLEV_UL_P > L_RXLEV_UL_P

Recommended rules U_RXLEV_UL_P >= L_RXLEV_UL_P + 10 dB

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -75

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Single -85 dBm (25)

Umbrella -85 dBm (25)

Concentric -85 dBm (25)

Concentric Umbrella -85 dBm (25)

Microcell -75 dBm (35)

Minicell -85 dBm (25)

Extended inner cell -85 dBm (25)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell -85 dBm (25)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 695 / 1176

Page 696: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.529 (U_RXQUAL_DL_P) - (U_RXQUAL_DL_P)

HMI Name U_RXQUAL_DL_PParameter Name

Logical Name U_RXQUAL_DL_P

Definition Upper downlink quality threshold for power control.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules U_RXQUAL_DL_P < L_RXQUAL_DL_P

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment Highest value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

696 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 697: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.530 (U_RXQUAL_UL_P) - (U_RXQUAL_UL_P)

HMI Name U_RXQUAL_UL_PParameter Name

Logical Name U_RXQUAL_UL_P

Definition Upper uplink quality threshold for power control.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules U_RXQUAL_UL_P < L_RXQUAL_UL_P

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment Highest value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 697 / 1176

Page 698: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.531 (Uplink DTX Phase 2 for AMR-WB GMSK) -(DTX_INDICATOR_SACCH_AMR_WB_GMSK)

HMI Name Uplink DTX Phase 2 for AMR-WB GMSKParameter Name

Logical Name DTX_INDICATOR_SACCH_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition Controls uplink DTX usage for GSM phase 2 MS. Applies only toAMR-WB GMSK.

Coding rules 0= the MS may use UL DTX for AMR-WB GMSK, 1= the MS shalluse UL DTX for AMR-WB GMSK, 2=the MS shall not use UL DTXfor AMR-WB GMSK,

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules The value "2" is recommended when EN_TFO_AMR_WB =1

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

698 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 699: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.532 (UPPER_TIMING_ADVANCE) - (U_TIME_ADVANCE)

HMI Name UPPER_TIMING_ADVANCEParameter Name

Logical Name U_TIME_ADVANCE

Definition Timing Advance threshold for distance handover.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 0 63 63

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Distance

External Comment One unit corresponds to a distance of about 550m

Single 35 km (63)

Umbrella 35 km (63)

Concentric 35 km (63)

Concentric Umbrella 35 km (63)

Microcell 1 km (2)

Minicell 35 km (63)

Extended inner cell 34.5 km (62)

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 35 km (63)

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 699 / 1176

Page 700: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.533 (VQ_AVERAGE) - (VQ_AVERAGE)

HMI Name VQ_AVERAGEParameter Name

Logical Name VQ_AVERAGE

Definition Average window size on measurements to obtain samples for VoiceQuality statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 0 128 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

700 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 701: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.534 (VQ_BAD_RXFER) - (VQ_BAD_RXFER)

HMI Name VQ_BAD_RXFERParameter Name

Logical Name VQ_BAD_RXFER

Definition Radio bad FER threshold to specify bad quality samples for VoiceQuality statistics.

Coding rules coded 0 to 200, step size=0.1% (0= 0%, 1 = 0.1 %, , 200 = 20%)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 20 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 701 / 1176

Page 702: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.535 (VQ_FER_THRESHOLD) - (VQ_FER_THRESHOLD)

HMI Name VQ_FER_THRESHOLDParameter Name

Logical Name VQ_FER_THRESHOLD

Definition Radio FER threshold to detect calls with bad speech quality for VoiceQuality statistics.

Coding rules step size = 1%

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

702 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 703: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.536 (VQ_GOOD_RXFER) - (VQ_GOOD_RXFER)

HMI Name VQ_GOOD_RXFERParameter Name

Logical Name VQ_GOOD_RXFER

Definition Radio good FER threshold to specify bad quality samples for VoiceQuality statistics.

Coding rules coded 0 to 200, step size=0.1% (0= 0%, 1 = 0.1 %, , 200 = 20%)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 20 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 703 / 1176

Page 704: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.537 (VQ_INTF_THRESHOLD) - (VQ_INTF_THRESHOLD)

HMI Name VQ_INTF_THRESHOLDParameter Name

Logical Name VQ_INTF_THRESHOLD

Definition Radio interference threshold to detect noisy calls for Voice Qualitystatistics.

Coding rules step size = 1%

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

704 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 705: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.538 (VQ_RXLEV) - (VQ_RXLEV)

HMI Name VQ_RXLEVParameter Name

Logical Name VQ_RXLEV

Definition Radio level threshold to specify bad quality samples for Voice Qualitystatistics.

Coding rules 0 = -110 dBm, 1 = -109 dBm, 62 = -48 dBm, 63 = -47 dBm, step= 1dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -95

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 705 / 1176

Page 706: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.539 (VQ_RXQUAL) - (VQ_RXQUAL)

HMI Name VQ_RXQUALParameter Name

Logical Name VQ_RXQUAL

Definition Radio quality threshold to specify bad quality samples for VoiceQuality statistics.

Coding rules step size=0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

706 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 707: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.540 (VQ_RXQUAL_VS_RXFER) - (VQ_RXQUAL_VS_RXFER)

HMI Name VQ_RXQUAL_VS_RXFERParameter Name

Logical Name VQ_RXQUAL_VS_RXFER

Definition Radio quality threshold to specify correlation between qualitysamples for Voice Quality statistics.

Coding rules step size=0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can bedefined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameterRMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 707 / 1176

Page 708: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.541 (W_LEV_HO) - (W_LEV_HO)

HMI Name W_LEV_HOParameter Name

Logical Name W_LEV_HO

Definition Weight applicable to level samples for handover when no DTX isapplied.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_LEV_HO + W_LEV_HO < 32

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

708 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 709: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.542 (W_LEV_MCHO) - (W_LEV_MCHO)

HMI Name W_LEV_MCHOParameter Name

Logical Name W_LEV_MCHO

Definition Weight applicable to level samples for microcell handover when noDTX is applied.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_LEV_MCHO + W_LEV_MCHO < 16

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment –

Single N/A

Umbrella N/A

Concentric N/A

Concentric Umbrella N/A

Microcell 1

Minicell N/A

Extended inner cell N/A

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 709 / 1176

Page 710: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.543 (W_LEV_PC) - (W_LEV_PC)

HMI Name W_LEV_PCParameter Name

Logical Name W_LEV_PC

Definition Weight applicable to level samples for power control when no DTXis applied.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_LEV_PC + W_LEV_PC < 32

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

710 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 711: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.544 (W_PBGT_HO) - (W_PBGT_HO)

HMI Name W_PBGT_HOParameter Name

Logical Name W_PBGT_HO

Definition Weight applicable to level samples for power budget when no DTXis applied.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_PBGT_HO + W_PBGT_HO < 32

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 711 / 1176

Page 712: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.545 (W_QUAL_CA) - (W_QUAL_CA)

HMI Name W_QUAL_CAParameter Name

Logical Name W_QUAL_CA

Definition Averaging weight applicable for full quality (Channel adaptation).

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

712 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 713: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.546 (W_QUAL_HO) - (W_QUAL_HO)

HMI Name W_QUAL_HOParameter Name

Logical Name W_QUAL_HO

Definition Weight applicable to quality samples for handover when no DTXis applied.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_QUAL_HO + W_QUAL_HO < 32

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 713 / 1176

Page 714: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.547 (W_QUAL_PC) - (W_QUAL_PC)

HMI Name W_QUAL_PCParameter Name

Logical Name W_QUAL_PC

Definition Weight applicable to quality samples for power control when no DTXis applied.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules A_QUAL_PC + W_QUAL_PC < 32

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

714 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 715: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.548 (WHITE_BOOK_INTERWORKING) - (MTP3_WB_INTERWORKING)

HMI Name WHITE_BOOK_INTERWORKINGParameter Name

Logical Name MTP3_WB_INTERWORKING

Definition This flag indicates if the BSC sends a Q.704 TRA message upon firstreception of SLTA from the MSC.

Coding rules 0 : TRA not sent upon first SLTA reception, 1 : TRA sent upon firstSLTA reception

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment This flag is set to 1 for interworking with a "White Book" MSC. It is setto 0 for interworking with a "Blue Book" MSC.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 715 / 1176

Page 716: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.549 (WI_CR) - (WI_CR)

HMI Name WI_CRParameter Name

Logical Name WI_CR

Definition Value of Wait Indication for Establishment cause = "CallRe-establishment".

Coding rules 0: 0s, 1: 1s, ..., 254: 254s, 255: no IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENTREJECT message is sent.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

716 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 717: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.550 (WI_EC) - (WI_EC)

HMI Name WI_ECParameter Name

Logical Name WI_EC

Definition Value of Wait Indication for Establishment cause = "Emergency call".

Coding rules 0: 0s, 1: 1s, ..., 254: 254s, 255: no IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENTREJECT message is sent.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 717 / 1176

Page 718: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.551 (WI_OC) - (WI_OC)

HMI Name WI_OCParameter Name

Logical Name WI_OC

Definition Value of Wait Indication for Establishment cause = "Originating call".

Coding rules 0: 0s, 1: 1s, ..., 254: 254s, 255: no IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENTREJECT message is sent.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

718 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 719: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.552 (WI_OP) - (WI_OP)

HMI Name WI_OPParameter Name

Logical Name WI_OP

Definition Value of Wait Indication for Establishment cause = "Locationupdating" or "Other procedures which can be completed with anSDCCH".

Coding rules 0: 0s, 1: 1s, ..., 254: 254s, 255: no IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENTREJECT message is sent.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 255 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 719 / 1176

Page 720: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.553 (ZONE_HO_HYST_DL) - (ZONE_HO_HYST_DL)

HMI Name ZONE_HO_HYST_DLParameter Name

Logical Name ZONE_HO_HYST_DL

Definition Hysteresis applied to RXLEV_DL_ZONE for outer to inner zonehandover.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -40 40 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

720 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 721: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.554 (ZONE_HO_HYST_UL) - (ZONE_HO_HYST_UL)

HMI Name ZONE_HO_HYST_ULParameter Name

Logical Name ZONE_HO_HYST_UL

Definition Hysteresis applied to RXLEV_UL_ZONE for outer to inner zonehandover.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -40 40 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 721 / 1176

Page 722: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.3 System (CST)

4.3.1 (Interference band 5 upper limit) - (INTFBD5)

HMI Name Interference band 5 upper limitParameter Name

Logical Name INTFBD5

Definition Upper limit of interference band 5.

Coding rules Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category System (CST)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -47

Modifiable OMC Changes: displayed RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

722 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 723: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.3.2 (SMSCB_Mode) - (SMSCB_Mode)

HMI Name SMSCB_ModeParameter Name

Logical Name SMSCB_Mode

Definition This parameter enables to select the mode of operation, eitherOMC-R or CBC.

Coding rules 0: OMC-R, 1: CBC

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category System (CST)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 723 / 1176

Page 724: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

724 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 725: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 725 / 1176

Page 726: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1 Network (CDE)

5.1.1 (Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data) -(Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data)

HMI Name Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_DataParameter Name

Logical Name Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data

Definition Threshold (percentage of used Ater nibbles, in a GPU) above whichthe Ater usage is optimized for "short data" MS transfers.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules If Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data is not set to 100% (100%meaning that there is no Ater usage optimization for "short data"MS transfers), then it is recommended to set it to 30%, except if thedrawbacks of another value (as explained in the external comments)are deemed acceptable.For all the Ater_Usage_Thresholdvalues being defined for the BSSs handled by the MFS,Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data <= Ater_Usage_Threshold30%. Indeed, for consistency reasons, "short data" MS transferoptimizations should come prior to high Ater usage optimizations.Ifit is seen as an important goal to save Ater resources in theGPU, a value of Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data < 100%is coherent with a low value of the T_GCH_INACTIVITY andT_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST timers.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Setting Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data to 100% means thatthere is no Ater usage optimization for "short data" MS transfers.IfAter_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data is not set to 100%:- the higherthe Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data value, the fewer ping timedegradations and data transfer delays will be experienced,- the lowerthe Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data value, the more accuratethe Ater consumption in the GPU will be (i.e. potential wastes of Aterresources will be minimized in the GPU).

726 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 727: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 727 / 1176

Page 728: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.2 (BSSGP_T3) - (bssgp_T3)

HMI Name BSSGP_T3Parameter Name

Logical Name bssgp_T3

Definition Timer used by MFS to wait for Suspend acknowledgement fromSGSN.

Coding rules 1:0,1 ; 2: 0,2 ; ; 10: 1 ; ; 100: 10

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 10 0.6

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

728 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 729: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.3 (BSSGP_T4) - (bssgp_T4)

HMI Name BSSGP_T4Parameter Name

Logical Name bssgp_T4

Definition Timer used by MFS to wait for Resume acknowledgement fromSGSN.

Coding rules 1:0,1 ; 2: 0,2 ; ; 10: 1 ; ; 100: 10

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules BSSGP_T4 < T_GPRS_Resume/ (Resume_retries+1))

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 10 0.6

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 729 / 1176

Page 730: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.4 (EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTING) -(EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTING)

HMI Name EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTINGParameter Name

Logical Name EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTING

Definition This flag enables / disables autonomous rerouting of DL LLC PDUs.

Coding rules 0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended not to activate simultaneously extended UL TBFfeature (EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF) and the DL PDU reroutingfeature (EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTING)

Category Network (CDE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

730 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 731: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.5 (EN_CBL) - (EN_CBL)

HMI Name EN_CBLParameter Name

Logical Name EN_CBL

Definition This flag enables / disables CBL feature (Leaky BucketSynchronisation)

Coding rules 0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 731 / 1176

Page 732: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.6 (FLOW_DIM_Safety_BVC) - (FLOW_DIM_Safety_BVC)

HMI Name FLOW_DIM_Safety_BVCParameter Name

Logical Name FLOW_DIM_Safety_BVC

Definition Safety factor to size BVC_Bucket_Size parameter, for downlink flowcontrol, on Gb interface.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 100 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

732 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 733: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.7 (FLOW_DIM_Safety_MS) - (FLOW_DIM_Safety_MS)

HMI Name FLOW_DIM_Safety_MSParameter Name

Logical Name FLOW_DIM_Safety_MS

Definition Safety factor to size default MS_Bucket_Size parameter, for downlinkflow control, on Gb interface.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules FLOW_DIM_Safety_MS should be set to a value corresponding tothe maximum multi-slot class of the MS present on the network

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 733 / 1176

Page 734: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.8 (INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_EGPRS) -(INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_EGPRS)

HMI Name INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_EGPRSParameter Name

Logical Name INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_EGPRS

Definition Number of PDCHs on which MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DLand MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL are targeted whenestablishing GCHs for an EGPRS TBF associated to a "short data"MS transfer.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 8 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

734 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 735: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.9 (INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_GPRS) -(INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_GPRS)

HMI Name INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_GPRSParameter Name

Logical Name INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_GPRS

Definition Number of PDCHs on which MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DLand MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL are targeted whenestablishing GCHs for a GPRS TBF associated to a "short data"MS transfer.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 8 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 735 / 1176

Page 736: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.10 (K_GSL (BSC)) - (K_GSL (BSC))

HMI Name K_GSL (BSC)Parameter Name

Logical Name K_GSL (BSC)

Definition Maximum number of outstanding I frames on a GSL link.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:-K_GSL = 7 if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater terrestrial links inall BSC of the MFS.- K_GSL = 16 if GPRS traffic is carried throughAter satellite links in at least one BSC of the MFS.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 16 7

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

736 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 737: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.11 (K_GSL (MFS)) - (K_GSL (MFS))

HMI Name K_GSL (MFS)Parameter Name

Logical Name K_GSL (MFS)

Definition Maximum number of outstanding I frames on a GSL link.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:-K_GSL = 7 if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater terrestrial links inall BSC of the MFS.- K_GSL = 16 if GPRS traffic is carried throughAter satellite links in at least one BSC of the MFS.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 32 7

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 737 / 1176

Page 738: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.12 (MAX_BLER) - (MAX_BLER)

HMI Name MAX_BLERParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_BLER

Definition Maximum mean BLER value that a TBF can possibly reach

Coding rules step size = 0,05

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 0.95 0.35

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The MAX_BLER value is used by RRM to evaluate the minimumnumber of GCHs necessary to support RT traffic on a TRX.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

738 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 739: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.13 (MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL) -(MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL)

HMI Name MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DLParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL

Definition Maximum Modulation and Coding Scheme used for the DL EGPRSTBFs associated to a "short data" MS transfer.

Coding rules 0: MCS-1; 1: MCS-2; 2: MCS-3; 3: MCS-4;4: MCS-5; 5: MCS-6;6:MCS-7; 7: MCS-8;8: MCS-9.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules For consistency reasons, MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DLshall NOT be higher than any of the MAX_EGPRS_MCS valuesdefined in the cells of the MFS (this could otherwise induce someabnormal TBF releases or other undesirable effects on the PS QoS).

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 9 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Setting this parameter to MCS-2 might introduce some problems(because a MCS-2 block consumes exactly 1.00 GCH and mighttherefore block some of the MFS-BTS signalling messages to besent in the M-EGCH link in DL).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 739 / 1176

Page 740: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.14 (MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL) -(MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL)

HMI Name MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_ULParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL

Definition Maximum Modulation and Coding Scheme used for the UL EGPRSTBFs associated to a "short data" MS transfer.

Coding rules 0: MCS-1; 1: MCS-2; 2: MCS-3; 3: MCS-4;4: MCS-5; 5: MCS-6;6:MCS-7; 7: MCS-8;8: MCS-9.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules For consistency reasons, MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_ULshall NOT be higher than any of the MAX_EGPRS_MCS valuesdefined in the cells of the MFS (this could otherwise induce someabnormal TBF releases or other undesirable effects on the PS QoS).

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 9 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

740 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 741: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.15 (MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL) -(MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL)

HMI Name MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DLParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL

Definition Maximum coding scheme used for the DL GPRS TBFs associated toa "short data" MS transfer.

Coding rules 0 : CS-1;1 : CS-2; 2 : CS-3; 3 : CS-4.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules For consistency reasons, MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL shallNOT be higher than any of the MAX_GPRS_CS values defined in thecells of the MFS (this could otherwise induce some abnormal TBFreleases or other undesirable effects on the PS QoS).

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 4 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Setting this parameter to CS-2 might introduce some problems(because a CS-2 block consumes exactly 1.00 GCH and mighttherefore block some of the MFS-BTS signalling messages to besent in the M-EGCH link in DL).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 741 / 1176

Page 742: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.16 (MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL) -(MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL)

HMI Name MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_ULParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL

Definition Maximum coding scheme used for the UL GPRS TBFs associated toa "short data" MS transfer.

Coding rules 0 : CS-1;1 : CS-2; 2 : CS-3; 3 : CS-4.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules For consistency reasons, MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL shallNOT be higher than any of the MAX_GPRS_CS values defined in thecells of the MFS (this could otherwise induce some abnormal TBFreleases or other undesirable effects on the PS QoS).

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 4 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

742 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 743: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.17 (N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS) - (N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS)

HMI Name N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANSParameter Name

Logical Name N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS

Definition Number of bytes below which an MS transfer is considered to be"short data".

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS <=N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 20 10000 150

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment An MS transfer is considered to be "short data" as long as less thanN_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS bytes have been transferred inboth directions (since the TBF establishment(s)). Else, if more thanN_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS bytes have been transferred in atleast one direction, the MS transfer is considered to be "long data".

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 743 / 1176

Page 744: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.18 (N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC) -(N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC)

HMI Name N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODICParameter Name

Logical Name N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC

Definition Number of bytes above which a transition from "short data" to "longdata" MS transfer shall be periodically reattempted (only useful in therare cases where such a transition previously failed).

Coding rules step size = 100 bytes

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS <=N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 100 100000 10000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment A transition from "short data" to "long data" MS transfer can onlyfail in the rare cases where there is a too high number of TBFs onthe TRX / in some very specific reallocation failure scenarios.Alow value of N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC shouldbe avoided because it will tend to increase the CPU load of theMFS for a defence case which should be rare (if TRX and Abis/Atertransmission resources are properly dimensioned).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

744 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 745: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.19 (N391) - (N391)

HMI Name N391Parameter Name

Logical Name N391

Definition Number of polling cycles before Frame Relay " full status enquiry"(see ITU Q.933 Annex A, A.7).

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 255 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 745 / 1176

Page 746: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.20 (N392) - (N392)

HMI Name N392Parameter Name

Logical Name N392

Definition Error threshold (Frame Relay, see Q.933, Annex A).

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules N392*T391 is the value of the link failure detection time

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

746 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 747: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.21 (N393) - (N393)

HMI Name N393Parameter Name

Logical Name N393

Definition Monitored error counts (Frame Relay, see ITU Q.933 Annex A, A.7).

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 747 / 1176

Page 748: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.22 (NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN) - (NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN)

HMI Name NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGINParameter Name

Logical Name NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN

Definition For a PDCH, percentage of channel capacity (in terms of radioblock scheduling) which is exclusively reserved to NRT TBFs. Thatcapacity is not allowed to be allocated to a streaming TBF (RT PFC).

Coding rules step size = 1%

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 7

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment In each direction (DL or UL), the minimum number of NRTTBFs which are possible (in all cases) to be established ona PDCH is equal to ((NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN/100) *(T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULING/20ms)) rounded down to theclosest integer value. This minimum number of NRT TBFs isguaranteed even in case of RT PFC allocation on the PDCH. Thehigher the value of NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN, the higher therisks of rejecting RT PFC creation requests. The lower the value ofNRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN, the higher the risks of rejecting NRTTBF establishment requests (signalling or data traffic).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

748 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 749: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.23 (P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS) - (P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS)

HMI Name P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFSParameter Name

Logical Name P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Definition Defines the priority indicated in L2 protocol (e.g. ethernet),corresponding to the P0 internal priority (the highest).

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS >= P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules The operator shall ensure that it is equal toP0_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using theparameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using theparameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 749 / 1176

Page 750: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.24 (P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS) - (P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS)

HMI Name P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFSParameter Name

Logical Name P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Definition Defines the Diffserv DSCP value used on the IP network by MFSflows having the P0 internal BSS priority (P0 is the highest priority).

Coding rules Step size = 1.Only a subset of the possible values are defined in thestandard: 00 for BE, 10,12,14 for AF1; 18,20,22 for AF2; 26, 28,30for AF3; 34, 36, 38 for AF4 and 46 for EF.

Mandatory rules P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >= P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules The operator shall ensure that it is equal toP0_LAYER3_MAPPING_BSC

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 63 46

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using theparameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using theparameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

750 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 751: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.25 (P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS) - (P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS)

HMI Name P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFSParameter Name

Logical Name P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Definition Defines the priority indicated in L2 protocol (e.g. ethernet),corresponding to the P1 internal priority.

Coding rules Step size = 1

Mandatory rules P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS >= P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS >=P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules The operator shall ensure that it is equal toP1_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using theparameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using theparameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 751 / 1176

Page 752: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.26 (P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS) - (P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS)

HMI Name P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFSParameter Name

Logical Name P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Definition Defines the Diffserv DSCP value used on the IP network by MFSflows having the P1 internal BSS priority (P3 is the lowest priority).

Coding rules Step size = 1.Only a subset of the possible values are defined in thestandard: 00 for BE, 10,12,14 for AF1; 18,20,22 for AF2; 26, 28,30for AF3; 34, 36, 38 for AF4 and 46 for EF.

Mandatory rules P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >= P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >=P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules The operator shall ensure that it is equal toP1_LAYER3_MAPPING_BSC

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 63 34

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using theparameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using theparameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

752 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 753: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.27 (P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS) - (P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS)

HMI Name P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFSParameter Name

Logical Name P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Definition Defines the priority indicated in L2 protocol (e.g. ethernet),corresponding to the P2 internal priority.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS >= P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS >=P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules The operator shall ensure that it is equal toP2_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using theparameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using theparameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 753 / 1176

Page 754: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.28 (P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS) - (P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS)

HMI Name P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFSParameter Name

Logical Name P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Definition Defines the Diffserv DSCP value used on the IP network by MFSflows having the P2 internal BSS priority (P3 is the lowest priority).

Coding rules Step size = 1.Only a subset of the possible values are defined in thestandard: 00 for BE, 10,12,14 for AF1; 18,20,22 for AF2; 26, 28,30for AF3; 34, 36, 38 for AF4 and 46 for EF.

Mandatory rules P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >= P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >=P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules The operator shall ensure that it is equal toP2_LAYER3_MAPPING_BSC

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 63 26

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using theparameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using theparameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

754 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 755: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.29 (P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS) - (P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS)

HMI Name P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFSParameter Name

Logical Name P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Definition Defines the priority indicated in L2 protocol (e.g. ethernet),corresponding to the P3 internal priority (the lowest).

Coding rules step size = 1.

Mandatory rules P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC >= P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC

Recommended rules The operator shall ensure that it is equal toP3_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using theparameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using theparameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 755 / 1176

Page 756: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.30 (P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS) - (P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS)

HMI Name P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFSParameter Name

Logical Name P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Definition Defines the Diffserv DSCP value used on the IP network by MFSflows having the P3 internal BSS priority (P3 is the lowest priority).

Coding rules Step size = 1.Only a subset of the possible values are defined in thestandard: 00 for BE, 10,12,14 for AF1; 18,20,22 for AF2; 26, 28,30for AF3; 34, 36, 38 for AF4 and 46 for EF.

Mandatory rules P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >= P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules The operator shall ensure that it is equal toP3_LAYER3_MAPPING_BSC

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 63 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using theparameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using theparameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

756 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 757: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.31 (PDU_LIFETIME_ORDER) - (PDU_LIFETIME_ORDER)

HMI Name PDU_LIFETIME_ORDERParameter Name

Logical Name PDU_LIFETIME_ORDER

Definition Authorize or inhibit DL LLC PDU ordering according to the remainingPDU lifetime.

Coding rules 0: ordering disabled, 1 : ordering enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules Should be set to "ordering disabled", when the MFS interfaces withan Ericsson SGSN or any SGSN modifying the PDU Lifetime valueduring data flows addressed to the same MS on the same LLC SAPIin a non-acceptable manner, otherwise should be set to "orderingenabled".

Category Network (CDE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Customer BUL file

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 757 / 1176

Page 758: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.32 (S_BECN) - (S_BECN)

HMI Name S_BECNParameter Name

Logical Name S_BECN

Definition Number of consecutive frames with BECN bit before congestion isstated.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 255 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Customer BUL files

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

758 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 759: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.33 (SCHEDULING_PRIORITY_FACTOR) -(SCHEDULING_PRIORITY_FACTOR)

HMI Name SCHEDULING_PRIORITY_FACTORParameter Name

Logical Name SCHEDULING_PRIORITY_FACTOR

Definition When computing the best candidate timeslot allocation for an NRTTBF, this factor enables to give a higher weight (PDCH capacity)to the already-established NRT TBFs having a higher schedulingpriority (combination of THP and of Precedence) than the TBF tobe established or reallocated.This factor will tend to avoid piling upseveral TBFs with different scheduling priorities on the same PDCHs,which would degrade the throughput of the low-priority TBFs.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The higher the value of T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULING is, thehigher the value of SCHEDULING_PRIORITY_FACTOR shall be,in order to avoid degrading the throughput of the low-priority TBFsin a significant manner (if it is possible according to the availablePDCHs in the cell).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 759 / 1176

Page 760: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.34 (T_ACK_WAIT) - (T_ACK_WAIT)

HMI Name T_ACK_WAITParameter Name

Logical Name T_ACK_WAIT

Definition Timer defining the maximum time to wait for an MS answer (i.e.Packet Control Ack or beginning of an UL TBF) to a networksolicitation sent on PACCH/DL when the MS is in PTM, or on PPCHwhen the MS is in PIM and non-DRX mode, or on main DCCH whenthe MS is in dedicated mode.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellitelinks:- T_ack_wait = 1200 ms if GPRS traffic is carried through Abisand Ater terrestrial links in all the cells of the MFS.- T_ack_wait =1700 ms if GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis satellite links orAter satellite links in at least one cell of the MFS.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 5 1.2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

760 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 761: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.35 (T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCH) - (T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCH)

HMI Name T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCHParameter Name

Logical Name T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCH

Definition Timer defining the maximum time to wait for a MS answer (i.e. PacketControl Ack) to a network sollicitation sent on PPCH when the MS isin PIM and DRX mode.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 sec ; 0 = 0; 1 = 0.1;... ;100 = 10

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellitelinks:- T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCH = 2.5 s if GPRS traffic is carriedthrough Abis and Ater terrestrial links in all the cells of the MFS,-T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCH = 3 s if GPRS traffic is carried eitherthrough Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links in at least one cellof the MFS.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 10 2.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 761 / 1176

Page 762: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.36 (T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC) -(T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC)

HMI Name T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOCParameter Name

Logical Name T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC

Definition Timer value controlling the time duration between successive resourcereallocation attempts for candidate MSs (triggers T3 and T4).In agiven cell, at each expiry of the T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOCtimer :- up to N_MAX_PERIODIC_REALLOC_ATTEMPT_T4T4 TBF reallocation attempts are performed,- up to 2 xN_MAX_PERIODIC_REALLOC_ATTEMPT_T3 T3 TBF reallocationattempts are performed

Coding rules step size = 1 sec; value 1 means 1 sec; value 2 means 2 sec, andso on

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T_GCH_INACTIVITY > T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC in all thecells of the BSS.This constraints avoids as much as possible thatsome GCHs are released and reestablished again some momentslater. This way, the T3 and T4 TBF reallocations can benefit from theGCHs which are currently unused, but still established.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 20 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Customer BUL files

External Comment This parameter, together with the parametersN_MAX_PERIODIC_REALLOC_ATTEMPT_T3 andN_MAX_PERIODIC_REALLOC_ATTEMPT_T4, allows to :- tocontrol the reactivity of the BSS with regards to T3 and T4 TBFreallocations,- and to control the extra CPU load generated byT3 and T4 TBF reallocation attempts (the lowest the value ofT_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC, the highest the generated CPUload).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

762 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 763: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.37 (T_GCH_release) - (Trelease)

HMI Name T_GCH_releaseParameter Name

Logical Name Trelease

Definition Supervision of GCH link release for 16k channel.

Coding rules step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules Trelease > TdslTreq_pending > Trelease

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellitelinks:- Trelease = 500 ms if GPRS traffic is carried through Abis andAter terrestrial links in all the cells of the MFS,- Trelease = 1000 msif GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis satellite links or Atersatellite links in at least one cell of the MFS.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 200 1200 500

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment HMI name changed to precise that this timer is valid for GCHchannels. Former HMI name Trelease.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 763 / 1176

Page 764: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.38 (T_GPRS_Resume) - (T_GPRS_Resume)

HMI Name T_GPRS_ResumeParameter Name

Logical Name T_GPRS_Resume

Definition Timer used by BSC, to wait for Resume acknowledgement fromSGSN before releasing the CS channel.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 sec, coded from 2 to 50

Mandatory rules T_GPRS_Resume < T3240 (10s)

Recommended rules T_GPRS_Resume > (BSSGP_T4 * (Resume_retries+1))It isrecommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:-T_GPRS_RESUME = 1 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Aterterrestrial links in all the cells of the MFS,- T_GPRS_RESUME =1.5 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links in at leastone cell of the MFS.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.2 5 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment T3240 is a MS timer see 3GPP TS 24.008

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

764 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 765: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.39 (T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULING) -(T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULING)

HMI Name T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULINGParameter Name

Logical Name T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULING

Definition Maximum time between two scheduling of a given NRT TBF (eitherbetween two DL block requests for a NRT DL TBF, or between twoUL blocks received for a given NRT UL TBF).

Coding rules step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.12 0.3 0.3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 765 / 1176

Page 766: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.40 (T_MS_CONTEXT_FLUSH_PERSISTENCE) -(T_MS_CONTEXT_FLUSH_PERSISTENCE)

HMI Name T_MS_CONTEXT_FLUSH_PERSISTENCEParameter Name

Logical Name T_MS_CONTEXT_FLUSH_PERSISTENCE

Definition This timer controls the duration during which a MS context is keptafter receipt of a FLUSH-LL.

Coding rules step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 0 5000 1000

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

766 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 767: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.41 (T_REROUTING_REQUEST_GUARD) -(T_REROUTING_REQUEST_GUARD)

HMI Name T_REROUTING_REQUEST_GUARDParameter Name

Logical Name T_REROUTING_REQUEST_GUARD

Definition This timer controls the maximum time during which a GPU waits forthe response to a rerouting request.

Coding rules step size = 50 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 50 2000 500

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 767 / 1176

Page 768: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.42 (T_ul_2_ph_access) - (T_One_Block)

HMI Name T_ul_2_ph_accessParameter Name

Logical Name T_One_Block

Definition - For Non Evolium BTS : Timer to postpone the release of one slavePDCH, when it does not support any (E)GPRS traffic, but a one uplinkblock has been allocated on it to a MS for a 2 phase access TBFestablishment. - For Evolium BTS : Timer to postpone the releaseof the M-EGCH link of a TRX, when the TRX does not support any(E)GPRS traffic, but a one uplink block has been allocated to a MS fora 2 phase access TBF establishment on one of the RTSs of the TRX

Coding rules step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellitelinks:- T_one_block = 4 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Abis andAter terrestrial links in all the cells of the MFS,- T_one_block = 5 sif GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis satellite links or Atersatellite links in at least one cell of the MFS.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 3 10 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

768 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 769: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.43 (T_ul_access_max) - (T_ul_access_max)

HMI Name T_ul_access_maxParameter Name

Logical Name T_ul_access_max

Definition Timer to limit the duration of an UL TBF establishment.

Coding rules step size = 50 ms, 0 = 0 ms, 1 = 50 ms,... , 100 = 5000 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules The two following rules are recommended:i) The TimeT_ul_access_max shall be longer than the duration of a radioallocation requested towards the BSC.ii) A too long value ofT_ul_access_max may lead to reserve unnecessarily radioresources. It is recommended to set T_ul_access_max = T_repeat+ 240 ms Round_Trip_Delay, where the T_Repeat is the maximumtime between two successive packet channel requests, 240 ms is agiven margin. The value of T_Repeat depends on the parameters S,TX_INT, and TX_INTEGER.It is recommended to set this parameteras follows depending on whether or not GPRS traffic is carriedthrough Ater satellite links:- T_ul_access_max = 1400 ms if GPRStraffic is carried through Ater terrestrial links in all the cells of theMFS,- T_ul_access_max = 1900 ms if GPRS traffic is carried throughAter satellite links in at least one cell of the MFS.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 0 5000 1400

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 769 / 1176

Page 770: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.44 (T_WAIT_FLUSH) - (T_WAIT_FLUSH)

HMI Name T_WAIT_FLUSHParameter Name

Logical Name T_WAIT_FLUSH

Definition Timer monitoring the receipt of a Flush message or a GPRS suspendmessage further to the release of the on-going TBF(s)

Coding rules Step size : 0.5 sec1 coded 1; 1,5 coded 2; 2 coded 3; 2,5 coded 4;.15,5 coded 30 and 16 coded 31

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules The timer T_WAIT_FLUSH shall be set to the maximum cellreselection duration plus the time for the MS to switch back to the oldcell and send a Packet Cell Change Failure message.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 16 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

770 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 771: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.45 (T1) - (bssgp_T1)

HMI Name T1Parameter Name

Logical Name bssgp_T1

Definition Guards the (un)blocking procedures.

Coding rules step size=1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 30 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Customer BUL file

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 771 / 1176

Page 772: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.46 (T2) - (bssgp_T2)

HMI Name T2Parameter Name

Logical Name bssgp_T2

Definition Guards the reset procedure.

Coding rules step size=1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 120 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Customer BUL file

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

772 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 773: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.47 (T200_GSL (MFS)) - (T200_GSL (MFS))

HMI Name T200_GSL (MFS)Parameter Name

Logical Name T200_GSL (MFS)

Definition Supervision of acknowledgements on the GSL link.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T_GSL_Ack (MFS) > T200_GSL (MFS) * (1 + N200_GSL (MFS))Itis recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:-T200_GSL(MFS) = 1 if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater terrestriallinks in all BSC of the MFS.- T200_GSL(MFS) = 2 if GPRS traffic iscarried through Ater satellite links in at least one BSC of the MFS.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 2 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 773 / 1176

Page 774: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.48 (T391) - (T391)

HMI Name T391Parameter Name

Logical Name T391

Definition Link integrity verification polling timer (Frame Relay, see ITU Q.933,Annex A, A.7).

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules N392*T391 is the value of the link failure detection time

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 5 30 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Customer BUL file

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

774 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 775: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.49 (TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL) - (TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL)

HMI Name TBF_GCH_RATIO_DLParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL

Definition Multiplication factor used in the computation of the maximum numberof DL TBFs allowed to be established on a TRX for a given numberof GCHs on this TRX (i.e. in the M-EGCH link of this TRX).

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 5 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment If there is a great amount of "short data" TBFs in the network(delayed DL or extended UL phases are longer than actual TBFtraffic phases), the existing TBF limitations (in number of TBFsestablished on a TRX for a given number of GCHs on this TRX) maybe too restrictive and lead to some TBF establishment failures. TheTBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parameters allowto increase this limit, so to be more flexible. Another justification forthe TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parametersis that the limits for DL and UL TBF numbers may be different.TheTBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parameters areused in the formulae to compute Min_Nb_GCH_Best_Effort_XL(RRM-PRH). An increase of their value should be validated by loadtests (in order to check, among others, that the DSP can support theinduced extra CPU load).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 775 / 1176

Page 776: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.50 (TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL) - (TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL)

HMI Name TBF_GCH_RATIO_ULParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL

Definition Multiplication factor used in the computation of the maximum numberof UL TBFs allowed to be established on a TRX for a given numberof GCHs on this TRX (i.e. in the M-EGCH link of this TRX).

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 5 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment If there is a great amount of "short data" TBFs in the network(delayed DL or extended UL phases are longer than actual TBFtraffic phases), the existing TBF limitations (in number of TBFsestablished on a TRX for a given number of GCHs on this TRX) maybe too restrictive and lead to some TBF establishment failures. TheTBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parameters allowto increase this limit, so to be more flexible. Another justification forthe TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parametersis that the limits for DL and UL TBF numbers may be different.TheTBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parameters areused in the formulae to compute Min_Nb_GCH_Best_Effort_XL(RRM-PRH). An increase of their value should be validated by loadtests (in order to check, among others, that the DSP can support theinduced extra CPU load).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

776 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 777: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.51 (Telecom_VLAN_ID) - (Telecom_VLAN_ID)

HMI Name Telecom_VLAN_IDParameter Name

Logical Name Telecom_VLAN_ID

Definition Virtual LAN identifier used to tag the MFS internal telecom traffic

Coding rules Coded on 12 bits.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In case the same subnet is used for Telecom and OAM traffic, thesame VLAN_ID shall be used for Telecom and OAM VLAN_Ids.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 2 4094 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 777 / 1176

Page 778: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.52 (TnsBlock) - (Tns_block)

HMI Name TnsBlockParameter Name

Logical Name Tns_block

Definition Time-out to trigger the block/unblock procedure.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 120 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Customer BUL file

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

778 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 779: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.53 (TnsReset) - (Tns_reset)

HMI Name TnsResetParameter Name

Logical Name Tns_reset

Definition Time-out for reset procedure.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 120 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Customer BUL file

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 779 / 1176

Page 780: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.54 (TnsTest) - (Tns_test)

HMI Name TnsTestParameter Name

Logical Name Tns_test

Definition Overall time-out to test an NS-VC.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 60 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Customer BUL file

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

780 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 781: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.55 (Treq_pending) - (Treq_pending)

HMI Name Treq_pendingParameter Name

Logical Name Treq_pending

Definition Maximum time during which a GCH establishment or release requestfrom PMU can be delayed in MEGCH layer.

Coding rules step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules Treq_pending > Trelease+Tcorr

Recommended rules Treq_pending > Testab+Tcorr

Category Network (CDE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 1000 5200 2000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 781 / 1176

Page 782: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2 Site (CAE)

5.2.1 (ACCESS_BURST_TYPE) - (ACCESS_BURST_TYPE)

HMI Name ACCESS_BURST_TYPEParameter Name

Logical Name ACCESS_BURST_TYPE

Definition Format of the access burst used by (E)GPRS MSs whensending a PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST, a PACKET CONTROLACKNOWLEDGEMENT or a PTCCH/U message.

Coding rules 0 : 8 bits access bursts, 1 : 11 bits access bursts

Mandatory rules For Non-Evolium BTS (i.e. DRFU BTS), the OMC-R shall force theACCESS_BURST_TYPE parameter to "8-bits access bursts".Acouple of mate cells (Extended inner + extended outer) shall havethe same ACCESS_BURST_TYPE when they are PS capable.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Cnct Ctrl 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

782 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 783: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.2 (Allowed priority classes) - (PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD(BSC))

HMI Name Allowed priority classesParameter Name

Logical Name PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD (BSC)

Definition This parameter indicates whether or not a MS of a certain priorityclass is allowed to do Packet access.

Coding rules Coded over 3 bits . 000: packet access not allowed in the cell;011:packet access allowed for priority level 1; 100: packet accessallowed for priority level 1 to 2; 101: packet access allowed for prioritylevel 1 to 3; 110: packet access allowed for priority level 1 to 4

Mandatory rules Equal to PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 6 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 783 / 1176

Page 784: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.3 (Allowed priority classes) - (PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD(MFS))

HMI Name Allowed priority classesParameter Name

Logical Name PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD (MFS)

Definition This parameter indicates whether or not a MS of a certain priorityclass is allowed to do a Packet access.

Coding rules Coded over 3 bits . 000: packet access is not allowed in the cell;011:packet access is allowed for priority level 1; 100: packet accessis allowed for priority level 1 to 2; 101: packet access is allowed forpriority level 1 to 3; 110: packet access allowed for priority level 1 to 4

Mandatory rules Equal to PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 6 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment Persistence level parameter for priority (i) is meaningless if the RadioPriority (i) is not allowed

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

784 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 785: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.4 (ALPHA) - (ALPHA (BSC))

HMI Name ALPHAParameter Name

Logical Name ALPHA (BSC)

Definition Alpha power control parameter.

Coding rules Possible values are : 0.0 to 1.0 with step of 0.1respectively binarycoded : 0000, 0001, 0010 1010

Mandatory rules Equal to ALPHA (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 785 / 1176

Page 786: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.5 (ALPHA) - (ALPHA (MFS))

HMI Name ALPHAParameter Name

Logical Name ALPHA (MFS)

Definition Alpha power control parameter.

Coding rules Possible values are : 0.0 to 1.0 with step of 0.1respectively binarycoded : 0000, 0001, 0010 1010

Mandatory rules Equal to ALPHA (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

786 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 787: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.6 (Ater_Usage_Threshold) - (Ater_Usage_Threshold)

HMI Name Ater_Usage_ThresholdParameter Name

Logical Name Ater_Usage_Threshold

Definition Threshold (percentage of used Ater nibbles, in a GPU) above whichthe Ater usage is said "high".

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules A low value of GCH_RED_Factor_High_Ater_Usage can becoherent with a high value of Ater_Usage_Threshold (it will avoidreaching the saturation point of 100% of the Ater resources usedat the same moment in the GPU). Reciprocally, a high valueof GCH_RED_Factor_High_Ater_Usage can be coherent witha low value of Ater_Usage_Threshold (it will limit the risks ofwasting, i.e. of not using, Ater resources in the GPU).For allthe Ater_Usage_Threshold values being defined for the BSSshandled by the MFS, Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data <=Ater_Usage_Threshold 30%. Indeed, for consistency reasons,"short data" MS transfer optimizations should come prior to highAter usage optimizations.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 1 100 70

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment When the Ater usage is "high", theGCH_RED_FACTOR_High_Ater_Usage is applied,whereas when the Ater usage is "normal" (i.e. percentage of usedAter nibbles is below the threshold), no GCH reduction factor isapplied.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 787 / 1176

Page 788: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.7 (BEST_EFFORT_PRIORITY) - (BEST_EFFORT_PRIORITY)

HMI Name BEST_EFFORT_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name BEST_EFFORT_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for the pre-defined Best EffortPacket Flow Context, and for all MS traffic without PFC

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Default value corresponds to the priority for interactive THP3.Theminimum value (the highest priority) corresponds to one priority levelbelow the streaming class.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

788 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 789: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.8 (BS_AG_BLKS_RES) - (BS_AG_BLKS_RES (MFS))

HMI Name BS_AG_BLKS_RESParameter Name

Logical Name BS_AG_BLKS_RES (MFS)

Definition Number of CCCH blocks reserved for the access grant channel(AGCH), broadcast on the PBCCH for CS service establishment.

Coding rules coded on 3 bits (000 : 0, ...111 : 7)

Mandatory rules -BS_AG_BLKS_RES (MFS) = BS_AG_BLKS_RES (BSC) for agiven cell-when CCCH_CONF=0 and CBCH is configured in thecell, BS_AG_BLKS_RES>0- when CCCH_CONF=2, max value ofBS_AG_BLKS_RES is 7 and BS_AG_BLKS_RES must be > 0 ifCBCH is configured in the cell.-When EN_VGCS is disabled :. ifBCCH_EXT = true, then BS_AG_BLKS_RES >= 1-When EN_VGCSis enabled : . if BCCH_EXT = false, then BS_AG_BLKS_RES>= NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS . if BCCH_EXT = true, thenBS_AG_BLKS_RES > NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment Maximum and Default values given for CCCH_CONF=0ForCCCH_CONF=1, max=2, def=1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 789 / 1176

Page 790: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.9 (BS_CV_MAX) - (BS_CV_MAX (BSC))

HMI Name BS_CV_MAXParameter Name

Logical Name BS_CV_MAX (BSC)

Definition Number of remaining RLC data blocks sent (per assigned PDCH) bythe MS, below which the Count Down procedure is entered.One thirdof the number of RLC data blocks per assigned PDCH before the MSchecks if the resolution contention has failed.

Coding rules Coded on 4 bits (1==0001, 2 == 0010 .. 15 == 1111).

Mandatory rules Equal to BS_CV_MAX (MFS)

Recommended rules BS_CV_MAX should be set to a value equal to the "minimum" roundtrip delay to optimise the uplink re-transmission of non-acknowledgedblocks and minimise window-stalled situations.If BS_CV_MAXis set greater than round-trip-delay, uplink retransmissions ofunacknowledged blocks may be delayed.It is recommended to setthis parameter as follows depending whether or not GPRS traffic iscarried through Abis or Ater satellite links:- BS_CV_MAX = 9 if GPRStraffic is carried through Abis and Ater terrestrial links in the servingcell,- BS_CV_MAX = 15 if GPRS traffic is carried either through Abissatellite links or Ater satellite links in the serving cell.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 9

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment Used by the MS to start the countdown value process (release ofUL TBF) or to consider acknowledgement messages as valid for agiven RLC data block. Lower values avoid too many TBF releasesand reestablishments.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

790 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 791: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.10 (BS_CV_MAX) - (BS_CV_MAX (MFS))

HMI Name BS_CV_MAXParameter Name

Logical Name BS_CV_MAX (MFS)

Definition Number of remaining RLC data blocks sent (per assigned PDCH) bythe MS, below which the Count Down procedure is entered.One thirdof the number of RLC data blocks per assigned PDCH before the MSchecks if the resolution contention has failed.

Coding rules Coded on 4 bits (1==0001, 2 == 0010 .. 15 == 1111).

Mandatory rules Equal to BS_CV_MAX (BSC)

Recommended rules BS_CV_MAX should be set to a value equal to the "minimum" roundtrip delay to optimise the uplink re-transmission of non-acknowledgedblocks and minimise window-stalled situations.If BS_CV_MAXis set greater than round-trip-delay, uplink retransmissions ofunacknowledged blocks may be delayed.It is recommended to setthis parameter as follows depending whether or not GPRS traffic iscarried through Abis or Ater satellite links:- BS_CV_MAX = 9 if GPRStraffic is carried through Abis and Ater terrestrial links in the servingcell,- BS_CV_MAX = 15 if GPRS traffic is carried either through Abissatellite links or Ater satellite links in the serving cell.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 9

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment Used by the MS to start the countdown value process (release ofUL TBF) or to consider acknowledgement messages as valid for agiven RLC data block. Lower values avoid too many TBF releasesand reestablishments.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 791 / 1176

Page 792: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.11 (BS_PA_MFRMS) - (BS_PA_MFRMS (MFS))

HMI Name BS_PA_MFRMSParameter Name

Logical Name BS_PA_MFRMS (MFS)

Definition Number of 51 frame multiframes between consecutive occurrencesof a Paging Group, broadcast on the PBCCH for the CS serviceestablishment.

Coding rules coded on 3 bits (000 : 2, ... 111: 9)

Mandatory rules BS_PA_MFRMS (BSC) = BS_PA_MFRMS (MFS) for a given cell

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 2 9 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment The bigger this parameter is, the lesser the MS power consumptionis.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

792 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 793: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.12 (BS_PAG_BLKS_RES) - (BS_PAG_BLKS_RES)

HMI Name BS_PAG_BLKS_RESParameter Name

Logical Name BS_PAG_BLKS_RES

Definition Number of blocks allocated to the PAGCH or PDTCH or PACCH per52 multiframe.

Coding rules coded on 4 bits (0001: 1, ..., 1010: 10)The codepoints 0000: 0,1011: 11 and 1100: 12 are not supported by the ALCATEL BSS.

Mandatory rules BS_PAG_BLKS_RES < 12 BS_PBCCH_BLKS

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment According to 3GPP TS 05.02, the number of paging blocks "available"on one PCCCH =(12 - BS_PAG_BLKS_RES - BS_PBCCH_BLKS)* 64. In order for the network to be able to page GPRS-attachedMobile Stations when PCCCH is present in the cell, there shall beat least one radio block where paging can occur. This requires (12- BS_PAG_BLKS_RES - BS_PBCCH_BLKS) to be strictly greaterthan 0.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 793 / 1176

Page 794: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.13 (BS_PBCCH_BLKS) - (BS_PBCCH_BLKS)

HMI Name BS_PBCCH_BLKSParameter Name

Logical Name BS_PBCCH_BLKS

Definition Number of blocks allocated to the PBCCH per 52 multiframe.

Coding rules coded on 2 bits : 00=Block B0 used for PBCCH, 01=Block B0, B6used for PBCCH, 10=Block B0, B6, B3 used for PBCCH, 11=BlockB0, B6, B3, B9 used for PBCCH

Mandatory rules BS_PBCCH_BLKS < 12 - BS_PAG_BLKS_RES

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 4 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

794 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 795: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.14 (BS_PRACH_BLKS_MIN) - (BS_PRACH_BLKS)

HMI Name BS_PRACH_BLKS_MINParameter Name

Logical Name BS_PRACH_BLKS

Definition Number of blocks statically allocated to the PRACH per 52 multiframeon each MPDCH.

Coding rules coded on 4 bits (0001: 1, .., 1000: 8)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 8 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 795 / 1176

Page 796: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.15 (BS_TXPWR_MAX) - (BS_TXPWR_MAX (MFS))

When a cell is shared, the BS_TX_POWER_MAX andBS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNER powers must always be defined against theactual physical power of the main sector. If the actual power of the secondarysector is lower than the actual power of the main sector, the operator has toadjust the values of BS_TX_POWER_MAX and BS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNERto avoid requiring too high an output power than is actually available.

HMI Name BS_TXPWR_MAXParameter Name

Logical Name BS_TXPWR_MAX (MFS)

Definition This parameter defines the power reduction relative to the maximumGMSK output power of the BTS.

Coding rules 0 0 0 0 = 0 dB, 0 0 0 1 = -2 dB, 0 0 1 0 = -4 dB, ..., 1 1 1 1 = -30 dB

Mandatory rules Equal to BS_TXPWR_MAX (BSC)BS_TXPWR_MAX >=BS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -30 0 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment The BTS maximum allowed transmit power is defined relatively tothe BTS maximum RF transmit power in GMSK (due to hardwarelimitation).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

796 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 797: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.16 (BVCI) - (PTP_BVCI)

HMI Name BVCIParameter Name

Logical Name PTP_BVCI

Definition PTP BVCI value.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 2 65535 #

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Cell Menu / Show GPRS Bvci

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 797 / 1176

Page 798: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.17 (C31_HYST) - (C31_HYST)

HMI Name C31_HYSTParameter Name

Logical Name C31_HYST

Definition Determines whether an additional cell hysteresis shallbe applied to the C31 criterion. The hysteresis isGPRS_CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS (for NC0 mode).

Coding rules 0 : no, 1 : yes

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

798 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 799: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.18 (C32_QUAL) - (C32_QUAL)

HMI Name C32_QUALParameter Name

Logical Name C32_QUAL

Definition Flag indicating an exception rule for GPRS_RESELECT_OFFSETin NC0 mode.

Coding rules 0=NO, 1=YES

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 799 / 1176

Page 800: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.19 (Capacity) - (ACCESS_RATE_BC)

HMI Name CapacityParameter Name

Logical Name ACCESS_RATE_BC

Definition Physical access rate of the Frame Relay bearer channel.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Not changeable after MFS system initialization.CIR <= NIR <= CIR x(1 + EBS/CBS) <= ACCESS_RATE_BC

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

kbit/s 64 1984 64

Modifiable OMC Changes: displayed RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Frame relay

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

800 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 801: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.20 (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET) - (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (MFS))

HMI Name CELL_RESELECT_OFFSETParameter Name

Logical Name CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (MFS)

Definition Permanent offset to C2 criterion.

Coding rules step size = 2dB; coded on 6 bits (000000:0 dB, 111111 : 126 dB)

Mandatory rules CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (MFS) = CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 126 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 801 / 1176

Page 802: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.21 (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET) -(CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(MFS))

HMI Name CELL_RESELECT_OFFSETParameter Name

Logical Name CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(MFS)

Definition Permanent offset to C2 criterion.

Coding rules step size = 2dB; coded on 6 bits (000000:0 dB, 111111 : 126 dB)

Mandatory rules CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(MFS) =CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (n)(BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 126 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit External Cell/ Packet2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

802 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 803: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.22 (CI) - (CI (MFS))

HMI Name CIParameter Name

Logical Name CI (MFS)

Definition Cell Identity.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual toCI (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 65535 65535

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 803 / 1176

Page 804: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.23 (CI) - (CI(n) (MFS))

HMI Name CIParameter Name

Logical Name CI(n) (MFS)

Definition Cell Identity of adjacent cell.

Coding rules Values 0..65535 correspond to the standard CI-value.

Mandatory rules LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same time.Equal toCI(n)(BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 65535 65535

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Adjacencies

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

804 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 805: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.24 (Commited Burst Size) - (CBS)

HMI Name Commited Burst SizeParameter Name

Logical Name CBS

Definition Commited Burst Size.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules CIR=0 <=> CBS=0 => EBS > 0CIR <= NIR <= CIR x (1 + EBS/CBS)<= ACCESS RATE BC

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance PVC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

kbyte 0 248 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Create NS-VC

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 805 / 1176

Page 806: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.25 (Committed Information Rate) - (CIR)

HMI Name Committed Information RateParameter Name

Logical Name CIR

Definition Committed Information Rate.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules CIR=0 when "direct access" is used, CIR=0 <=> CBS=0 => EBS >0CIR <= NIR <= CIR x (1 + EBS/CBS) <= ACCESS RATE BC

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance PVC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

kbit/s 0 1984 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Create NS-VC

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

806 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 807: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.26 (CS_AVG_PERIOD_LT) - (CS_AVG_PERIOD_LT)

HMI Name CS_AVG_PERIOD_LTParameter Name

Logical Name CS_AVG_PERIOD_LT

Definition "Forgetting time" in the long term averaging of channel qualitymeasurements in the GPRS link Adaptation: measurements whichare older than CS_AVG_PERIOD_LT are negligible in the average ofchannel quality measurements.

Coding rules step size = 20ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.02 5 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 807 / 1176

Page 808: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.27 (CS_AVG_PERIOD_ST) - (CS_AVG_PERIOD_ST)

HMI Name CS_AVG_PERIOD_STParameter Name

Logical Name CS_AVG_PERIOD_ST

Definition "Forgetting time" in the short term averaging of channel qualitymeasurements in the GPRS link adaptation: measurements whichare older than CS_AVG_PERIOD_ST are negligible in the average ofchannel quality measurements.

Coding rules step size = 20ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.02 5 0.32

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

808 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 809: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.28 (CS_BLER_DL_3_4) - (CS_BLER_DL_3_4)

HMI Name CS_BLER_DL_3_4Parameter Name

Logical Name CS_BLER_DL_3_4

Definition CS3 BLER threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the downlink direction whenthe SIR measurements are not reported by the MS

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 809 / 1176

Page 810: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.29 (CS_BLER_DL_4_3) - (CS_BLER_DL_4_3)

HMI Name CS_BLER_DL_4_3Parameter Name

Logical Name CS_BLER_DL_4_3

Definition CS4 BLER threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS4 to CS3 in the downlink direction whenthe SIR measurements are not reported by the MS.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

810 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 811: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.30 (CS_HST_DL_LT) - (CS_HST_DL_LT)

HMI Name CS_HST_DL_LTParameter Name

Logical Name CS_HST_DL_LT

Definition Hysteresis value for AV_RXQUAL_LT thresholds used in the downlinkradio link supervision to change the TBF coding scheme.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 6 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 811 / 1176

Page 812: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.31 (CS_HST_DL_ST) - (CS_HST_DL_ST)

HMI Name CS_HST_DL_STParameter Name

Logical Name CS_HST_DL_ST

Definition Hysteresis value for AV_RXQUAL_ST thresholds used in thedownlink radio link supervision to change the TBF coding scheme.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 6 1.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

812 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 813: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.32 (CS_HST_UL_LT) - (CS_HST_UL_LT)

HMI Name CS_HST_UL_LTParameter Name

Logical Name CS_HST_UL_LT

Definition Hysteresis value for AV_RXQUAL_LT thresholds used in the uplinkradio link supervision to change the TBF coding scheme.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 6 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 813 / 1176

Page 814: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.33 (CS_HST_UL_ST) - (CS_HST_UL_ST)

HMI Name CS_HST_UL_STParameter Name

Logical Name CS_HST_UL_ST

Definition Hysteresis value for AV_RXQUAL_ST thresholds used in the uplinkradio link supervision to change the TBF coding scheme.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 6 1.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

814 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 815: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.34 (CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIOD) - (CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIOD)

HMI Name CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIOD

Definition Maximum transfer inactivity time to reuse the previous (Modulationand) Coding Scheme. This applies in case of transfer resumptionduring inactive TBF phase (delayed downlink TBF mode / extendeduplink TBF mode) and in case of uplink TBF establishment onPACCH while extended uplink TBF mode is not used (with someadditional restrictions).

Coding rules step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 0 5000 680

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Cnct Ctrl 1/2

External Comment This parameter applies to both GPRS and EGPRS TBFs.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 815 / 1176

Page 816: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.35 (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_ACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on ahopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

816 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 817: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.36 (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_NACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on ahopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 817 / 1176

Page 818: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.37 (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_ACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

818 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 819: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.38 (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_NACK) -(CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_NACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 819 / 1176

Page 820: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.39 (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_ACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on ahopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

820 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 821: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.40 (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_NACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on ahopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 821 / 1176

Page 822: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.41 (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_ACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 3.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

822 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 823: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.42 (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_NACK) -(CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_NACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 823 / 1176

Page 824: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.43 (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_ACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on ahopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

824 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 825: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.44 (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_NACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on ahopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 825 / 1176

Page 826: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.45 (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

826 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 827: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.46 (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK) -(CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the downlink direction whenthe RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 827 / 1176

Page 828: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.47 (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_ACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the uplink direction whenthe RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on ahopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

828 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 829: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.48 (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_NACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the uplink direction whenthe RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on ahopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 829 / 1176

Page 830: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.49 (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_ACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the uplink direction whenthe RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

830 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 831: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.50 (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_NACK) -(CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_NACK

Definition RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to changethe Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the uplink direction whenthe RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 831 / 1176

Page 832: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.51 (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_ACK

Definition Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change theCoding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the uplink direction when theRLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a hoppingTRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

832 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 833: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.52 (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_NACK

Definition Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change theCoding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the uplink direction when theRLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on ahopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 833 / 1176

Page 834: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.53 (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_ACK

Definition Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change theCoding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the uplink direction whenthe RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 3.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

834 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 835: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.54 (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_NACK) -(CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_NACK

Definition Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change theCoding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the uplink direction when theRLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 835 / 1176

Page 836: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.55 (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_ACK

Definition Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change theCoding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the uplink direction when theRLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a hoppingTRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

836 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 837: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.56 (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_NACK

Definition Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change theCoding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the uplink direction when theRLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on ahopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 837 / 1176

Page 838: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.57 (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_ACK

Definition Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change theCoding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the uplink direction whenthe RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

838 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 839: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.58 (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_NACK) -(CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_NACK

Definition Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change theCoding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the uplink direction when theRLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on anon-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 839 / 1176

Page 840: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.59 (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_ACK) - (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_ACK

Definition Signal to Interference Ratio threshold used in the link adaptationalgorithms to change the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in thedownlink direction when the RLC mode is acknowledged and theTBF is established on a hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 15 14

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

840 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 841: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.60 (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_NACK) - (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_NACK

Definition Signal to Interference Ratio threshold used in the link adaptationalgorithms to change the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in thedownlink direction when the RLC mode is unacknowledged and theTBF is established on a hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 15 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 841 / 1176

Page 842: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.61 (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK) - (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK)

HMI Name CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK

Definition Signal to Interference Ratio threshold used in the link adaptationalgorithms to change the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in thedownlink direction when the RLC mode is acknowledged and theTBF is established on a non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 15 13

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

842 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 843: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.62 (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK) - (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK)

HMI Name CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK

Definition Signal to Interference Ratio threshold used in the link adaptationalgorithms to change the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in thedownlink direction when the RLC mode is unacknowledged and theTBF is established on a non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 15 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 843 / 1176

Page 844: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.63 (CS_SIR_HST_DL) - (CS_SIR_HST_DL)

HMI Name CS_SIR_HST_DLParameter Name

Logical Name CS_SIR_HST_DL

Definition Signal to Interference Ratio hysteresis used in the link adaptationalgorithms to change the Coding Scheme from CS4 to CS3 in thedownlink direction.

Coding rules step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 15 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

844 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 845: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.64 (Data Link Connection Identifier) - (DLCI)

HMI Name Data Link Connection IdentifierParameter Name

Logical Name DLCI

Definition Data Link Connection Identifier, corresponds to a PVC identifier, seeQ.922 Annex A, Table 1.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance PVC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 16 991 None

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Create NS-VC

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 845 / 1176

Page 846: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.65 (DRX_TIMER_MAX) - (DRX_TIMER_MAX (BSC))

HMI Name DRX_TIMER_MAXParameter Name

Logical Name DRX_TIMER_MAX (BSC)

Definition Maximum value allowed for the MS to request for non-DRX modeafter packet transfer mode.

Coding rules Radio coding :Possible values : 0, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64 respectivelybinary coded as 000, 001, , 111ONLY THE VALUES 0, 1, 2 AND 4ARE POSSIBLE in ALCATEL BSS.

Mandatory rules Equal to DRX_TIMER_MAX (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 4 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

846 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 847: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.66 (DRX_TIMER_MAX) - (DRX_TIMER_MAX (MFS))

HMI Name DRX_TIMER_MAXParameter Name

Logical Name DRX_TIMER_MAX (MFS)

Definition Maximum value allowed for the MS to request for non-DRX modeafter packet transfer mode.

Coding rules Radio coding :Possible values : 0, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64 respectivelybinary coded as 000, 001, , 111ONLY THE VALUES 0, 1, 2 AND 4ARE POSSIBLE in ALCATEL BSS.

Mandatory rules Equal to DRX_TIMER_MAX (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 4 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 847 / 1176

Page 848: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.67 (EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK) - (EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK)

HMI Name EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACKParameter Name

Logical Name EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK

Definition Enables / disables the link adaptation in RLC acknowledged mode.

Coding rules 0: Disable; 1: Enable

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules If EN_STREAMING = 1 then it is recommended to setEN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK to "TRUE" in order to activate the linkadaptation mechanism so that the (M)CS can reach a suitable levelregarding the level of the configured Rmin_(E)GPRS. Otherwise,the streaming PFCs can be downgraded to the Default Best EffortABQP because the negotiated GBR cannot be reached on the radiointerface.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Cnct Ctrl 1/2

External Comment This parameter applies to both GPRS and EGPRS TBFs.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

848 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 849: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.68 (EN_CS_ADAPTATION_NACK) - (EN_CS_ADAPTATION_NACK)

HMI Name EN_CS_ADAPTATION_NACKParameter Name

Logical Name EN_CS_ADAPTATION_NACK

Definition Enables / disables the link adaptation in RLC unacknowledged

Coding rules 0: Disable; 1: Enable

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Cnct Ctrl 1/2

External Comment This parameter applies to both GPRS and EGPRS TBFs.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 849 / 1176

Page 850: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.69 (EN_DL_LLC_PDU_REROUTING) -(EN_DL_LLC_PDU_REROUTING)

HMI Name EN_DL_LLC_PDU_REROUTINGParameter Name

Logical Name EN_DL_LLC_PDU_REROUTING

Definition This flag enables / disables rerouting of DL LLC PDUs.

Coding rules 0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment This parameter locks only the rerouting part of the feature. It hasno effect on the securisation part. This parameter applies to both,intra-NSE and inter-NSE cell change.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

850 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 851: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.70 (EN_EGPRS) - (EN_EGPRS)

HMI Name EN_EGPRSParameter Name

Logical Name EN_EGPRS

Definition Enables/Disables EGPRS traffic in the cell.

Coding rules 0: Disable, 1: Enable

Mandatory rules EN_EGPRS = enable only if MAX_PDCH > 0.

Recommended rules If EN_EGPRS is set to enable, Alcatel recommend to set theparameter PS_PREF_BCCH_TRX to 0.In case of extended cell,Alcatel recommend to set the same value in both, inner and outer,cells.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment From system point of view, when EN_EGPRS = Enable, the highestMCS allowed on the TRX is defined by the current size of theM-EGCH link of the TRX and by the MAX_EGPRS_MCS value.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 851 / 1176

Page 852: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.71 (EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF) - (EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF)

HMI Name EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBFParameter Name

Logical Name EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF

Definition Flag to disable/enable the extended TBF mode feature on the uplink(without or with allowing the MS not to answer to a USF receivedwhile in Extended UL TBF mode).

Coding rules 0: Extended UL TBF mode (EUTM) is not used1: EUTM is used2:I-EUTM is used (improved EUTM mode)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules -It is recommended not to activate simultaneously extended UL TBFfeature (EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF) and the DL PDU rerouting feature(EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTING)- if EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF isenabled and if RA capability update is supported by SGSN, then theparameter EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE must be enabled.The ExtendedUL TBF mode feature is completely effective only if the parameterEN_RA_CAP_UPDATE is set to enabled.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment I-EUTM (improved EUTM) allow MS in EUTM mode to not answer toa USF

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

852 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 853: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.72 (EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS) -(EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS)

HMI Name EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESSParameter Name

Logical Name EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS

Definition This flag indicates whether or not one Slave PDCH is available for(E)GPRS traffic in the cell (fast initial PS access feature).- In a NonEvolium BTS, that corresponds to an established PDCH being ableto support incoming (E)GPRS traffic. - In an Evolium BTS, thatcorresponds to a PDCH being able to support incoming (E)GPRStraffic, that PDCH being located on an established TRX (i.e. the TRXowns an M-EGCH link)

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules MIN_PDCH > NB_TS_MPDCH ifEN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = enabled; MIN_PDCH >=NB_TS_MPDCH if EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = disabled.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Res. Ctrl

External Comment Better performances for service access time will be obtained whenthis parameter is set to enabled, but one PDCH will always beestablished in the cell. A compromise has to be made by the operatorbetween performance gain and the cost of radio and terrestrialresources. This compromise becomes of higher importance incase of a cell connected through a satellite link due to the higherGPRS access time with satellite links, but also the higher cost oftransmission links.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 853 / 1176

Page 854: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.73 (EN_FAST_USF_UL_EXTENDED) -(EN_FAST_USF_UL_EXTENDED)

HMI Name EN_FAST_USF_UL_EXTENDEDParameter Name

Logical Name EN_FAST_USF_UL_EXTENDED

Definition Flag to disable/enable the fast scheduling mode for the uplink TBFs.

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The parameter is significant only if EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBFis enabled.The fast scheduling policy is controlled by theT_EXTENDED_UL_TBF_FAST_POL parameter.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

854 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 855: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.74 (EN_FULL_IR_DL) - (EN_FULL_IR_DL_per_cell)

HMI Name EN_FULL_IR_DLParameter Name

Logical Name EN_FULL_IR_DL_per_cell

Definition Enables/Disables the resegmentation for the downlink TBF in the cell.

Coding rules 0: Disable the "full" IR, so : Incremental Redundancy withresegmentation allowed in DL, 1: Enable the "full" IR, so, IncrementalRedundancy without resegmentation in DL

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules To allow the best throughput in DL, it is strongly recommended to setthis parameter to 0 i.e. to not forbid the resegmentation.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 855 / 1176

Page 856: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.75 (EN_MULTISLOT_CLASS_30_33) -(EN_MULTISLOT_CLASS_30_33)

HMI Name EN_MULTISLOT_CLASS_30_33Parameter Name

Logical Name EN_MULTISLOT_CLASS_30_33

Definition Enables the support of (E)GPRS multislot class 30-33.

Coding rules 0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Support of DTM (E)GPRS multislot classes 31 to 33 is possible onlyif EN_DTM = 1 and EN_MULTISLOT_CLASS_30_33 = 1. Supportof configurations requiring EDA is possible only if EN_EDA = 1 (andALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATION = 1 in case of DTM).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

856 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 857: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.76 (EN_NACC) - (EN_NACC)

HMI Name EN_NACCParameter Name

Logical Name EN_NACC

Definition Enables the Network Assisted Cell Change feature.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1:enabled

Mandatory rules Can be enabled only if round_trip_delay < 500 msecWhen cell_type= "extended inner" or "extended outer", then EN_NACC = 0

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 857 / 1176

Page 858: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.77 (EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR) - (EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR)

HMI Name EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIRParameter Name

Logical Name EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR

Definition Indicates whether or not outgoing GPRS redirections aresystematically triggered from the serving cell.

Coding rules 0: Outgoing GPRS redirections are not triggered1: Outgoing GPRSredirections are systematically triggered

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematicallytriggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it is up tothe operator to ensure that at least one NC cell reselection causeis always triggered upon receipt of the first Packet MeasurementReport message. For instance, NC cell reselection Cause PT1 canbe always activated by setting NC_DL_RXLEV_THR to -47 dBm(Always).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access ???

External Comment An outgoing GPRS redirection is a NC cell reselection which istriggered when the MS enters the packet transfer mode in the servingcell even if the radio link is good. The intention of GPRS redirectionsis to redirect the MS towards a target cell more appropriate to carryPS traffic (for instance a macro cell).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

858 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 859: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.78 (EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR(n)) -(EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR(n))

HMI Name EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR(n)Parameter Name

Logical Name EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR(n)

Definition Indicates whether or not outgoing GPRS redirections aresystematically triggered from the serving cell.

Coding rules 0: Disable Outgoing GPRS redirections are not triggered1: EnableOutgoing GPRS redirections are systematically triggered

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematicallytriggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it is up tothe operator to ensure that at least one NC cell reselection causeis always triggered upon receipt of the first Packet MeasurementReport message. For instance, NC cell reselection Cause PT1 canbe always activated by setting NC_DL_RXLEV_THR to -47 dBm(Always).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access ???

External Comment An outgoing GPRS redirection is a NC cell reselection which istriggered when the MS enters the packet transfer mode in the servingcell even if the radio link is good. The intention of GPRS redirectionsis to redirect the MS towards a target cell more appropriate to carryPS traffic (for instance a macro cell).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 859 / 1176

Page 860: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.79 (EN_PFC_FEATURE) - (EN_PFC_FEATURE)

HMI Name EN_PFC_FEATUREParameter Name

Logical Name EN_PFC_FEATURE

Definition Enables/disables the support of the PFC negotiation feature.

Coding rules 1 => PFC feature is supported, 0 => PFC feature is not supported

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Any modification of the parameter leads the MFS to resetautonomously all the GPUs connected to this BSS.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

860 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 861: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.80 (EN_PSI_STATUS) - (EN_PSI_STATUS)

HMI Name EN_PSI_STATUSParameter Name

Logical Name EN_PSI_STATUS

Definition Enables the Packet SI Status feature in cells w/o PBCCH or thePacket PSI Status feature in cells with a PBCCH.

Coding rules 0: disabled; 1:enabled

Mandatory rules Can be enabled only if round_trip_delay < 500 msecWhen cell_type= "extended inner" or "extended outer", then EN_PSI_STATUS = 0

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 861 / 1176

Page 862: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.81 (EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE) - (EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE)

HMI Name EN_RA_CAP_UPDATEParameter Name

Logical Name EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE

Definition Flag to enable/disable the Radio Acces Capability update on Gb

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules This parameter must be enabled if RA capability update issupported by SGSN and if it exists, at least, one cell whereEN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF is enabled.The Extended UL TBFmode feature is completely effective only if the parameterEN_RA_CAP_UPDATE is set to enabled.If EN_STREAMING is setto 1 then EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE must also be set to 1 (enabled).Otherwise the BSS will not be able to handle streaming flow. Ifthis rule is not respected then all PFC creation requests related toa streaming flow will be downgraded to the default best effort flowby the BSS.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

862 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 863: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.82 (EN_STREAMING) - (EN_STREAMING)

HMI Name EN_STREAMINGParameter Name

Logical Name EN_STREAMING

Definition Enables/disables the support of the STREAMING flows.

Coding rules 1 => the cell supports the streaming flows in addition to the non realtime flows (best effort, interactive, background) if EN_PFC_FEATURE= 1 and if the PFC feature negotiation with the SGSN is successful0=> the cell supports the non real time flows (best effort, interactive,background) if EN_PFC_FEATURE = 1 and if the PFC featurenegotiation with the SGSN is successful

Mandatory rules - Can be enabled only if the BTS Generation = Evolium- IfEN_STREAMING = 1 then MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD > 0-When cell_type = "extended inner" or "extended outer", thenEN_STREAMING = 0

Recommended rules 1) If this parameter is set to 1 then the parameterEN_RA_CAP_UPDATE must also be set to 1 (enabled). Otherwisethe BSS will not be able to handle streaming flow. If this rule is notrespected then all PFC creation requests related to a streaming flowwill be downgraded to the default best effort flow by the BSS.2) theparameter EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK must also set to "TRUE" inorder to activate the link adaptation mechanism so that the (M)CScan reach a suitable level regarding the level of the configuredRmin_(E)GPRS. Otherwise, the streaming PFCs can be downgradedto the Default Best Effort ABQP because the negotiated GBR cannotbe reached on the radio interface.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 863 / 1176

Page 864: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.83 (Excess Burst Size) - (EBS)

HMI Name Excess Burst SizeParameter Name

Logical Name EBS

Definition Excess Burst Size.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules CIR=0 <=> CBS=0 => EBS > 0CIR <= NIR <= CIR x (1 + EBS/CBS)<= ACCESS RATE BC

Recommended rules EBS=FR_CAPACITY(expressed in kbit/s) / 8, if CIR=0

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance PVC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

kbyte 0 248 None

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Create NS-VC

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

864 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 865: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.84 (GAMMA_TNx) - (GAMMA_TNx)

HMI Name GAMMA_TNxParameter Name

Logical Name GAMMA_TNx

Definition Binary representation of the "gamma ch" for MS output power control.

Coding rules Coded on 5 bits, step size=2dB, with 00000 == 0 dB, 00001 == 2dB, ... 11111 == 62 dB.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 62 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Ctrl

External Comment In the context of a concentric cell, the parameter applies to the outerzone.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 865 / 1176

Page 866: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.85 (Gb_Configuration_Type) - (Gb_Configuration_type)

HMI Name Gb_Configuration_TypeParameter Name

Logical Name Gb_Configuration_type

Definition Configuration type used with Gb over IP

Coding rules 0 : Static configuration 1: Dynamic configurationdefault value : 0

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance NSE

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Gb_Configuration type is significant only when Gb_Transport modeis IP.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

866 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 867: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.86 (Gb_Transport_Mode) - (Gb_Transport_Mode)

HMI Name Gb_Transport_ModeParameter Name

Logical Name Gb_Transport_Mode

Definition Mode of the transport for Gb interface: FR or IP.

Coding rules 0: FR mode1: IP mode

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment When the NSE is not associated to a BSS, theGb_Transport_Mode_perNSE defines the transport modeof the NSE.When the NSE is associated to a BSS, the transportmode of the BSS defines the transport mode of all NSEs of the BSS(the Gb_Transport_Mode - of the BSS - overrides the transport modedefined in the NSE instance).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 867 / 1176

Page 868: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.87 (Gb_Transport_Mode_per_NSE) - (Gb_Transport_Mode_per_NSE)

HMI Name Gb_Transport_Mode_per_NSEParameter Name

Logical Name Gb_Transport_Mode_per_NSE

Definition Mode of the transport for Gb interface (per NSE): FR or IP.

Coding rules 0: FR mode1: IP mode

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance NSE

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment When the NSE is not associated to a BSS, theGb_Transport_Mode_perNSE defines the transport modeof the NSE.When the NSE is associated to a BSS, the transportmode of the BSS defines the transport mode of all NSEs of the BSS(the Gb_Transport_Mode - of the BSS - overrides the transport modedefined in the NSE instance).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

868 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 869: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.88 (GCH_RED_FACTOR_HiAter) -(GCH_RED_FACTOR_High_Ater_Usage)

HMI Name GCH_RED_FACTOR_HiAterParameter Name

Logical Name GCH_RED_FACTOR_High_Ater_Usage

Definition Reduction factor of the number of GCHs targeted per PDCH, whenthe Ater usage is "high".

Coding rules step size = 0.01

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules A low value of GCH_RED_Factor_High_Ater_Usage can becoherent with a high value of Ater_Usage_Threshold (it will avoidreaching the saturation point of 100% of the Ater resources usedat the same moment in the GPU).Reciprocally, a high value ofGCH_RED_Factor_High_Ater_Usage can be coherent with a lowvalue of Ater_Usage_Threshold (it will limit the risks of wasting, i.e.of not using, Ater resources in the GPU).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 1 0.75

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The GCH reduction factor applies to the new PDCHs which areused when the Ater usage is "high" (see the Ater_Usage_Thresholdparameter). This parameter can be reduced in order to avoid Atershortage situations.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 869 / 1176

Page 870: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.89 (GPRS_CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS) -(GPRS_CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS)

HMI Name GPRS_CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESISParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS

Definition Additional hysteresis which applies in Ready state for cells in sameRA.

Coding rules step size = 2dB; coded on 3 bits. 000=0 dB, 001= 2 dB, 111=14 dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 14 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

870 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 871: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.90 (GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) - (GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH)

HMI Name GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCHParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH

Definition Maximum TX power level an MS may use when accessing thesystem.

Coding rules Coded on 5 bits from 0 to 31The coding depends on the BCCHfrequency band:P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39dBm, 2: 39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800coding:step size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900coding: range 0 to 15, 30, 31; 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm, 0: 30 dBm,1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm 5 43 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment The default value depends on the BCCH frequency band:Defaultvalue for P-GSM/G1: 43 dBmDefault value for GSM850: 39dBmDefault value for DCS1800: 30 dBmDefault value for DCS1900:30 dBm

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 871 / 1176

Page 872: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.91 (GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) -(GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n))

HMI Name GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCHParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n)

Definition Maximum TX power level an MS may use when accessing thesystem.

Coding rules Coded on 5 bits from 0 to 31The coding depends on the BCCHfrequency band:P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1:39 dBm, 2: 39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm, 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800coding:step size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900coding: range 0 to 15, 30, 31; 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm, 0: 30 dBm,1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm 5 43 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit External Cell / Packet

External Comment The default value depends on the BCCH frequency band:Defaultvalue for P-GSM/G1: 43 dBmDefault value for GSM850: 39dBmDefault value for DCS1800: 30 dBmDefault value for DCS1900:30 dBm

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

872 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 873: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.92 (GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE) -(GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE)

HMI Name GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUEParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE

Definition Default value of the (E)GPRS multislot class assumed at TBFestablishment when the actual MS (E)GPRS multislot class isunknown.- In an Evolium BTS : The default MS class is used as aninput of the best candidate TBF allocation computation processwhen the MS class is not known on UL TBF establishment- In a NonEvolium BTS : The default MS class is used as an input of the bestcandidate TBF allocation computation process when the MS classis not known on UL TBF establishment.In the PDCH anticipationprocess on UL TBF establishment : the default MS class is used todetermine how many PDCHs are established in advance to anticipatethe concurrent DL TBF establishment.

Coding rules Only the following GPRS multislot class defined in 3GPP TS 05.02annex B are allowed: 1: GPRS multislot class 1 (1+1 MS);2: GPRSmultislot class 2 (2+1 MS);4: GPRS multislot class 4 (3+1 MS);8:GPRS multislot class 8 (4+1 MS).30: GPRS multislot class 30 (5+1MS).

Mandatory rules –

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 873 / 1176

Page 874: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

Recommended rules The recommendations to set this parameter are the following:1)Case where there are only Evolium BTSs in the BSS:1.1) Incase the PS traffic is mainly signalling (e.g. there is a greatproportion of RA Updates among the UL TBF establishmentrequests), GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE shall beset to 1 (optimization of the number of T2 TBF reallocationsand of PPC / DSP CPU). 1.2) In case the PS traffic is mainlydata (high proportion of UL TBF establishment requests for datatraffic), GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE should be setto the most common multislot class which can be found amongthe mobile stations within the BSS (in order to limit the numberof T2 TBF reallocations and of PPC / DSP CPU, triggered withthe establishment of the concurrent DL TBF). In case of multislotclass 30, this additionally requires that the multislot class 30-33feature is widely activated in the BSS.2) Case where there aresome DRFU BTSs in the BSS (together with some Evolium BTSsor not):2.1) In DRFU BTSs, the impacts of this parameter value onT2 TBF reallocations are the same as in Evolium BTSs, so 1.1)and 1.2) recommendations are applicable in order to avoid useless/ to limit the number of T2 TBF reallocations .2.2) On the otherhand, in DRFU BTSs, in case the PS traffic is mainly signalling(e.g. there is a great proportion of RA Updates among the UL TBFestablishment requests) and in case of low number of Ater resources(risk of Ater congestion in some GPUs), it is recommended toset GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE to 1. Indeed, anAter congestion may be encountered because some transmissionresources (PDCHs) are established in advance by RRM based onthe value of GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE (PDCHanticipation process). Once the traffic type is confirmed signalling,these resources (PDCHs) are released, but at T_GCH_Inactivitytimer expiry. As a consequence, the transmission resources (PDCHs)can be established even if they are not used during several seconds,which can generate an Ater congestion in some GPUs.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 30 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / General

874 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 875: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment The entered value is assumed by default at uplink TBF establishmentwhen the actual MS multislot class is unknown (e.g. RACHone phase access on CCCH) . Otherwise, the multislot classreceived in the request for uplink TBF establishment is takeninto account.In case the traffic is mainly signalling (majority ofRA Updates), Ater congestion may be encountered because thetransmission resources are allocated in advance, based on the valueof GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE parameter. Indeed,once the traffic type is confirmed signalling, these resources arede-allocated, but only at T_PDCH_Inactivity timer expiry. As aconsequence, in this case, the transmission resources are allocatedeven if they are not used during several seconds. Therefore it isadvised to reduce the value of the default multislot class to 1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 875 / 1176

Page 876: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.93 (GPRS_PENALTY_TIME) - (GPRS_PENALTY_TIME(n))

HMI Name GPRS_PENALTY_TIMEParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_PENALTY_TIME(n)

Definition Time during which GPRS_TEMPORARY_OFFSET is active inneighbour cells.

Coding rules step size = 10 sec, coded on 5 bits (00000 = 10 sec, 11111 = 320 sec)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 10 320 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

876 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 877: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.94 (GPRS_RESELECTION_OFFSET) -(GPRS_RESELECTION_OFFSET(n))

HMI Name GPRS_RESELECTION_OFFSETParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_RESELECTION_OFFSET(n)

Definition Permanent offset for GPRS cell reselection in neighbour cells.

Coding rules coded on 5 bits (00000 = -52 dB, 11111 = 48 dB)00000= -52; 00001=-48; 00010= -44; 00011= -40; 00100= -36; 00101= -32; 00110= -28;00111= -24; 01000= -20; 01001= -16; 01010= -12; 01011= -10;01100= - 8; 01101= - 6; 01110= - 4; 01111= - 2; 10000= 0; 10001= 2;10010= 4; 10011= 6; 10100= 8; 10101=10; 10110= 12; 10111= 16;11000= 20; 11001= 24; 11010= 28; 11011= 32; 11100= 36; 11101=40; 11110= 44; 11111= 48

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -52 48 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 877 / 1176

Page 878: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.95 (GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN)

HMI Name GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MINParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN

Definition Minimum received level at the MS required for access to the system.

Coding rules step size = 1 dBm, coded on 6 bits (000000 = -110 dBm, 111111= -47 dBm)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2 (+ Edit Cell / GPRS / MasterChannel 2/2)

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

878 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 879: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.96 (GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n))

HMI Name GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MINParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)

Definition Minimum received level at the MS required for access to the systemin neighbour cells.

Coding rules coded on 6 bits, 0=-110 dBm, 63=-47 dBm, step size=1dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 879 / 1176

Page 880: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.97 (GPRS_TEMPORARY_OFFSET) -(GPRS_TEMPORARY_OFFSET(n))

HMI Name GPRS_TEMPORARY_OFFSETParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_TEMPORARY_OFFSET(n)

Definition Negative offset used for MS cell reselection process in neighbourcells.

Coding rules Possible values : 0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, infinity respectively binarycoded as 000, 001, , 111

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 infinity 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

880 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 881: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.98 (GPU_Gb_Base_IP) - (GPU_Gb_Base_IP)

HMI Name GPU_Gb_Base_IPParameter Name

Logical Name GPU_Gb_Base_IP

Definition Base address of the local IP address used to define theGb_IP_Address of each GPU.

Coding rules coded on 32 bitscoded as follow in 4 groups of 8bits:255.255.255.000The last group is set to 000 (base address)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 4294967295 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Base address used to define the GPU_Local_IP_Endpoint

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 881 / 1176

Page 882: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.99 (GPU_Gb_Base_UDP) - (GPU_Gb_Base_UDP)

HMI Name GPU_Gb_Base_UDPParameter Name

Logical Name GPU_Gb_Base_UDP

Definition UDP port number of the GPU board for Gb over IP interface.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 63488 64512 64512

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment used to define the UDP port of each GPU boards

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

882 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 883: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.100 (GPU_Gb_IP_Address) - (GPU_Gb_IP_Address)

HMI Name GPU_Gb_IP_AddressParameter Name

Logical Name GPU_Gb_IP_Address

Definition Allows to display the IP address used by a GPU board in a NSEinstance (used for Gb over IP)

Coding rules coded on 32 bitsOMC must display the value of each octet followingthe format: www.xxx.yyy.zzzdefault value : 0.0.0.0

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance GPU

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 4294967295 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Calculated by the MFS from the GPU_Gb_Base_IP value.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 883 / 1176

Page 884: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.101 (GPU_Gb_UDP_Port) - (GPU_Gb_UDP_Port)

HMI Name GPU_Gb_UDP_PortParameter Name

Logical Name GPU_Gb_UDP_Port

Definition UDP port number of the GPU board in the NSE instance (used forGb over IP).

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance GPU

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 63488 64512 64512

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment equal to GPU_Gb_base_UDP.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

884 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 885: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.102 (HCS_THR) - (GPRS_HCS_THR)

HMI Name HCS_THRParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_HCS_THR

Definition HCS signal strength.

Coding rules Coded on 5 bits. 00000=-110 dBm, 00001=-108 dBm, 11111=-48dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -48 -84

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 885 / 1176

Page 886: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.103 (HCS_THR) - (GPRS_HCS_THR(n))

HMI Name HCS_THRParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_HCS_THR(n)

Definition HCS signal strength.

Coding rules Coded on 5 bits. 00000=-110 dBm, 00001=-108 dBm, 11111=-48dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -48 -84

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

886 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 887: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.104 (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY) -(HIGH_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY)

HMI Name HIGH_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name HIGH_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Background Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'high'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 887 / 1176

Page 888: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.105 (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY) -(HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY)

HMI Name HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP1 Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'high'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

888 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 889: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.106 (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY) -(HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY)

HMI Name HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP2 Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'high'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 9

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 889 / 1176

Page 890: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.107 (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY) -(HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY)

HMI Name HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP3 Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'high'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

890 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 891: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.108 (HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD_GPRS) - (HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD_GPRS)

HMI Name HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD_GPRSParameter Name

Logical Name HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD_GPRS

Definition Load threshold used to determine a certain margin of radio timeslotsreserved for CS traffic between two sending of the BSCGP RRAllocation Indication messages. The threshold is expressed inpercentage of the radio timeslots available in the cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 90

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment The margin of radio timeslots reserved for CS traffic can be computedas follows:(100 - HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD_GPRS)/100*NB_TSwhereNB_TS is the number of radio timeslots available in the cell.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent

t01 t02 t03 t04 t05 t06 t07 t08 t09 t010 t011 t012

70 70 70 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 891 / 1176

Page 892: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.109 (IPGB_SUBNET_MASK_MFS) - (IPGB_SUBNET_MASK_MFS)

HMI Name IPGB_SUBNET_MASK_MFSParameter Name

Logical Name IPGB_SUBNET_MASK_MFS

Definition Mask of the subnet where is allocated the range of MFS addressesused forGb telecom protocols

Coding rules coded on 32 bitscoded as follow in 4 groups of 8bits:255.255.255.255default value : 0.0.0.0

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 4294967295 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

892 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 893: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.110 (LAC) - (LAC (MFS))

HMI Name LACParameter Name

Logical Name LAC (MFS)

Definition Location Area Code.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual to LAC(BSC)A couple of mate extended cells (Extended inner + extendedouter) shall have the same LAC

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 65535 65535

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description ( + Edit External cell/ circuit1/2)

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 893 / 1176

Page 894: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.111 (LAC) - (LAC(n)(MFS))

HMI Name LACParameter Name

Logical Name LAC(n)(MFS)

Definition Location Area Code.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same time.Equal toLAC(n)(BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 65535 65535

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Adjacencies

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

894 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 895: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.112 (Level 1 down) - (PVC_Level1_down)

HMI Name Level 1 downParameter Name

Logical Name PVC_Level1_down

Definition This parameter gives the low level of threshold for congestion.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance PVC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 40

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access MFSUSM / GB Configuration / Create NSVC

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 895 / 1176

Page 896: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.113 (Level 1 Factor) - (PVC_Level1_Factor)

HMI Name Level 1 FactorParameter Name

Logical Name PVC_Level1_Factor

Definition This parameter is used to calculate the amount of data used forbuffering.

Coding rules step size = 0.01

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules amount of memory needed : PVC_Level1_factor * 10 * (CBS+EBS)for a PVC

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance PVC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.05 12.75 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access MFSUSM / GB Configuration / Create NSVC

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

896 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 897: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.114 (Level 1 up) - (PVC_Level1_up)

HMI Name Level 1 upParameter Name

Logical Name PVC_Level1_up

Definition This parameter gives the high level of threshold for congestion.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance PVC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 70

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access MFSUSM / GB Configuration / Create NSVC

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 897 / 1176

Page 898: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.115 (LOAD_EV_PERIOD_GPRS) - (LOAD_EV_PERIOD_GPRS)

HMI Name LOAD_EV_PERIOD_GPRSParameter Name

Logical Name LOAD_EV_PERIOD_GPRS

Definition Number of load samples (calculated every TCH_INFO_PERIODseconds) used to compute the maximum number of slave PDCHsthat the BSC can allocate to the MFS.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 3 30 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Resource Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

898 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 899: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.116 (LOW_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY) -(LOW_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY)

HMI Name LOW_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name LOW_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Background Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'low'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 899 / 1176

Page 900: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.117 (LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY) -(LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY)

HMI Name LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP1 Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'low'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

900 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 901: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.118 (LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY) -(LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY)

HMI Name LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP2 Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'low'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 9

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 901 / 1176

Page 902: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.119 (LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY) -(LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY)

HMI Name LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP3 Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'low'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

902 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 903: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.120 (MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCH) - (MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCH)

HMI Name MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCHParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCH

Definition Indicative value of the maximum number of DownLink (E)GPRSTBFs per Slave PDCH.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 10 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment When allocating a DL GPRS TBF: MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCH isthe maximum number of GPRS + EGPRS TBFs allowed inDL on each Slave PDCH. When allocating a DL EGPRS TBF:MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCH is the maximum number of EGPRS TBFsallowed in DL on each Slave PDCH (regardless of the current numberof DL GPRS TBFs).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 903 / 1176

Page 904: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.121 (MAX_EGPRS_MCS) - (MAX_EGPRS_MCS)

HMI Name MAX_EGPRS_MCSParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_EGPRS_MCS

Definition Maximum Modulation and Coding Scheme used for EGPRS trafficin the cell.

Coding rules 0: MCS-1; 1: MCS-2; 2: MCS-3; 3: MCS-4;4: MCS-5; 5: MCS-6;6:MCS-7; 7: MCS-8;8: MCS-9;

Mandatory rules MAX_EGPRS_MCS >= TBF_DL_INIT_MCSMAX_EGPRS_MCS>= TBF_UL_INIT_MCSWhen cell_type = "extended outer", thenMAX_EGPRS_MCS <= MCS-4

Recommended rules R_AVERAGE_EGPRS shall not be set to a bitrate higher thanthe useful bitrate corresponding to MAX_EGPRS_MCS (e.g. ifMAX_EGPRS_MCS = MCS9 => R_AVERAGE_EGPRS shallnot be higher than 59,2kbps).R_MIN_EGPRS shall not beset to a bitrate higher than the useful bitrate corresponding toMax_EGPRS_MCS. If the above recommended rule is not fulfilled,then some RT PFCs can be accepted by the BSS whereas itwill not be possible to handle their associated GBR. This mayresult in RT PFC downgrades to Best Effort.It is advised to setMAX_EGPRS_MCS to a value different from MCS-2 to copewith MEGCH control message granularity in an optimal way.Forconsistency reasons, MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL andMAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL shall NOT be higher thanany of the MAX_EGPRS_MCS values defined in the cells of the MFS(this could otherwise induce some abnormal TBF releases or otherundesirable effects on the PS QoS).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 9 9

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

904 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 905: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.122 (MAX_GPRS_CS) - (MAX_GPRS_CS)

HMI Name MAX_GPRS_CSParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_GPRS_CS

Definition Maximum coding scheme used for GPRS traffic in the cell.

Coding rules 1 : CS-2; 2 : CS-3; 3 : CS-4

Mandatory rules MAX_GPRS_CS >= TBF_DL_INIT_CSMAX_GPRS_CS >=TBF_UL_INIT_CSIf Max_PDCH = 0 then MAX_GPRS_CS =CS-2.The aim of this last rule is to prevent the BSC to triggeruselessly the algorithms of adjust ranking and transmission pool setup (lead time and outage) for CS3 and CS4, in case Max_PDCH= 0 (i.e. GPRS is not allowed)

Recommended rules R_AVERAGE_GPRS shall not be set to a bitrate higher thanthe useful bitrate corresponding to MAX_GPRS_CS (e.g. ifMAX_GPRS_CS = CS2 => R_AVERAGE_GPRS shall not be higherthan 12kbps)R_MIN_GPRS shall not be set to a bitrate higher thanthe useful bitrate corresponding to Max_GPRS_CS. If the aboverecommended rule is not fulfilled, then some RT PFCs can beaccepted by the BSS whereas it will not be possible to handle theirassociated GBR. This may result in RT PFC downgrades to BestEffort.For consistency reasons, MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DLand MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL shall NOT be higher thanany of the MAX_GPRS_CS values defined in the cells of the MFS(this could otherwise induce some abnormal TBF releases or otherundesirable effects on the PS QoS).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 2 4 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 905 / 1176

Page 906: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.123 (MAX_PAGING_QUEUE) - (MAX_PAGING_QUEUE)

HMI Name MAX_PAGING_QUEUEParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_PAGING_QUEUE

Definition Maximum number of CS+PS paging messages stored in GPU.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules Paging Rate = 100 paging/s AND Queueing Time = 5s

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 50 1000 500

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / General

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

906 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 907: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.124 (MAX_PDCH) - (MAX_PDCH (MFS))Management of

Enable_GPRS Flag (Cell

Parameter)

This flag exists in the BSC and is managed by the OMC-R but it is not visibleto the operator. It is derived by the OMC-R from the value of Max_PDCH.When the Enable_GPRS flag is set to true, it means that the BSC can acceptMFS requests for a certain cell. In some circumstances, there can be someinconsistencies, but these might not have any impact:

Creation of a BSC When the BSS is discovered by the OMC-R, the MFS parameters are set totheir default value by the OMC-R. Max_PDCH is set to 0. (There may beinconsistency at system level, but no impact.) Later, if the operator installsGPRS, he has to download the radio configuration to the MFS. Through thisoperation, the flag ’Enable_GPRS’ is recomputed for the cells concerned bythe PRC, and therefore downloaded to the BSC. All data is then in line forthe cells concerned by the PRC. It can occur that some cells remain with’Enable_GPRS’ set to true and Max_PDCH set to 0 but this does no harm at all(no impact on the traffic, and not visible by the operator).

DLS Restore When the

Flag is Not In Lline With

Max_PDCH

Any DLS restore must be followed by the following procedure to line-up theEN_GPRS of the cells handled by this BSC with the Max_PDCH of thesecells currently stored in the OMC-R:

1. Copy the SC into the PRC

2. Activate this PRC

Until the synchronization is achieved, the cell cannot be set into service forGPRS by the telecom application (there is no impact if the cell is alreadystarted for GPRS).

HMI Name MAX_PDCHParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_PDCH (MFS)

Definition Maximum number of slave and master PDCHs that can be allocatedto the MFS in the cell.

Coding rules –

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 907 / 1176

Page 908: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

Mandatory rules Max_PDCH >= MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD;If MAX_PDCH > 0then EN_GPRS = TRUE ; If MAX_PDCH = 0 then EN_GPRS =FALSE;If MAX_PDCH = 0 then EN_EGPRS = FALSE;If EN_VGCS=enabled, then "(MAX_VGCS_TS + MAX_PDCH) < Total numberof TCHs of the cell"If Max_PDCH = 0 then MAX_GPRS_CS =CS-2.The aim of this rule is to prevent the BSC to trigger uselesslythe algorithms of adjust ranking and transmission pool set up(lead time and outage) for CS3 and CS4, in case Max_PDCH =0 (i.e. GPRS is not allowed)MAX_PDCH shall be set so that atleast one slave PDCH can be allocated to the MFS to serve DLor UL TBFs. This means that MAX_PDCH > NB_TS_MPDCH ifEN_GPRS = TRUE.When Max_PDCH > 0 and cell_type = "extendedinner" or "extended outer", then MAX_PDCH shall be an evennumber.The following conditions are verified by the OMC-R in orderto check the upper limit of MAX_PDCH:i) MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nbof TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 1 if TRX_PREF_MARK= 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "1: CCCH combined"ii)MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 2if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF ="0: CCCH not combined"iii) MAX_PDCH <= NB_TS_MPDCH +8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) if TRX_PREF_MARK<> 0 on BCCH TRXiv) MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs withTRX_PREF_MARK=0) - 3 if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRXand CCCH_CONF = 2

Recommended rules In a micro cell, the operator may be interested to force theMS to reselect a macro cell by a correct setting of the cellreselection parameters broadcast on PBCCH (without using NC cellreselections, i.e. when EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR is set to0 and NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to NC0 in the microcell). In this case, the following configuration is recommended:NB_TS_MPDCH = 1, MAX_PDCH = 2, MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD =1, MIN_PDCH = 1.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 127 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Resource Control

External Comment 127 is a theoretical value : 16 TRX * 8 PDCH - BCCH.To supportLCS in a cell, it is mandatory to have Max_PDCH > 0

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

908 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 909: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.125 (MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD) - (MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD (MFS))

HMI Name MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOADParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD (MFS)

Definition Maximum number of slave and master PDCHs that can be allocatedto the MFS when the CS traffic is high.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules - MAX_PDCH >= MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD-MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD >= MIN_PDCH- If EN_DTM = 1 thenMAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD > 1

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 127 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Resource Control

External Comment 127 is a theoretical value: 16 TRX * 8 PDCH - BCCH.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 909 / 1176

Page 910: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.126 (MAX_PDCH_PER_TBF) - (MAX_PDCH_PER_TBF)

HMI Name MAX_PDCH_PER_TBFParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_PDCH_PER_TBF

Definition Maximum number of PDCHs allocated to a single (E)GPRSconnection.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 5 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Resource Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

910 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 911: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.127 (MAX_RETRANS) - (Max_retrans (MFS))

HMI Name MAX_RETRANSParameter Name

Logical Name Max_retrans (MFS)

Definition Maximum number of CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissions bythe MS on the RACH, broadcast on the PBCCH for CS serviceestablishment.

Coding rules Possible values are:1, 2 ,4 and 7 respectively binary coded:00, 01,10 and 11

Mandatory rules Max_retrans (BSC) = Max_retrans (MFS) for a given cell

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 7 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment The bigger this parameter is, the lesser the MS power consumptionis.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 911 / 1176

Page 912: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.128 (MAX_RETRANS_1) - (MAX_RETRANS_1)

HMI Name MAX_RETRANS_1Parameter Name

Logical Name MAX_RETRANS_1

Definition Maximum number of PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissionsby the MS on the PRACH with priority level 1.

Coding rules Possible values are : 1, 2, 4, 7 respectively binary coded : 00, 01,10, 11

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 7 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

912 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 913: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.129 (MAX_RETRANS_2) - (MAX_RETRANS_2)

HMI Name MAX_RETRANS_2Parameter Name

Logical Name MAX_RETRANS_2

Definition Maximum number of PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissionsby the MS on the PRACH with priority level 2.

Coding rules Possible values are : 1, 2, 4, 7 respectively binary coded : 00, 01,10, 11

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 7 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 913 / 1176

Page 914: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.130 (MAX_RETRANS_3) - (MAX_RETRANS_3)

HMI Name MAX_RETRANS_3Parameter Name

Logical Name MAX_RETRANS_3

Definition Maximum number of PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissionsby the MS on the PRACH with priority level 3.

Coding rules Possible values are : 1, 2, 4, 7 respectively binary coded : 00, 01,10, 11

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 7 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

914 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 915: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.131 (MAX_RETRANS_4) - (MAX_RETRANS_4)

HMI Name MAX_RETRANS_4Parameter Name

Logical Name MAX_RETRANS_4

Definition Maximum number of PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissionsby the MS on the PRACH with priority level 4.

Coding rules Possible values are : 1, 2, 4, 7 respectively binary coded : 00, 01,10, 11

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 7 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 915 / 1176

Page 916: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.132 (MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCH) - (MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCH)

HMI Name MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCHParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCH

Definition Indicative value of maximum number of UpLink (E)GPRS TBFs perslave PDCH.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 6 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment When allocating an UL GPRS TBF: MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCH isthe maximum number of GPRS + EGPRS TBFs allowed in ULon each Slave PDCH. When allocating an UL EGPRS TBF:MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCH is the maximum number of EGPRS TBFsallowed in UL on each Slave PDCH (regardless of the current numberof UL GPRS TBFs).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

916 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 917: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.133 (MIN_PDCH) - (MIN_PDCH (MFS))

HMI Name MIN_PDCHParameter Name

Logical Name MIN_PDCH (MFS)

Definition Minimum number of master and slave PDCHs that are alwaysallocated to the MFS.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules -MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD >= MIN_PDCH;-MIN_PDCH> NB_TS_MPDCH if EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS= enabled;-MIN_PDCH >= NB_TS_MPDCH ifEN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = disabled.-WhenMIN_PDCH > 0 and cell_type = "extended inner" or "extended outer",then MIN_PDCH shall be an even number

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter to a value smaller than themaximum number of PDCHs that may be allocated in the cell, inorder to avoid congestion on the MFS-BSC interface.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 127 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Resource Control

External Comment 127 is a theoretical value : 16 TRX * 8 PDCH - BCCH.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 917 / 1176

Page 918: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.134 (Mobile Country Code (MCC)) - (MCC (MFS))

HMI Name Mobile Country Code (MCC)Parameter Name

Logical Name MCC (MFS)

Definition Mobile Country Code of the own PLMN.

Coding rules 3 digits BCD

Mandatory rules The OMC-R shall ensure that the following rules are always fulfilled:-MCC (BSC) = MCC (MFS).- The cells belonging to the same BSCshall have the same (MCC,MNC) couple.- The (MCC,MNC) coupleof cells internal to the OMC-R shall be selected from the set of ownPLMNs.- The (MCC,MNC) couple of cells external to the OMC-R canbe selected from the set of own or foreign PLMNs.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 999 999

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Customer BUL file

External Comment The value depends on the configuration. The default value indicatedhere is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

918 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 919: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.135 (Mobile Network Code (MNC)) - (MNC (MFS))

HMI Name Mobile Network Code (MNC)Parameter Name

Logical Name MNC (MFS)

Definition Mobile Network Code of the own PLMN.

Coding rules 3 digits BCD

Mandatory rules The OMC-R shall ensure that the following rules are always fulfilled:-MNC (BSC) = MNC (MFS).- The cells belonging to the same BSCshall have the same (MCC,MNC) couple.- The (MCC,MNC) coupleof cells internal to the OMC-R shall be selected from the set of ownPLMNs.- The (MCC,MNC) couple of cells external to the OMC-R canbe selected from the set of own or foreign PLMNs.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 999 999

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Customer BUL file

External Comment The value depends on configuration. The default value indicatedhere is for implementation purposes.The operator is allowed toenter 2 or 3 digits MNC.MNC such as yz or Fyz correspond to a 2digits MNC (y, z = 0..9). (F binary coded 1111)MNC such as xyzcorrespond to a 3 digits MNC (x = 0..9).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 919 / 1176

Page 920: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.136 (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH (MFS))

HMI Name MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCHParameter Name

Logical Name MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH (MFS)

Definition Maximum transmission power an MS is allowed to use whenaccessing the cell until otherwise commanded, broadcast on PBCCHfor CS service establishment.

Coding rules P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:stepsize = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range0 to 15, 30, 31; 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm, 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm,..., 15: 0 dBm.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm 5 43 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment The default value depends on the BCCH frequency band:Defaultvalue for P-GSM/G1: 43 dBmDefault value for GSM850: 39dBmDefault value for DCS1800: 30 dBmDefault value for DCS1900:30 dBm

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

920 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 921: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.137 (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n)(MFS))

HMI Name MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCHParameter Name

Logical Name MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n)(MFS)

Definition Maximum transmission power an MS is allowed to use whenaccessing the cell until otherwise commanded, broadcast on PBCCHfor CS service establishment.

Coding rules P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:stepsize = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range0 to 15, 30, 31; 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm, 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm,..., 15: 0 dBm.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm 5 43 43

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit External Cell/ Packet2/2

External Comment The default value depends on the BCCH frequency band:Defaultvalue for P-GSM/G1: 43 dBmDefault value for GSM850: 39dBmDefault value for DCS1800: 30 dBmDefault value for DCS1900:30 dBm

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 921 / 1176

Page 922: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.138 (N_AVG_I (BSC)) - (N_AVG_I (BSC))

HMI Name N_AVG_I (BSC)Parameter Name

Logical Name N_AVG_I (BSC)

Definition N_AVG_I (BSC) value is broadcast to the (E)GPRS MS in the SI13.The (E)GPRS MS uses it for filtering the interference signal levelmeasurements that it shall perform during the packet transfer mode.These measurements are used by the (E)GPRS MS for output powercontrol, but also reported to the network and used for performingdownlink link adaptation.

Coding rules coded on 4 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to N_AVG_I (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 15 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

922 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 923: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.139 (N_AVG_I (MFS)) - (N_AVG_I (MFS))

HMI Name N_AVG_I (MFS)Parameter Name

Logical Name N_AVG_I (MFS)

Definition N_AVG_I (MFS) value is broadcast to the (E)GPRS MS in the PSI13 and PSI1. The (E)GPRS MS uses it for filtering the interferencesignal level measurements that it shall perform during the packettransfer mode. These measurements are used by the (E)GPRS MSfor output power control, but also reported to the network and usedfor performing downlink link adaptation.

Coding rules coded on 4 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to N_AVG_I (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 15 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Ch. 1/2.

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 923 / 1176

Page 924: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.140 (N3101_LIMIT) - (N3101_LIMIT)

HMI Name N3101_LIMITParameter Name

Logical Name N3101_LIMIT

Definition In an UL TBF tranfer procedure, maximum of consecutive times(before releasing abnormally the UL TBF) when the network receivesno valid UL RLC data block or nothing from the MS on its allocatedPDCH.To note that the counter N3101 can be incremented morethan one time per block period.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 10 64 64

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

924 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 925: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.141 (N3101_POLLING_THR) - (N3101_POLLING_THR)

HMI Name N3101_POLLING_THRParameter Name

Logical Name N3101_POLLING_THR

Definition Threshold on the counter N3101 above which the RLC layer shallstart sending polling request to a MS for an UL TBF in EUTM modewhen EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF is set ot 2 (IEUTM enabled).

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules This parameter should be equal to N3101_LIMIT / 4.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 3 16 16

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 925 / 1176

Page 926: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.142 (N3103_LIMIT) - (N3103_LIMIT)

HMI Name N3103_LIMITParameter Name

Logical Name N3103_LIMIT

Definition In an UL TBF releasing procedure, maximum of consecutive times(before releasing abnormally the UL TBF) when the network does notreceive a Packet Control Acknowledgement from the MS in responseof its Packet UL ACK/NACK which specifies the end of the TBF.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules N3103_Limit: maximum number of retransmissions to release anUL TBFMax_Retrans_DL: maximum number of retransmissions toestablish a DL TBFIn case of simultaneous UL TBF Release andDL TBF establishment with loss of the Packet Control Ack whichacknowledges the final Packet UL Ack/Nack, the UL TBF has to bereleased, at least before the last attempt to establish the DL TBF,in order to avoid the emission of a Radio Status.Consequently thefollowing rule has to be followed:(N3103_Limit + 1) x (RTD + 60) <Max_Retrans_DL x (RTD + 60)N3103_Limit + 1: total number ofattempts to send the final Packet UL Ack/NackRTD: Round TripDelay60 (msec): for the Packet UL Ack/Nack acknowledgement:RRBP + 3 is usedMax_Retrans_DL: total number of attempts minusone to send the Packet DL Assignment60 (msec): for the PacketDL Assignment acknowledgement: RRBP + 3 is usedN3103_Limit< (Max_Retrans_DL x (RTD + 60) / (RTD + 60)) - 1N3103_Limit< [Max_Retrans_DL] - 1Example:With Max_Retrans_DL = 3:N3103_Limit < 2 that is N3103_Limit = 1

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 16 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

926 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 927: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.143 (N3105_LIMIT) - (N3105_LIMIT)

HMI Name N3105_LIMITParameter Name

Logical Name N3105_LIMIT

Definition For a DL GPRS TBF, if the EGPRS traffic is carried through Abisterrestrial link and Ater terrestrial link, this parameter defines themaximum number of expected Packet Downlink ACK/NACK or PacketControl Acknowledgement messages consecutively lost on the radiointerface, before triggering an abnormal release of the DL TBF. Thisparameter is used in conjunction with the MIN_RLF_TIME_DL delayto decide if the DL TBF shall be released.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 64 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment If N3105_LIMIT < TBF_CS_DL then the loss of consecutive packetDL ACK/NACK will not trigger link adaptation but TBF release.N3105_Limit has to be set in order not to release a DL TBF in caseof transient bad radio conditions. The polling frequency depends onGPRS_DL_Ack_Period, T_DL_GPRS_MeasReport, MS multislotclass and on the number of TBFs per PDCH.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 927 / 1176

Page 928: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.144 (N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE) - (N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE)

HMI Name N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITEParameter Name

Logical Name N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE

Definition For a DL GPRS TBF, if the EGPRS traffic is carried through Abissatellite link or Ater satellite link, this parameter defines the maximumnumber of expected Packet Downlink ACK/NACK or Packet ControlAcknowledgement messages consecutively lost on the radiointerface, before triggering an abnormal release of the DL TBF. Thisparameter is used in conjunction with the MIN_RLF_TIME_DL delayto decide if the DL TBF shall be released.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 64 24

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment If N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE < TBF_CS_DL then the loss ofconsecutive packet DL ACK/NACK will not trigger link adaptationbut TBF release. N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE has to be set in ordernot to release a DL TBF in case of transient bad radio conditions.The polling frequency depends on GPRS_DL_Ack_Period_Satellite,T_DL_GPRS_MeasReport, MS multislot class and on the numberof TBFs per PDCH.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

928 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 929: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.145 (NB_TS_MPDCH) - (NB_TS_MPDCH (BSC))

HMI Name NB_TS_MPDCHParameter Name

Logical Name NB_TS_MPDCH (BSC)

Definition Number of radio timeslots reserved for the primary and secondarymaster PDCHs defined in the cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules 1) MIN_PDCH > NB_TS_MPDCH ifEN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = enabled; MIN_PDCH>= NB_TS_MPDCH if EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS =disabled.2) if the network_operation_mode (BSC) parameter is setto 2 (NMO II) then all cells of the BSS must have NB_TS_MPDCH= 03)The following conditions are verified by the OMC-R in orderto check the upper limit of MAX_PDCH:i) MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nbof TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 1 if TRX_PREF_MARK= 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "1: CCCH combined"ii)MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 2 ifTRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "0:CCCH not combined"iii) MAX_PDCH <= NB_TS_MPDCH + 8*(nbof TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) if TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0on BCCH TRX.4) When cell_type = "extended inner" or "extendedouter", then NB_TS_MPDCH = 0

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 4 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Ch 1/2

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 929 / 1176

Page 930: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment The Master PDCH requires the establishment of a GCH (Abisand Ater) which does not carry traffic. In case of Abis or Aterthrough satellite link, the usage of the MPDCH must consider thefollowing criteria:* higher cost of transmission resources through thesatellite link;* limited throughput of the RSL in case of Abis throughsatellite to about 6 kbit/s (because of round trip delay effect onacknowledged protocol with limited LAP-D window size). In case ofimportant CS signalling load, the RSL may not be able to transportthe additional signalling load due toTBF establishments when noMPDCH is established.Hence the recommendation in the GPRSthrough satellite case is:* for a cell connected with Abis throughsatellite and with non negligible signalling load (CS+PS), MPDCHis recommended;* for a cell connected with Ater through satellite,MPDCH is not recommended.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

930 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 931: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.146 (NB_TS_MPDCH) - (NB_TS_MPDCH (MFS))

HMI Name NB_TS_MPDCHParameter Name

Logical Name NB_TS_MPDCH (MFS)

Definition Number of radio timeslots reserved for the primary and secondarymaster PDCHs defined in the cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules 1) MIN_PDCH > NB_TS_MPDCH ifEN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = enabled;MIN_PDCH>= NB_TS_MPDCH if EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS =disabled.2) if the network_operation_mode (MFS) parameter is setto 2 (NMO II) then all cells of the BSS must have NB_TS_MPDCH= 0.3)The following conditions are verified by the OMC-R in orderto check the upper limit of MAX_PDCH:i) MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nbof TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 1 if TRX_PREF_MARK= 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "1: CCCH combined"ii)MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 2 ifTRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "0:CCCH not combined"iii) MAX_PDCH <= NB_TS_MPDCH + 8*(nbof TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) if TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0on BCCH TRX.4) When cell_type = "extended inner" or "extendedouter", then NB_TS_MPDCH = 0

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 4 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Ch 1/2

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 931 / 1176

Page 932: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment The Master PDCH requires the establishment of a GCH (Abisand Ater) which does not carry traffic. In case of Abis or Aterthrough satellite link, the usage of the MPDCH must consider thefollowing criteria:* higher cost of transmission resources through thesatellite link;* limited throughput of the RSL in case of Abis throughsatellite to about 6 kbit/s (because of round trip delay effect onacknowledged protocol with limited LAP-D window size). In case ofimportant CS signalling load, the RSL may not be able to transportthe additional signalling load due toTBF establishments when noMPDCH is established.Hence the recommendation in the GPRSthrough satellite case is:* for a cell connected with Abis throughsatellite and with non negligible signalling load (CS+PS), MPDCHis recommended;* for a cell connected with Ater through satellite,MPDCH is not recommended.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

932 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 933: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.147 (NC_DL_RXLEV_LIMIT_THR) - (NC_DL_RXLEV_LIMIT_THR)

HMI Name NC_DL_RXLEV_LIMIT_THRParameter Name

Logical Name NC_DL_RXLEV_LIMIT_THR

Definition Threshold below which a NC cell reselection Cause PT2 can betriggered due to the detection of a better neighbour cell.

Coding rules 0: "-110 dBm (Never)", 1:" -109 dBm", ...,63: "-47 dBm (Always)"(step size = 1 dB)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematicallytriggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it isrecommended to deactivate NC cell reselection Cause PT2 (i.e.set NC_DL_RXLEV_LIMIT_THR to -110 dBm (Never). The aim ofthis recommended rule is to limit the conditions triggering a GPRSredirection.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -47

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment 1) The specific value of "-110 dBm (Never)" deactivates the NC cellreselections Cause PT2.2) The specific value of "-47 dBm (Always)"systematically allows the triggering of NC cell reselections CausePT2

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 933 / 1176

Page 934: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.148 (NC_DL_RXLEV_THR) - (NC_DL_RXLEV_THR)

HMI Name NC_DL_RXLEV_THRParameter Name

Logical Name NC_DL_RXLEV_THR

Definition Threshold below which a NC cell reselection Cause PT1 is triggereddue to a too bad RXLEV in the downlink direction (while the MS isin packet transfer mode).

Coding rules 0: "-110 dBm (Never)", 1:" -109 dBm", ...,63: "-47 dBm" (step size= 1 dB)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematicallytriggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it isrecommended to activate NC cell reselection Cause PT1 (i.e. setNC_DL_RXLEV_THR to -47 dBm (Always).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -96

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment The specific value of "-110 dBm (Never)" deactivates the NC cellreselection Cause PT1.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

934 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 935: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.149 (NC_DL_RXQUAL_THR) - (NC_DL_RXQUAL_THR)

HMI Name NC_DL_RXQUAL_THRParameter Name

Logical Name NC_DL_RXQUAL_THR

Definition Threshold above which a NC cell reselection Cause PT3 is triggereddue to a too bad RXQUAL in downlink direction (while the MS isin packet transfer mode).

Coding rules step size = 0.1. At the OMC-R, the following values are displayed:"0", "0.1", "0.2", , "6.9", "7 (Never)".

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematicallytriggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it isrecommended to deactivate NC cell reselection Cause PT3 (i.e. setNC_UL_RXQUAL_THR to 7 (Never). The aim of this recommendedrule is to limit the conditions triggering a GPRS redirection.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 7

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment The specific value of "7 (Never)" deactivates the NC cell reselectionCause PT3.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 935 / 1176

Page 936: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.150 (NC_PING_PONG_OFFSET) - (NC_PING_PONG_OFFSET)

HMI Name NC_PING_PONG_OFFSETParameter Name

Logical Name NC_PING_PONG_OFFSET

Definition NC ping-pong offset which is applied to the C2 or C32 criterion todisfavour the neighbour cells during T_NC_PING_PONG_OFFSET.

Coding rules step size = 1 dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 63 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

936 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 937: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.151 (NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T) - (NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T)

HMI Name NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_TParameter Name

Logical Name NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T

Definition Reporting period of NC measurements reported by the MS whilein packet transfer mode.

Coding rules coded from 0 to 7 (0 0 0 : 0.48 sec , 0 0 1: 0.96 sec , 0 1 0 : 1.92sec , 0 1 1: 3.84 sec, 1 0 0 : 7.68 sec , 1 0 1 : 15.36 sec , 1 1 0:30.72 sec , 1 1 1: 61.44 sec) .

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.48 61.44 0.96

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit cell / Gprs / Reselection

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 937 / 1176

Page 938: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.152 (NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T(n)) -(NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T(n))

HMI Name NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T(n)Parameter Name

Logical Name NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T(n)

Definition Reporting period of NC measurements reported by the MS whilein packet transfer mode.

Coding rules coded from 0 to 7 (0 0 0 : 0.48 sec , 0 0 1: 0.96 sec , 0 1 0 : 1.92sec , 0 1 1: 3.84 sec, 1 0 0 : 7.68 sec , 1 0 1 : 15.36 sec , 1 1 0:30.72 sec , 1 1 1: 61.44 sec) .

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.48 61.44 0.96

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit External cell / Packet 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

938 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 939: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.153 (NC_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS) -(NC_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(0,n))

HMI Name NC_RESELECT_HYSTERESISParameter Name

Logical Name NC_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(0,n)

Definition NC cell reselection offset used for triggering power budget causes.

Coding rules 0: -127 dB (Always), 1: -126 dB, , 254: 127 dB, 255: 128 dB (Never)(step size = 1 dB)

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -127 128 128

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit adjacency / Adjacency parameters View / outgoing

External Comment 1) The specific value of "128 dB (Never)" deactivates the NC cellreselection Cause PT2 towards the target cell n.2) The specific valueof "-127 dB" (Always)" systematically triggers the NC cell reselectionCause PT2 towards the target cell n.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 939 / 1176

Page 940: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.154 (NC_RXLEV_FORGETTING_FACTOR) -(NC_RXLEV_FORGETTING_FACTOR)

HMI Name NC_RXLEV_FORGETTING_FACTORParameter Name

Logical Name NC_RXLEV_FORGETTING_FACTOR

Definition Forgetting factor of the filter used to average the NC measurementsreported in the Packet Measurement Report messages.

Coding rules step size = 0.001

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0.13

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment This parameter applies to the serving cell and the neighbour cells.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

940 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 941: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.155 (NC_RXQUAL_AVG_PERIOD) - (NC_RXQUAL_AVG_PERIOD)

HMI Name NC_RXQUAL_AVG_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name NC_RXQUAL_AVG_PERIOD

Definition Period after which a weight of 0.9 s is applied to the current UL orDL RXQUAL samples in the averaging filter.

Coding rules step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 20 10000 4000

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment This parameter applies to the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 941 / 1176

Page 942: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.156 (NC_UL_RXQUAL_THR) - (NC_UL_RXQUAL_THR)

HMI Name NC_UL_RXQUAL_THRParameter Name

Logical Name NC_UL_RXQUAL_THR

Definition Threshold above which a NC cell reselection Cause PT4 is triggereddue to a too bad RXQUAL in uplink direction (while the MS is inpacket transfer mode).

Coding rules step size = 0.1. At the OMC-R, the following values are displayed:"0", "0.1", "0.2", , "6.9", "7 (Never)"

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematicallytriggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it isrecommended to deactivate NC cell reselection Cause PT4 (i.e. setNC_UL_RXQUAL_THR to 7 (Never). The aim of this recommendedrule is to limit the conditions triggering a GPRS redirection.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 7

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment The specific value of "7 (Never)" deactivates the NC cell reselectionCause PT4.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

942 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 943: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.157 (NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODE) - (NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODE)

HMI Name NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODEParameter Name

Logical Name NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODE

Definition NC2 deactivation mode. This parameter defines whether or not thePacket Measurement Order message with a Reset Command is sentat the end of a packet transfer.

Coding rules 0: "NC2 deactivation at the end of the packet transfer". A PacketMeasurement Order message is sent to deactivate the NC2 mode atthe end of the packet transfer.1: "NC2 deactivation at the expiry ofthe GMM Ready timer". No Packet Measurement Order message issent to deactivate the NC2 mode.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are not triggeredsystematically (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Disable), thepresence of the PBCCH is not mandatory. However, the followingrecommendations apply, depending on the presence of the PBCCH:-If PBCCH is present, the NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODE can be set toany value (at the end of the packet transfer mode or at the expiry ofthe GMM Ready timer) if the setting of the C32 parameters ensuresthat GPRS mobile stations do not camp in cells where outgoingGPRS redirections are systematically triggered.- If PBCCH is notpresent or PBCCH is present but C32 parameters are not correctlyset, the NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODE should be set to "at the expiryof the GMM Ready timer" to prevent the GPRS mobile stations fromreselecting a cell where outgoing GPRS redirections are triggeredsystematically (at least while the MS is in packet idle mode and theGMM Ready timer is running).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 943 / 1176

Page 944: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.158 (NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER) -(NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER)

HMI Name NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDERParameter Name

Logical Name NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER

Definition This parameter defines whether the MS or the BSS controls the cellreselections.

Coding rules 0: NC0 mode of operation for all MS. All MS controls their cellreselections an no MS reports packet measurements to the BSS.1:NC1 mode of operation for all MS. All MS controls their cellreselections but all the MS reports packet measurements to the BSS.(Not supported)2: NC2 mode of operation for R99 onwards MS.The BSS controls the cell reselections of R99 onwards MS when inpacket transfer mode or of R99 onwards MS when in GMM Readystate (depending on the selected NC2 deactivation mode). While theNC2 mode is activated for the concerned MS, the MS reports packetmeasurements to the BSS.3: NC2 mode of operation for all MS. TheBSS controls the cell reselections of all MS when in packet transfermode or of all MS when in GMM Ready state (depending on theselected NC2 deactivation mode). While the NC2 mode is activatedfor the concerned MS, the MS reports packet measurements to theBSS.4: NC2 mode of operation for Rel.4 onwards MS. The BSScontrols the cell reselections of Rel.4 onwards MS when in packettransfer mode or of Rel.4 onwards MS when in GMM Ready state(depending on the selected NC2 deactivation mode). While the NC2mode is activated for the concerned MS, the MS reports packetmeasurements to the BSS.

Mandatory rules - The OMC-R only shows the values 0, 2, 3 and 4 to the operator.-When cell_type = "extended inner" or "extended outer", thenNETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER = NC0 mode of operation for all MS

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 4 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

944 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 945: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment If the NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to "NC2 mode ofoperation for R99 onwards MS" or "NC2 mode of operation for all MS"or "NC2 mode of operation for Rel.4 onwards MS", the 3G search issystematically deactivated when activating the NC2 mode (activationperformed through the Packet Measurement Order [NC2] message).This 3G search deactivation is then performed independently of thevalue of the EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION parameter.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 945 / 1176

Page 946: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.159 (NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER) -(NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER(n))

HMI Name NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDERParameter Name

Logical Name NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER(n)

Definition This parameter defines whether the MS or the BSS controls the cellreselections.

Coding rules 0: NC0 mode of operation for all MS. All MS controls their cellreselections an no MS reports packet measurements to the BSS.1:NC1 mode of operation for all MS. All MS controls their cellreselections but all the MS reports packet measurements to the BSS.(Not supported)2: NC2 mode of operation for R99 onwards MS.The BSS controls the cell reselections of R99 onwards MS when inpacket transfer mode or of R99 onwards MS when in GMM Readystate (depending on the selected NC2 deactivation mode). While theNC2 mode is activated for the concerned MS, the MS reports packetmeasurements to the BSS.3: NC2 mode of operation for all MS. TheBSS controls the cell reselections of all MS when in packet transfermode or of all MS when in GMM Ready state (depending on theselected NC2 deactivation mode). While the NC2 mode is activatedfor the concerned MS, the MS reports packet measurements to theBSS.4: NC2 mode of operation for Rel.4 onwards MS. The BSScontrols the cell reselections of Rel.4 onwards MS when in packettransfer mode or of Rel.4 onwards MS when in GMM Ready state(depending on the selected NC2 deactivation mode). While the NC2mode is activated for the concerned MS, the MS reports packetmeasurements to the BSS.

Mandatory rules - The OMC-R only shows the values 0, 2, 3 and 4 to the operator.-When cell_type = "extended inner" or "extended outer", thenNETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER = NC0 mode of operation for all MS

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 4 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit External Cell / Packet 2/2

946 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 947: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment If the NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to "NC2 mode ofoperation for R99 onwards MS" or "NC2 mode of operation for all MS"or "NC2 mode of operation for Rel.4 onwards MS", the 3G search issystematically deactivated when activating the NC2 mode (activationperformed through the Packet Measurement Order [NC2] message).This 3G search deactivation is then performed independently of thevalue of the EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION parameter.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 947 / 1176

Page 948: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.160 (Network_mode_of_operation) - (network_operation_mode(BSC))

HMI Name Network_mode_of_operationParameter Name

Logical Name network_operation_mode (BSC)

Definition This parameter defines the CS-PS co-ordination for paging.

Coding rules 3 possible values : 1, 2, 3; 1 == Network operation mode I ; 2 ==Network operation mode II ; 3 == Network operation mode III.

Mandatory rules If the network_operation_mode (BSC) parameter is set to NMO IIthen all cells of the BSS must have NB_TS_MPDCH = 0 Equal tonetwork_operation_mode (MFS).

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment Any change will trigger a data reset of the GPUs. Stop and restartof (E)GPRS traffic in all the cells of the BSS. NMO I requires a Gsinterface.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

948 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 949: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.161 (Network_mode_of_operation) - (network_operation_mode(MFS))

HMI Name Network_mode_of_operationParameter Name

Logical Name network_operation_mode (MFS)

Definition This parameter defines the CS-PS co-ordination for paging.

Coding rules 3 possible values : 1, 2, 3; 1 == Network operation mode I ; 2 ==Network operation mode II ; 3 == Network operation mode III

Mandatory rules If the network_operation_mode (MFS) parameter is set to NMO IIthen all cells of the BSS must have NB_TS_MPDCH = 0. Equal tonetwork_operation_mode (BSC).

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 3 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment Any change will trigger a data reset of the GPUs. Stop and restartof (E)GPRS traffic in all the cells of the BSS. NMO I requires a Gsinterface.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 949 / 1176

Page 950: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.162 (Normal Information Rate) - (NIR)

HMI Name Normal Information RateParameter Name

Logical Name NIR

Definition Normal Information Rate.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules CIR <= NIR <= CIR x (1 + EBS/CBS) <= ACCESS RATE BC

Recommended rules NIR=0 when direct access is used

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance PVC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

kbit/s 0 1984 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access MFSUSM / GB Configuration / NSVC Creation

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

950 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 951: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.163 (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY) -(NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY)

HMI Name NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Background Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'normal'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 951 / 1176

Page 952: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.164 (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY) -(NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY)

HMI Name NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP1 Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'normal'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

952 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 953: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.165 (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY) -(NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY)

HMI Name NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP2 Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'normal'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 9

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 953 / 1176

Page 954: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.166 (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY) -(NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY)

HMI Name NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP3 Packet FlowContext, with precedence parameter set to 'normal'

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

954 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 955: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.167 (NS Priority) - (NS_Priority)

HMI Name NS PriorityParameter Name

Logical Name NS_Priority

Definition Priority of the NSVC, is used by the load sharing.

Coding rules 1: lowest priority, 255:highest priority

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance NSVC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 255 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access MFSUSM / GB Configuration / NSVC Creation

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 955 / 1176

Page 956: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.168 (NSEI) - (NSEI)

HMI Name NSEIParameter Name

Logical Name NSEI

Definition NSE Identifier.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance NSE

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 65535 None

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access MFSUSM / GB Configuration / NSE Creation

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

956 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 957: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.169 (NstagnatingWindowDL_LIMIT) -(N_stagnating_Window_DL_LIMIT)

HMI Name NstagnatingWindowDL_LIMITParameter Name

Logical Name N_stagnating_Window_DL_LIMIT

Definition This parameter defines the maximum number of consecutive PacketDownlink ACK/NACK or EGPRS Packet Downlink ACK/NACKmessages reporting the failure of progress of the RLC window duringthe active phase of a downlink TBF, before triggering an abnormalrelease of the DL TBF. This parameter is used in conjunction with theMIN_RLF_TIME_DL delay to decide if the DL TBF shall be released.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 256 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 957 / 1176

Page 958: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.170 (NstagnatingWindowUL_LIMIT) -(N_stagnating_Window_UL_LIMIT)

HMI Name NstagnatingWindowUL_LIMITParameter Name

Logical Name N_stagnating_Window_UL_LIMIT

Definition NstagnatingWindow limit above which a mono-slot uplink TBF aloneon its PDCH shall be released: the counter is incremented each timea Packet UL Ack/Nack fails in making the RLC window progress.For a multi-slot TBF or a TBF which shares its PDCH, the limit isproportional to the allocated bandwidth at the TBF establishment.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 256 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

958 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 959: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.171 (NSVC Identifier) - (NSVCI)

HMI Name NSVC IdentifierParameter Name

Logical Name NSVCI

Definition NSVC identifier.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance NSVC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 65535 None

Modifiable OMC Changes: set by create(MFS) RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access MFSUSM / GB Configuration / NSVC Creation

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 959 / 1176

Page 960: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.172 (PAN_DEC) - (PAN_DEC (BSC))

HMI Name PAN_DECParameter Name

Logical Name PAN_DEC (BSC)

Definition Value decremented from MS N3102 counter when PACKET ULACK/NACK is not received before MS timer T3182.

Coding rules Binary coded on 3 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to PAN_DEC (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

960 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 961: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.173 (PAN_DEC) - (PAN_DEC (MFS))

HMI Name PAN_DECParameter Name

Logical Name PAN_DEC (MFS)

Definition Value decremented from MS N3102 counter when PACKET ULACK/NACK is not received before MS timer T3182.

Coding rules Binary coded on 3 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to PAN_DEC (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 961 / 1176

Page 962: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.174 (PAN_INC) - (PAN_INC (BSC))

HMI Name PAN_INCParameter Name

Logical Name PAN_INC (BSC)

Definition Value incremented to MS N3102 counter when PACKET ULACK/NACK is received by MS.

Coding rules Binary coded on 3 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to PAN_INC (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

962 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 963: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.175 (PAN_INC) - (PAN_INC (MFS))

HMI Name PAN_INCParameter Name

Logical Name PAN_INC (MFS)

Definition Value incremented to MS N3102 counter when PACKET ULACK/NACK is received by MS.

Coding rules Binary coded on 3 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to PAN_INC (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 963 / 1176

Page 964: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.176 (PAN_MAX) - (PAN_MAX (BSC))

HMI Name PAN_MAXParameter Name

Logical Name PAN_MAX (BSC)

Definition Maximum value for counter N3102. cell reselection is done by MSwhen N3102 <= 0.

Coding rules Possible values : 4, 8, 12., 32 respectively binary coded 000, 001, ,111

Mandatory rules Equal to PAN_MAX (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 32 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

964 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 965: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.177 (PAN_MAX) - (PAN_MAX (MFS))

HMI Name PAN_MAXParameter Name

Logical Name PAN_MAX (MFS)

Definition Maximum value for counter N3102. cell reselection is done by MSwhen N3102 <= 0.

Coding rules Possible values : 4, 8, 12,.., 32 respectively binary coded 000, 001,.., 111

Mandatory rules Equal to PAN_MAX (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 32 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 965 / 1176

Page 966: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.178 (PC_MEAS_CHAN) - (PC_MEAS_CHAN (BSC))

HMI Name PC_MEAS_CHANParameter Name

Logical Name PC_MEAS_CHAN (BSC)

Definition This parameter determines on which channel the MS shall measurethe received power level on the downlink for the purpose of the uplinkpower control.

Coding rules 0 : downlink measurements for power control shall be made on BCCH

Mandatory rules Equal to PC_MEAS_CHAN (MFS).

Recommended rules PC_MEAS_CHAN should be forced to PDCH in multiband cells

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

966 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 967: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.179 (PC_MEAS_CHAN) - (PC_MEAS_CHAN (MFS))

HMI Name PC_MEAS_CHANParameter Name

Logical Name PC_MEAS_CHAN (MFS)

Definition This parameter determines on which channel the MS shall measurethe received power level on the downlink for the purpose of the uplinkpower control.

Coding rules 0 : downlink measurements for power control shall be made onBCCH, 1 : downlink measurements for power control shall be madeon PDCH

Mandatory rules Equal to PC_MEAS_CHAN (BSC).

Recommended rules PC_MEAS_CHAN should be forced to PDCH in multiband cells

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 967 / 1176

Page 968: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.180 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1) -(PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1)

HMI Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1

Definition Upper limit of the 1st band, lower limit of the 2nd band for DL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1<PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

968 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 969: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.181 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2) -(PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2)

HMI Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2

Definition Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for DL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1 <PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2<PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 969 / 1176

Page 970: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.182 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3) -(PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3)

HMI Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3

Definition Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for DL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3 <PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 1.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

970 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 971: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.183 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4) -(PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4)

HMI Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4

Definition Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for DL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4 <PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 971 / 1176

Page 972: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.184 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5) -(PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5)

HMI Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5

Definition Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for DL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5 <PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 2.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

972 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 973: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.185 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6) -(PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6)

HMI Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6

Definition Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for DL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6 <PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 973 / 1176

Page 974: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.186 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7) -(PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7)

HMI Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7

Definition Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for DL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7 <PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 3.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

974 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 975: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.187 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8) -(PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8)

HMI Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8

Definition Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for DL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8 <PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 975 / 1176

Page 976: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.188 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9) -(PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9)

HMI Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Definition Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for DL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8 <PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 4.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

976 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 977: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.189 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1) -(PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1

Definition Upper limit of the first band, lower limit of the second band for DLTBF duration distribution.

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 977 / 1176

Page 978: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.190 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2) -(PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2

Definition Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for DL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

978 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 979: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.191 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3) -(PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3

Definition Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for DL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 979 / 1176

Page 980: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.192 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4) -(PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4

Definition Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for DL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

980 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 981: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.193 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5) -(PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5

Definition Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for DL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 981 / 1176

Page 982: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.194 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6) -(PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6

Definition Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for DL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

982 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 983: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.195 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7) -(PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7

Definition Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for DL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 983 / 1176

Page 984: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.196 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8) -(PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8

Definition Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for DL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 50

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

984 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 985: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.197 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9) -(PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Definition Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for DL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8 <PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 985 / 1176

Page 986: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.198 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1

Definition Upper limit of the 1st band, lower limit of the 2nd band for LLCvolume carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 500

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

986 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 987: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.199 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2

Definition Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for LLCvolume carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2 <PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 1000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 987 / 1176

Page 988: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.200 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3

Definition Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for LLC volumecarried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3 <PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 2000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

988 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 989: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.201 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4

Definition Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for LLC volumecarried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4 <PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 3000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 989 / 1176

Page 990: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.202 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5

Definition Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for LLC volumecarried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5 <PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 5000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

990 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 991: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.203 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6

Definition Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for LLC volumecarried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6 <PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 10000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 991 / 1176

Page 992: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.204 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7

Definition Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for LLC volumecarried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7 <PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 20000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

992 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 993: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.205 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8

Definition Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for LLC volumecarried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8 <PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 50000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 993 / 1176

Page 994: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.206 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9)

HMI Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Definition Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for LLCvolume carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 100000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

994 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 995: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.207 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1) -(PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1)

HMI Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1

Definition Upper limit of the 1st band, lower limit of the 2nd band for UL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1<PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 995 / 1176

Page 996: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.208 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2) -(PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2)

HMI Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2

Definition Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for UL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1 <PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2<PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

996 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 997: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.209 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3) -(PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3)

HMI Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3

Definition Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for UL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3 <PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 1.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 997 / 1176

Page 998: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.210 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4) -(PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4)

HMI Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4

Definition Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for UL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4 <PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

998 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 999: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.211 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5) -(PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5)

HMI Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5

Definition Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for UL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5 <PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 2.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 999 / 1176

Page 1000: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.212 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6) -(PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6)

HMI Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6

Definition Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for UL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6 <PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1000 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1001: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.213 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7) -(PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7)

HMI Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7

Definition Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for UL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7 <PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 3.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1001 / 1176

Page 1002: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.214 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8) -(PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8)

HMI Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8

Definition Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for UL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8 <PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1002 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1003: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.215 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9) -(PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9)

HMI Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Definition Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for UL PDCHunit allocation distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8 <PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0.1 4.9 4.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1003 / 1176

Page 1004: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.216 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1) -(PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1

Definition Upper limit of the first band, lower limit of the second band for ULTBF duration distribution.

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1004 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1005: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.217 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2) -(PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2

Definition Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for UL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1005 / 1176

Page 1006: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.218 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3) -(PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3

Definition Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for UL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1006 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1007: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.219 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4) -(PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4

Definition Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for UL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1007 / 1176

Page 1008: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.220 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5) -(PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5

Definition Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for UL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1008 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1009: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.221 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6) -(PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6

Definition Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for UL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1009 / 1176

Page 1010: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.222 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7) -(PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7

Definition Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for UL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1010 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1011: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.223 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8) -(PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8

Definition Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for UL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 50

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1011 / 1176

Page 1012: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.224 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9) -(PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Definition Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for UL TBFduration distribution

Coding rules step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8 <PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 16383.5 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1012 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1013: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.225 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1

Definition Upper limit of the 1st band, lower limit of the 2nd band for LLCvolume carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 500

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1013 / 1176

Page 1014: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.226 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2

Definition Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for LLCvolume carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2 <PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 1000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1014 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1015: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.227 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3

Definition Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for LLC volumecarried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3 <PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 2000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1015 / 1176

Page 1016: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.228 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4

Definition Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for LLC volumecarried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4 <PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 3000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1016 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1017: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.229 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5

Definition Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for LLC volumecarried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5 <PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 5000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1017 / 1176

Page 1018: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.230 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6

Definition Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for LLC volumecarried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6 <PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 10000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1018 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1019: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.231 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7

Definition Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for LLC volumecarried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7 <PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 20000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1019 / 1176

Page 1020: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.232 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8

Definition Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for LLC volumecarried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8 <PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 50000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1020 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1021: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.233 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9)

HMI Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9Parameter Name

Logical Name PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Definition Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for LLCvolume carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

byte 1 99999999 100000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1021 / 1176

Page 1022: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.234 (Peer_NSE_Data_Weight) - (Peer_NSE_Data_Weight)

HMI Name Peer_NSE_Data_WeightParameter Name

Logical Name Peer_NSE_Data_Weight

Definition GboverIP: Indicates the data weight assigned to the peer NSE.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance SGSN-IPEndPoint

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 255 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Declared by the operator in case of static configuration.Initializedafter the CONFIG procedure in case of dynamic configuration.IfPeer_NSE_Data_Weight=0, the IP endpoint will not be selected as adata by the load sharing function.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1022 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1023: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.235 (Peer_NSE_Signalling_Weight) - (Peer_NSE_Signalling_Weight)

HMI Name Peer_NSE_Signalling_WeightParameter Name

Logical Name Peer_NSE_Signalling_Weight

Definition GboverIP: Indicates the signalling weight assigned to the peer NSE.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance SGSN-IPEndPoint

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 255 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Declared by the operator in case of static configuration.Initializedafter the CONFIG procedure in case of dynamic configuration.IfPeer_NSE_Signalling_Weight=0, the IP endpoint will not be selectedas a signalling endpoint.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1023 / 1176

Page 1024: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.236 (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_1) - (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_1)

HMI Name PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_1Parameter Name

Logical Name PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_1

Definition This parameter indicates the values of the access persistence levelfor radio priority 1.

Coding rules Values : 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 16 codedon 4 bits0 0 0 0 : persistence level 0, 0 0 0 1: persistence level 1,0 0 1 0:persistence level 2, 0 0 1 1: persistence level 3, 0 1.0.0 :persistence level 4. . . . 1 1 1 0 : persistence level 14, 1 1 1 1:persistence level 16

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 16 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1024 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1025: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.237 (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_2) - (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_2)

HMI Name PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_2Parameter Name

Logical Name PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_2

Definition This parameter indicates the values of the access persistence levelfor radio priority 2.

Coding rules Values : 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 16 codedon 4 bits0 0 0 0 : persistence level 0, 0 0 0 1: persistence level 1,0 0 1 0:persistence level 2, 0 0 1 1: persistence level 3, 0 1.0.0 :persistence level 4. . . . 1 1 1 0 : persistence level 14, 1 1 1 1:persistence level 16

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 16 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1025 / 1176

Page 1026: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.238 (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_3) - (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_3)

HMI Name PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_3Parameter Name

Logical Name PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_3

Definition This parameter indicates the values of the access persistence levelfor radio priority 3.

Coding rules Values : 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 16 codedon 4 bits0 0 0 0 : persistence level 0, 0 0 0 1: persistence level 1,0 0 1 0:persistence level 2, 0 0 1 1: persistence level 3, 0 1.0.0 :persistence level 4. . . . 1 1 1 0 : persistence level 14, 1 1 1 1:persistence level 16

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 16 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1026 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1027: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.239 (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_4) - (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_4)

HMI Name PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_4Parameter Name

Logical Name PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_4

Definition This parameter indicates the values of the access persistence levelfor radio priority 4.

Coding rules Values : 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 16 codedon 4 bits0 0 0 0 : persistence level 0, 0 0 0 1: persistence level 1,0 0 1 0:persistence level 2, 0 0 1 1: persistence level 3, 0 1.0.0 :persistence level 4. . . . 1 1 1 0 : persistence level 14, 1 1 1 1:persistence level 16

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 16 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1027 / 1176

Page 1028: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.240 (PFC_T6) - (PFC_T6)

HMI Name PFC_T6Parameter Name

Logical Name PFC_T6

Definition Timer guarding the Download-BSS-PFC procedure

Coding rules step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 10 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1028 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1029: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.241 (PFC_T8) - (PFC_T8)

HMI Name PFC_T8Parameter Name

Logical Name PFC_T8

Definition Timer guarding the Modify-BSS-PFC procedure

Coding rules step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 10 0.5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1029 / 1176

Page 1030: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.242 (PRACH_BUSY_THRES) - (PRACH_BUSY_THRES)

HMI Name PRACH_BUSY_THRESParameter Name

Logical Name PRACH_BUSY_THRES

Definition Received level above which a PRACH block is deemed busy.

Coding rules This parameter is encoded with a step size of 4 dB as follows:0:-110 dBm1: -106 dBm2: -102 dBm3: -98 dBm4: -94 dBm5: -90dBm6: -86 dBm7: -82 dBm8: -78 dBm9: -74 dBm10: -70 dBm11:-66 dBm12: -62 dBm13: -58 dBm14: -54 dBm15: -50 dBm

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -50 -106

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment Parameter used in dynamic allocation of secondary MasterPDCHalgorithm.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1030 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1031: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.243 (PRIORITY_CLASS) - (GPRS_PRIORITY_CLASS)

HMI Name PRIORITY_CLASSParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_PRIORITY_CLASS

Definition HCS priority of the cell, used in NC0.

Coding rules Coded on 3 bits.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1031 / 1176

Page 1032: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.244 (PRIORITY_CLASS) - (GPRS_PRIORITY_CLASS(n))

HMI Name PRIORITY_CLASSParameter Name

Logical Name GPRS_PRIORITY_CLASS(n)

Definition HCS priority of the adjacent cell, used in NC0.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1032 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1033: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.245 (PS_PREF_BCCH_TRX) - (PS_PREF_BCCH_TRX)

HMI Name PS_PREF_BCCH_TRXParameter Name

Logical Name PS_PREF_BCCH_TRX

Definition Indicates whether or not the PS requests shall be preferentiallyserved with PDCH(s) of the BCCH TRX

Coding rules 0: No preference. The TRX ranking algorithm handles the BCCHTRX as a non-BCCH TRX.1: PS requests preferentially served onBCCH TRX. The TRX ranking algorithm ensures that the BCCH TRXhas the highest preference to carry PS traffic (provided that theBCCH TRX can carry PS traffic, i.e. TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on thatTRX).2 : PS requests served on BCCH TRX with lowest priority. TheTRX ranking algorithm ensures that the BCCH TRX has the lowestpreference to carry PS traffic (provided that the BCCH TRX can carryPS traffic, i.e. TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on that TRX).

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules If EGPRS is activated in a non-hopping or a non-hopping /radio-hopping cell, Alcatel recommend to set this parameter to 0in order to reduce the likelihood of having to reduce the GMSKoutput power (see external comment).If EGPRS is activated in abase-band hopping cell, setting this parameter to 0 does not reducethe likelihood of having to reduce the GMSK output power since PScapable TRXs will hop on the BCCH carrier.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1033 / 1176

Page 1034: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment When set to 1 or '2', this parameter is only relevant if the BCCH TRXsupports PS traffic (i.e. if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on the BCCHTRX).If EGPRS is activated in a non-hopping or a non-hopping /radio-hopping cell, if the BCCH TRX can carry PS traffic and if theBCCH TRX is associated to a TRE hardware allowing the usage of8-PSK, the operator shall ensure that the difference in the meanoutput powers between GSMK and 8-PSK signals is less than 2 dBin order to be compliant with 3GPP TS 45.005 and 3GPP TS 45.008requirements (or 4 dB if an SDCCH timeslot is defined on timeslotnumber 7 of the BCCH TRX).If EGPRS is activated in a base-bandhopping cell, the operator shall ensure that the difference in themean output powers between GMSK and 8-PSK signals is less than2 dB in order to be compliant with 3GPP TS 45.005 and 3GPP TS45.008 requirements (or 4 dB if timeslot number 7 is not part of thePDCH groups).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1034 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1035: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.246 (QOS_SAFETY_MARGIN) - (QOS_SAFETY_MARGIN)

HMI Name QOS_SAFETY_MARGINParameter Name

Logical Name QOS_SAFETY_MARGIN

Definition Additional capacity (in terms of radio bandwidth and in terms oftransmission resources) which is reserved for a streaming TBF (RTPFC) to correctly fulfill its AGBR contract and to possibly convey othermultiplexed NRT PFC(s) of the same TBF. The part of this marginthat is not used by the streaming TBF may be used by other TBF(s).

Coding rules step size = 10%

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules Setting QOS_SAFETY_MARGIN to 0% is not recommended (theGBR of some RT PFCs may turn out to be impossible to guarantee inthis case).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1035 / 1176

Page 1036: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.247 (R_AVERAGE_EGPRS) - (R_AVERAGE_EGPRS)

HMI Name R_AVERAGE_EGPRSParameter Name

Logical Name R_AVERAGE_EGPRS

Definition Average bitrate per PDCH for Edge capable terminals in this cell

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules RMIN_EGPRS <= R_AVERAGE_EGPRS

Recommended rules R_AVERAGE_EGPRS shall not be set to a bitrate higher thanthe useful bitrate corresponding to MAX_EGPRS_MCS (e.g. ifMAX_EGPRS_MCS = MCS9 => R_AVERAGE_EGPRS shall notbe higher than 59,2kbps).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bit/s 0 59200 30000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter represents the average bit rate that is targeted,per PDCH, in the cell with respect to the cell radio planning. Itis recommended not to set this bit rate higher than the averagemeasured bit rate in the cell.The default value corresponds toMCS-6.The max value corresponds to MCS-9.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1036 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1037: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.248 (R_AVERAGE_GPRS) - (R_AVERAGE_GPRS)

HMI Name R_AVERAGE_GPRSParameter Name

Logical Name R_AVERAGE_GPRS

Definition Average bitrate per PDCH for non-Edge capable terminals in this cell

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules RMIN_GPRS <= R_AVERAGE_GPRS

Recommended rules R_AVERAGE_GPRS shall not be set to a bitrate higher thanthe useful bitrate corresponding to MAX_GPRS_CS (e.g. ifMAX_GPRS_CS = CS2 => R_AVERAGE_GPRS shall not be higherthan 12kbps).

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bit/s 0 20000 12000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter represents the average bit rate that is targeted,per PDCH, in the cell with respect to the cell radio planning. Itis recommended not to set this bit rate higher than the averagemeasured bit rate in the cell.The default value corresponds toCS-2.The max value corresponds to CS-4.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1037 / 1176

Page 1038: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.249 (RA_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS) - (RA_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS)

HMI Name RA_RESELECT_HYSTERESISParameter Name

Logical Name RA_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS

Definition This parameter indicates in both STANDBY and READY state theadditional hysteresis which applies when selecting a cell in a newRouting Area.

Coding rules step size = 2 dB, Coded on 3 bits. 000=0 dB, 001=2 dB, ...111=14 dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 14 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1038 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1039: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.250 (RACH/PRACH_TA_FILTER) - (RACH_TA_FILTER (MFS))

HMI Name RACH/PRACH_TA_FILTERParameter Name

Logical Name RACH_TA_FILTER (MFS)

Definition Timing Advance threshold for CHANNEL REQUIRED and PACKETCHANNEL REQUEST filtering.

Coding rules 64: no filtering

Mandatory rules Equal to RACH_TA_FILTER (BSC)

Recommended rules Disable the filtering for extended cells.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bper 0 64 64

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment One unit corresponds to a distance of about 550m. CHANNELREQUIRED or PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST messages withTiming Advance greater or equal to RACH_TA_FILTER arediscarded.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1039 / 1176

Page 1040: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.251 (RMIN_EGPRS) - (RMIN_EGPRS)

HMI Name RMIN_EGPRSParameter Name

Logical Name RMIN_EGPRS

Definition Minimal bitrate per PDCH for Edge capable terminals in this cell (at95 % or 90% confidence level or less %, depending on tolerable risk)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules RMIN_EGPRS <= R_AVERAGE_EGPRS

Recommended rules If EN_STREAMING = 1 and EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK = Falsethen the following condition must be respected: RMIN_EGPRS<= useful bitrate corresponding to min (TBF_UL_INIT_MCS,TBF_DL_INIT_MCS). Otherwise the streaming PFC can bedowngraded to the Defaut Best Effort ABQP.R_MIN_EGPRS shallnot be set to a bitrate higher than the useful bitrate corresponding toMax_EGPRS_MCS. If the above recommended rule is not fulfilled,then some RT PFCs can be accepted by the BSS whereas it will notbe possible to handle their associated GBR. This may result in RTPFC downgrades to Best Effort.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bit/s 0 59200 20800

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter is used to provide a guaranted Bit rate of streamingPFC for Edge capable MS, in the worst case radio condition. It shouldbe set appropriately with respect to the cell radio planning.The defaultvalue corresponds to a bitrate between MCS-4 and MCS-5.The maxvalue corresponds to MCS-9.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1040 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1041: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.252 (RMIN_GPRS) - (RMIN_GPRS)

HMI Name RMIN_GPRSParameter Name

Logical Name RMIN_GPRS

Definition Minimal bitrate per PDCH for non-Edge capable terminals in thiscell cell (at 95 % or 90% confidence level or less, depending ontolerable risk)

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules RMIN_GPRS <= R_AVERAGE_GPRS

Recommended rules If EN_STREAMING = 1 and EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK = Falsethen the following condition must be respected: RMIN_GPRS<= useful bitrate corresponding to min (TBF_UL_INIT_CS,TBF_DL_INIT_CS). Otherwise the streaming PFC can bedowngraded to the Defaut Best Effort ABQP.R_MIN_GPRS shallnot be set to a bitrate higher than the useful bitrate correspondingto Max_GPRS_CS. If the above recommended rule is not fulfilled,then some RT PFCs can be accepted by the BSS whereas it will notbe possible to handle their associated GBR. This may result in RTPFC downgrades to Best Effort.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

bit/s 0 20000 8000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter is used to provide a guaranted Bit rate of streamingPFC for Non Edge capable MS, in the worst case radio condition. Itshould be set appropriately with respect to the cell radio planning.Thedefault value corresponds to CS-1.The max value corresponds toCS-4.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1041 / 1176

Page 1042: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.253 (Round trip delay MFS-MS) - (round_trip_delay)

HMI Name Round trip delay MFS-MSParameter Name

Logical Name round_trip_delay

Definition Round trip delay between the MFS and a MS.

Coding rules step size=10 ms

Mandatory rules T3192 + T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL + round_trip_delay < 5 sec

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 80 940 160

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment The round-trip delay is used by the RRM, RLC and MAC layers. TheOMC-R and the MFS also use this parameter to determine whetheror not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite links asfollows:- If round_trip_delay < 500 ms, the OMC-R and the MFSconsider that GPRS traffic is carried through Abis and Ater terrestriallinks,- If round_trip_delay >= 500 ms, the OMC-R and the MFSconsider that GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis satellite linksor Ater satellite links.When the GPRS traffic is carried through Abisor Ater satellite links in the serving cell, it is recommended to set theround_trip_delay parameter to [Delay due to satellite (540 ms) +Delay due to MFS-MS link (160 ms)] = 700 ms.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1042 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1043: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.254 (Routing Area Code for GPRS) - (RA_CODE (BSC))

HMI Name Routing Area Code for GPRSParameter Name

Logical Name RA_CODE (BSC)

Definition Routing Area Code for GPRS.

Coding rules The initial special value -1 means that the RA code has still not beenset by the operator.

Mandatory rules - Equal to RA_CODE (MFS)- A couple of mate extended cells(Extended inner + extended outer) shall have the same RA_CODEwhen they are PS capable

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None -1 255 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment The value depends on configuration. The default value indicatedhere is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1043 / 1176

Page 1044: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.255 (Routing Area Code for GPRS) - (RA_CODE (MFS))

HMI Name Routing Area Code for GPRSParameter Name

Logical Name RA_CODE (MFS)

Definition Routing Area Code.

Coding rules 0...255 (significant value: 3GPP TS 04.60)other values: externalor unknown cell

Mandatory rules - Equal to RA_CODE (BSC)- A couple of mate extended cells(Extended inner + extended outer) shall have the same RA_CODEwhen they are PS capable

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None -1 255 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment The value depends on configuration. The default value indicatedhere is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1044 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1045: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.256 (Routing Area Code for GPRS) - (RA_CODE(n))

HMI Name Routing Area Code for GPRSParameter Name

Logical Name RA_CODE(n)

Definition Routing Area Code of neighbour cells.

Coding rules 0...255 (significant value: 3GPP TS 04.60);other values: external orunknown cell.The special value of "-1" means that the RA code hasstill not been valued by the network provider or that the MFS shall setthe SAME_RA_AS_SERVING_CELL field to 0.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules If i) the target and serving cells belong to different PLMNs and ii) theRAC and LAC of the target cell are equal to the RAC and LAC of theserving cell, and iii) there is a PBCCH established in the servingcell, and iv) a cell reselection adjacency link is defined between theserving cell and the target cell, then it is recommended to set theRA_CODE to -1. Otherwise, the MFS considers that the serving celland the target cell belong to the same routing area when settingthe SAME_RA_AS_SERVING_CELL field in the 04.60 PACKETSYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3/3bis messages.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None -1 255 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment The special value of -1 means that the RA code has still not beenvalued by the operator or that the routing area of the serving cell isdifferent from the routing area of the target cell.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1045 / 1176

Page 1046: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.257 (Routing Area Colour for GPRS) - (RA_COLOUR)

HMI Name Routing Area Colour for GPRSParameter Name

Logical Name RA_COLOUR

Definition Routing Area Colour for GPRS.

Coding rules Coded over 3 bits. the initial special value -1 means that the RAcodecolour has not yet been valued by the network provider.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 7 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment Default value depends on the configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1046 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1047: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.258 (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (MFS))

HMI Name RXLEV_ACCESS_MINParameter Name

Logical Name RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (MFS)

Definition Minimum received level at the MS required for initial access to thecell.

Coding rules Coded on 6 bits, 0=-110 dBm, 63=-47 dBm, step size=1dBm.

Mandatory rules RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (MFS) = RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access ?

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1047 / 1176

Page 1048: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.259 (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(MFS))

HMI Name RXLEV_ACCESS_MINParameter Name

Logical Name RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(MFS)

Definition Minimum received level at the MS required for initial access to thecell.

Coding rules Coded on 6 bits, 0=-110 dBm, 63=-47 dBm, step size=1dBm.

Mandatory rules RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(MFS) = RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance adj

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -110 -47 -100

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit External Cell/ Packet2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1048 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1049: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.260 (S) - (S)

HMI Name SParameter Name

Logical Name S

Definition Number of slots between 2 successive PACKET CHANNELREQUEST.

Coding rules Possible values are : 12, 15, 20, 30, 41, 55, 76, 109, 163, 217respectively binary coded : 0000, 0001, 0010,... ,1001

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules When the GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater terrestriallinks, it is recommended to set S so that the time between twosuccessive Packet Channel Request messages is longer than 900ms.When the GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellitelinks, it is recommended to set S so that the time between twosuccessive Packet Channel Request messages is longer than 1400ms.The number of slots belonging to the MSs PRACH between 2successive Packet Channel Request messages is a random valuedrawn randomly for each new retransmission with uniform distributionin the set (S, S+1, ...,S+T-1) with T = Tx_INT. The time in secondsbetween two Packet Channel Request messages is determined asa function of S, TX_INT and of the BS_PRACH_BLKS parameter.BS_PRACH_BLKS defines the number of blocks statically allocatedto the PRACH per 52 multiframe on each PCCCH.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 12 217 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1049 / 1176

Page 1050: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.261 (SGSN_IP_Address) - (SGSN_IP_Address)

HMI Name SGSN_IP_AddressParameter Name

Logical Name SGSN_IP_Address

Definition IP address of the SGSN used for Gb over IP

Coding rules coded on 32 bitsOMC must display the value of each octet followingthe format:www.xxx.yyy.zzzdefault value is 0.0.0.0

Mandatory rules Each SGSN IP EndPoint (SGSN_IP_Address, SGSN_UDP_Port)must be unique per NSE

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance SGSN-IPEndPoint

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 4294967295 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1050 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1051: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.262 (SGSN_UDP_Port) - (SGSN_UDP_Port)

HMI Name SGSN_UDP_PortParameter Name

Logical Name SGSN_UDP_Port

Definition UDP port number of the SGSN endpoint used for Gb over IP.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules Each SGSN IP EndPoint (SGSN_IP_Address, SGSN_UDP_Port)must be unique per NSE.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance SGSN-IPEndPoint

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 49152 65535 49152

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1051 / 1176

Page 1052: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.263 (SGSNR) - (SGSNR)

HMI Name SGSNRParameter Name

Logical Name SGSNR

Definition Year corresponding to the version of ETSI/3GPP recommendationsused to implement SGSN software.

Coding rules 0 = SGSN is release '98 or older; 1 = SGSN is release '99 onwards

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / Internetworking SGSN Internetworking

External Comment Any modification of the parameter leads the MFS to resetautonomously all the GPUs connected to this BSS.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1052 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1053: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.264 (SMS_PRIORITY) - (SMS_PRIORITY)

HMI Name SMS_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name SMS_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for the pre-defined "SMS" PFC.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1053 / 1176

Page 1054: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.265 (T stop frame relay emission) - (T_STOP_FR_EMISSION)

HMI Name T stop frame relay emissionParameter Name

Logical Name T_STOP_FR_EMISSION

Definition Timer used to trigger restart of emission on a PVC (Frame Relay).

Coding rules step size = 1 ms

Mandatory rules Not changeable after MFS system initialization.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance PVC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 10 5000 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access MFSUSM / GB Configuration / NSVC Creation

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1054 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1055: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.266 (T_AVG_T) - (T_AVG_T (BSC))

HMI Name T_AVG_TParameter Name

Logical Name T_AVG_T (BSC)

Definition Signal strength filter period for power control in packet transfer mode.

Coding rules binary coded on 5 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to T_AVG_T (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 25 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1055 / 1176

Page 1056: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.267 (T_AVG_T) - (T_AVG_T (MFS))

HMI Name T_AVG_TParameter Name

Logical Name T_AVG_T (MFS)

Definition Signal strength filter period for power control in packet transfer mode.

Coding rules binary coded on 5 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to T_AVG_T (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 25 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1056 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1057: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.268 (T_AVG_W) - (T_AVG_W (BSC))

HMI Name T_AVG_WParameter Name

Logical Name T_AVG_W (BSC)

Definition Signal strength filter period for power control in packet idle mode.

Coding rules binary coded on 5 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to T_AVG_W (MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 25 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1057 / 1176

Page 1058: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.269 (T_AVG_W) - (T_AVG_W (MFS))

HMI Name T_AVG_WParameter Name

Logical Name T_AVG_W (MFS)

Definition Signal strength filter period for power control in packet idle mode.

Coding rules binary coded on 5 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to T_AVG_W (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 25 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1058 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1059: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.270 (T_DELAYED_FINAL_PUAN) - (T_DELAYED_FINAL_PUAN)

HMI Name T_DELAYED_FINAL_PUANParameter Name

Logical Name T_DELAYED_FINAL_PUAN

Definition This timer defines the duration of the delay introduced by the BSSto send the final Packet UL Ack/Nack message when releasing anUL TBF.

Coding rules step size : 100 ms ; 0 = 0 msec, 1 = 100 msec, 2 = 200 msec, etc

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 0 2000 400

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment The feature "delayed emission of the final Packet UL Ack/Nack"can be inhibited by setting the value 0 to the parameterT_DELAYED_FINAL_PUAN. When the feature is enabled, the timerduration should be long enough to let the server send its responseto the uplink PDUs received from the MS, while remaining shortenough in order not to jeopardise the sending of further uplink PDUsby the MS.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1059 / 1176

Page 1060: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.271 (T_DL_GPRS_MeasReport) - (T_DL_GPRS_MeasReport)

HMI Name T_DL_GPRS_MeasReportParameter Name

Logical Name T_DL_GPRS_MeasReport

Definition Time period to request for a Packet Downlink Ack/Nack withmeasurements.

Coding rules step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 60 3000 400

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1060 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1061: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.272 (T_FLOW_CTRL_CELL) - (T_flow_ctrl_cell)

HMI Name T_FLOW_CTRL_CELLParameter Name

Logical Name T_flow_ctrl_cell

Definition Periodicity of emission of NM- FLOW-CONTROL-BVC message toSGSN.

Coding rules step size=1sec, 0 means infinite timer

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 10 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1061 / 1176

Page 1062: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.273 (T_FLOW_CTRL_MS) - (T_flow_ctrl_ms)

HMI Name T_FLOW_CTRL_MSParameter Name

Logical Name T_flow_ctrl_ms

Definition Periodicity of emission of NM- FLOW-CONTROL-MS messagetowards the SGSN for GPRS and EGPRS Mobile Stations.

Coding rules step size=1sec, 0 means infinite timer

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 250 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment 1) if T_Flow_Ctrl_MS is set to "0", then the MS flow controlmechanism is inhibited;2) if T_Flow_Ctrl_MS has a non-null value,then "C< T_flow_ctrl_ms < Th". The parameters C and Th aredefined in the 3GPP TS 08.18.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1062 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1063: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.274 (T_GCH_CORR) - (Tcorr)

HMI Name T_GCH_CORRParameter Name

Logical Name Tcorr

Definition Timer to supervise clock drift correction loop for 16k channel.

Coding rules step size=100ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules Tcorr > Trelease+240ms and Tcorr > Testab+240mswhere 240 msrepresents the maximum delay in MAC layer between the notificationfor a DBN correction and the application of this DBN correction.It isrecommended to set this parameter as follows depending whether ornot GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite links:- Tcorr= 0.8 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Abis and Ater terrestriallinks in the serving cell,- Tcorr = 1.4 s if GPRS traffic is carried eitherthrough Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links in the serving cell.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.5 2 0.8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment HMI name changed to precise that this timer is valid for GCHchannels. Former HMI name Tcorr.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1063 / 1176

Page 1064: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.275 (T_GCH_ESTAB) - (Testab)

HMI Name T_GCH_ESTABParameter Name

Logical Name Testab

Definition Supervision of loss of GCH link establishment for 16k channels.

Coding rules step size= 100 ms

Mandatory rules Treq_pending > Testab

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellitelinks:- Testab = 0.4 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Abis andAter terrestrial links in the serving cell,- Testab = 1 s if GPRS trafficis carried either through Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links inthe serving cell.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 2 0.4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment HMI name changed to precise that this timer is valid for GCHchannels. Former HMI name Testab.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1064 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1065: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.276 (T_GCH_INACTIVITY) - (T_GCH_INACTIVITY)

HMI Name T_GCH_INACTIVITYParameter Name

Logical Name T_GCH_INACTIVITY

Definition - For Non Evolium BTS : Timer to postpone the release of one slavePDCH, when it does not support any (E)GPRS traffic.- For EvoliumBTS : Timer to postpone the release of the "unused" GCHs of theM-EGCH link of a TRX (the condition for some GCHs of the M-EGCHlink of a TRX to become "unused" is that some TBFs established onthat TRX were released).

Coding rules step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules T_GCH_INACTIVITY > T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC in all thecells of the BSS.This constraints avoids as much as possible thatsome GCHs are released and reestablished again some momentslater. This way, the T3 and T4 TBF reallocations can benefit from theGCHs which are currently unused, but still established.If it is seenas an important goal to save Ater resources in the GPU, a value ofAter_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data < 100% is coherent with a lowvalue of the T_GCH_INACTIVITY and T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LASTtimers.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 100 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The setting of the T_GCH_INACTIVITY timer comes to makea trade-off between the GCH resource usage and the Telecomperformance:- The higher is the T_GCH_INACTIVITY timer, thehigher is the GCH resource usage on the Ater interface.- The higheris the T_GCH_INACTIVITY timer, the lower is the average durationof TBF establishments on (P)CCCH, especially if the GPRS traffic iscarried through satellite.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1065 / 1176

Page 1066: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.277 (T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST) - (T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST)

HMI Name T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LASTParameter Name

Logical Name T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST

Definition - Evolium BTS : Timer to postpone the release of the lastN_GCH_FAST_PS_ACCESS GCHs established in a cell, whenthe last TBF has been released in the cell. There is no more(E)GPRS traffic in the cell, but keeping some GCHs established willbe useful in case of (E)GPRS traffic resumption in the cell (e.g.WAP, WEB).- Non Evolium BTS : Timer to postpone the release ofthe last established slave PDCH of a cell, when it does not supportGPRS traffic anymore. There is no more GPRS traffic in the cell, butkeeping a PDCH established will be useful in case of GPRS trafficresumption in the cell.

Coding rules step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules If it is seen as an important goal to save Ater resources in theGPU, a value of Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data < 100%is coherent with a low value of the T_GCH_INACTIVITY andT_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST timers.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 200 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment That timer is relevant only if EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESSis disabled.The setting of the T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST timercomes to make a trade-off between the GCH resource usage and theTelecom performance:- The higher is the T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LASTtimer, the higher is the GCH resource usage on the Ater interface.-The higher is the T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST timer, the lower is theaverage duration of TBF establishments on (P)CCCH, especiallyif the GPRS traffic is carried through satellite links.This parametermay also be used to ensure that the BSS reserves at least oneGCH resource in the serving cell while the MS is engaged in a Webbrowsing session.

1066 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1067: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1067 / 1176

Page 1068: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.278 (T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL) - (T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL)

HMI Name T_MAX_EXTENDED_ULParameter Name

Logical Name T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL

Definition Maximum duration of the extended uplink TBF phase

Coding rules step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules T3192 + T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL + round_trip_delay < 5 sec

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellitelinks:- between 1 sec and 2 sec if GPRS traffic is carried through Abisand Ater terrestrial links,- between 1.5 sec and 2.5 sec if GPRS trafficis carried either through Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 100 4000 2000

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1068 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1069: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.279 (T_MAX_STREAMING_BUFFERING) -(T_MAX_STREAMING_BUFFERING)

HMI Name T_MAX_STREAMING_BUFFERINGParameter Name

Logical Name T_MAX_STREAMING_BUFFERING

Definition Time which multiplied by the GBR defines a buffer level above whichwe may consider the BSS failed to provide the GBR

Coding rules step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 8 100 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1069 / 1176

Page 1070: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.280 (T_NC_PING_PONG) - (T_NC_PING_PONG)

HMI Name T_NC_PING_PONGParameter Name

Logical Name T_NC_PING_PONG

Definition Time during which the ping-pong offset is applied.

Coding rules step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 0 20000 5000

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1070 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1071: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.281 (T_NC_REJ_CELL) - (T_NC_REJ_CELL)

HMI Name T_NC_REJ_CELLParameter Name

Logical Name T_NC_REJ_CELL

Definition Time during which a NC cell reselection is inhibited towards that celldue to a previous NC cell reselection failure on that cell.

Coding rules step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 0 20000 5000

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel. 1/2

External Comment -

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1071 / 1176

Page 1072: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.282 (T_NETWORK_RESPONSE_TIME) -(T_NETWORK_RESPONSE_TIME)

HMI Name T_NETWORK_RESPONSE_TIMEParameter Name

Logical Name T_NETWORK_RESPONSE_TIME

Definition Maximum expected response time of a network server as seen fromthe MFS.

Coding rules step size: 100 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 100 5000 1600

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / General

External Comment 1) The response time corresponds to T1 T2 where T2 correspondsto the time at which a command is sent to the SGSN and T1 the timeat which the response is received on the MFS side. This command/ response is e.g. the LLC PDU containing an FTP GET and thefirst LLC PDU starting the file transfer. It can also be the LLC PDUcontaining an HTTP GET and the first LLC PDU starting the pagedownload.2) The value of this timer defines the duration of theDelayed DL TBF Release procedure. In case the servers to whichthe GGSN serving the MFS is connected are not located at the sameplace, then the maximum server response time should be entered.However, note that the higher this timer is, the longer TBF releaseswill be delayed and therefore the more resources are used up.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1072 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1073: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.283 (T_PAG_PS) - (T_PAG_PS (BSC))

HMI Name T_PAG_PSParameter Name

Logical Name T_PAG_PS (BSC)

Definition This timer indicates the maximum time a PS PAGING message canremain in a Paging Group Queue. It includes the round-trip delayon Gb and A-bis interface.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules Equal to T_PAG_PS (MFS)

Recommended rules T_PAG_PS < T3313 (SGSN timer)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1073 / 1176

Page 1074: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.284 (T_PAG_PS) - (T_PAG_PS (MFS))

HMI Name T_PAG_PSParameter Name

Logical Name T_PAG_PS (MFS)

Definition This timer indicates the maximum time a PS PAGING message canremain in a Paging Group Queue. It includes the round-trip delayon Gb and A-bis interface.

Coding rules step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules Equal to T_PAG_PS (BSC)

Recommended rules T_PAG_PS < T3313 (SGSN timer)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1074 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1075: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.285 (T_PSI_PACCH) - (T_PSI_PACCH)

HMI Name T_PSI_PACCHParameter Name

Logical Name T_PSI_PACCH

Definition Scheduling period of PSI1, PSI13 or PSI14 on PACCH.

Coding rules step size =1sec, 00000 == Deactivated PSI scheduling on PACCH,00001 == 1s, 11110 == T_PSI_PACCH = 30 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 30 14

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit BSS / GPRS / General

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1075 / 1176

Page 1076: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.286 (T_RESEL) - (T_RESEL)

HMI Name T_RESELParameter Name

Logical Name T_RESEL

Definition Timer whose expiry allows a MS, which has performed an abnormalrelease with cell reselection, to reselect the previous cell.

Coding rules coded on 3 bits, 000= 5 sec, 001= 10 sec, 010 = 15 sec, 011 = 20sec, 100= 30 sec, 101 = 60 sec, 110 = 120 sec, 111 = 300 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 5 300 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1076 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1077: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.287 (T_ul_assign_PCCCH) - (T_ul_assign_pccch)

HMI Name T_ul_assign_PCCCHParameter Name

Logical Name T_ul_assign_pccch

Definition The duration between the reception of the (EGPRS) Packet ChannelRequest message and one uplink radio block allocated to the MS.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellitelinks:- T_ul_asssign_pccch = 0.4 s if GPRS traffic is carried throughAbis and Ater terrestrial links in the serving cell,- T_ul_assign_pccch= 0.7 s if GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis satellite links orAter satellite links in the serving cell.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0.1 0.7 0.4

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1077 / 1176

Page 1078: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.288 (T_UL_RLS_EUTM) - (T_UL_RLS_EUTM)

HMI Name T_UL_RLS_EUTMParameter Name

Logical Name T_UL_RLS_EUTM

Definition Waiting time between two successive polling request sent to a MSfor an UL TBF in EUTM mode when EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF isset ot 2 (IEUTM enabled).

Coding rules step size = 20ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 100 300 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment RLS = Radio Link Supervision

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1078 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1079: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.289 (T3168) - (T3168 (BSC))

HMI Name T3168Parameter Name

Logical Name T3168 (BSC)

Definition This timer defines the maximum time the MS waits for a packetUL assignment, after sending a Packet Resource Request (caseof two-phase UL TBF establishment) or after including a ChannelRequest Description Information Element in a Packet DownlinkAck/Nack (case of UL TBF establishment on a concurrent DL TBF).Broadcast in SI13 within the GPRS Cell Options IE.

Coding rules Coded on 3 bits as follows:001: 1000 ms010: 1500 ms011: 2000ms100: 2500 ms101: 3000 ms110: 3500 ms111: 4000 ms.

Mandatory rules Equal to T3168 (MFS)

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:-T3168 = 1 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater terrestrial links inthe serving cell,- T3168 = 1.5 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Atersatellite links in the serving cell.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 4 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment The setting of T3168 should leave sufficient time to the MFS forgranting PDCHs for serving the UL TBF request, plus also coverthe round trip time and the possible queuing delay within the MFSbefore the Packet Uplink Assignment can be sent to the MobileStation. Therefore a value of 500 ms is not allowed in this releaseof the Alcatel BSS.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1079 / 1176

Page 1080: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.290 (T3168) - (T3168 (MFS))

HMI Name T3168Parameter Name

Logical Name T3168 (MFS)

Definition This timer defines the maximum time the MS waits for a packetUL assignment, after sending a Packet Resource Request (caseof two-phase UL TBF establishment) or after including a ChannelRequest Description Information Element in a Packet DownlinkAck/Nack (case of UL TBF establishment on a concurrent DL TBF).Broadcast in PSI1 within the GPRS Cell Options IE.

Coding rules Coded on 3 bits as follows:001: 1000 ms010: 1500 ms011: 2000ms100: 2500 ms101: 3000 ms110: 3500 ms111: 4000 ms.

Mandatory rules Equal to T3168 (BSC)

Recommended rules It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:-T3168 = 1 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater terrestrial links,-T3168 = 1.5 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 1 4 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment The setting of T3168 should leave sufficient time to the MFS forgranting PDCHs for serving the UL TBF request, plus also coverthe round trip time and the possible queuing delay within the MFSbefore the Packet Uplink Assignment can be sent to the MobileStation. Therefore a value of 500 ms is not allowed in this releaseof the Alcatel BSS.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1080 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1081: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.291 (T3192) - (T3192 (BSC))

HMI Name T3192Parameter Name

Logical Name T3192 (BSC)

Definition Wait for release of the downlink TBF on MS side after reception ofthe final block by the MS.

Coding rules Coded on 3 bits as follows: 0 0 0: 500 msec0 0 1: 1000 msec0 10: 1500 msec1 1 1: 200 msec

Mandatory rules Equal to T3192 (MFS)T3192 + T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL +round_trip_delay < 5 sec

Recommended rules T3192>MS-BSS roundtrip delay + RRBP maximum duration (60ms)It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Atersatellite links:==> Case GPRS traffic is carried through Abis andAter terrestrial links in the serving cell:i) T3192 = 1000 ms if thenon-DRX mode is not activated and the delayed DL TBF releasemode is not activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX =0 and EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 0)ii) T3192 = 500 ms ifthe non-DRX mode is activated or the delayed DL TBF releasemode is activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX > 0 orEN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 1)iii) however, if T3192 is finally setto 200 msec, then :- some abnormal DL TBF release may occurduring the delayed phase, and - the MS may not receive the NC2deactivation order from the BSS, which may lead the MS to senduseless PMR before leaving its ready state.==> Case GPRS traffic iscarried either through Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links in theserving cell:i) T3192 = 1500 ms if the non-DRX mode is not activatedand the delayed DL TBF release mode is not activated in the cell (i.e.if DRX_TIMER_MAX = 0 and EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 0)ii)T3192 = 1000 ms if the non-DRX mode is activated or the delayed DLTBF release mode is activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX >0 or EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 1)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 200 1500 500

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1081 / 1176

Page 1082: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment The following values ofT3192 defined in the 3GPP TS 04.60 are notsupported in this release of the Alcatel BSS:0 1 1: 0 msec1 0 0: 80msec1 0 1: 120 msec1 1 0: 160 msec

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1082 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1083: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.292 (T3192) - (T3192 (MFS))

HMI Name T3192Parameter Name

Logical Name T3192 (MFS)

Definition Wait for release of the downlink TBF on MS side after reception ofthe final block by the MS.

Coding rules Coded on 3 bits as follows: 0 0 0: 500 msec0 0 1: 1000 msec0 10: 1500 msec1 1 1: 200 msec

Mandatory rules Equal to T3192 (BSC)T3192 + T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL +round_trip_delay < 5 sec

Recommended rules T3192>MS-BSS roundtrip delay + RRBP maximum duration (60ms)It is recommended to set this parameter as follows dependingwhether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Atersatellite links:==> Case GPRS traffic is carried through Abis andAter terrestrial links in the serving cell:i) T3192 = 1000 ms if thenon-DRX mode is not activated and the delayed DL TBF releasemode is not activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX =0 and EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 0)ii) T3192 = 500 ms ifthe non-DRX mode is activated or the delayed DL TBF releasemode is activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX > 0 orEN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 1)iii) however, if T3192 is finally setto 200 msec, then :- some abnormal DL TBF release may occurduring the delayed phase, and - the MS may not receive the NC2deactivation order from the BSS, which may lead the MS to senduseless PMR before leaving its ready state.==> Case GPRS traffic iscarried either through Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links in theserving cell:i) T3192 = 1500 ms if the non-DRX mode is not activatedand the delayed DL TBF release mode is not activated in the cell (i.e.if DRX_TIMER_MAX = 0 and EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 0)ii)T3192 = 1000 ms if the non-DRX mode is activated or the delayed DLTBF release mode is activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX >0 or EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 1)

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 200 1500 500

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1083 / 1176

Page 1084: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment The following values ofT3192 defined in the 3GPP TS 04.60 are notsupported in this release of the Alcatel BSS:0 1 1: 0 msec1 0 0: 80msec1 0 1: 120 msec1 1 0: 160 msec

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1084 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1085: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.293 (T3212) - (T3212 (MFS))

HMI Name T3212Parameter Name

Logical Name T3212 (MFS)

Definition This timer indicates to the MS the delay between two consecutivePeriodic Location Update procedures.

Coding rules 0: no periodic location update, coded on 8 bits

Mandatory rules Equal to T3212 (BSC)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

6 mn 0 255 30

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1085 / 1176

Page 1086: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.294 (TBF_CS_DL) - (TBF_CS_DL)

HMI Name TBF_CS_DLParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_CS_DL

Definition Threshold defining the number of consecutive PACKET DOWNLINKACK/NACK not received above which the Coding Scheme of a DLacknowledged or unacknowledged DL TBF is changed to CS-1.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 15 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment If the GPRS traffic is carried through Abis terrestrial link andAter terrestrial link, in case where N3105_LIMIT < TBF_CS_DLthen the loss of consecutive packet DL ACK/NACK will nottrigger link adaptation but TBF release.If the GPRS traffic iscarried through Abis satellitel link or Ater satellite link, in casewhere N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE < TBF_CS_DL then the loss ofconsecutive packet DL ACK/NACK will not trigger link adaptationbut TBF release.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1086 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1087: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.295 (TBF_CS_UL) - (TBF_CS_UL)

HMI Name TBF_CS_ULParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_CS_UL

Definition Threshold defining the maximum number of consecutive times thenetwork receives an invalid UL RLC data block or nothing fromthe MS having a monoslot GPRS TBF before changing the codingscheme to CS1. For a multislot GPRS TBF, TBF_CS_UL_limit :=TBF_CS_UL x n_allocated

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 64 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1087 / 1176

Page 1088: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.296 (TBF_CS3_BLER_PERIOD) - (TBF_CS3_BLER_PERIOD)

HMI Name TBF_CS3_BLER_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_CS3_BLER_PERIOD

Definition Defines the window size required to estimate the CS3 BLER. Thewindow size is expressed as a number of DL RLC data blocks.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 512 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1088 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1089: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.297 (TBF_CS4_BLER_PERIOD) - (TBF_CS4_BLER_PERIOD)

HMI Name TBF_CS4_BLER_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_CS4_BLER_PERIOD

Definition Defines the window size required to estimate the CS4 BLER. Thewindow size is expressed as a number of DL RLC data blocks.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 512 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1089 / 1176

Page 1090: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.298 (TBF_DL_INIT_CS) - (TBF_DL_INIT_CS)

HMI Name TBF_DL_INIT_CSParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_DL_INIT_CS

Definition Value of the downlink coding scheme when the link adaptationalgorithm is disabled or initial value of the coding scheme otherwise.

Coding rules 0 : CS1, 1 : CS2, 2 : CS3, 3 : CS4

Mandatory rules TBF_DL_INIT_CS <= MAX_GPRS_CS

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 4 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1090 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1091: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.299 (TBF_MCS_DL) - (TBF_MCS_DL)

HMI Name TBF_MCS_DLParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_MCS_DL

Definition Threshold defining the number of consecutive EGPRS PACKETDOWNLINK ACK/NACK not received above which the MCS of a DLacknowledged or unacknowledged DL TBF is changed to MCS-1.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 15 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / E-GPRS

External Comment If the EGPRS traffic is carried through Abis terrestrial link and Aterterrestrial link, in case where EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT < TBF_MCS_DLthen the loss of consecutive EGPRS Packet DL ACK/NACK willnot trigger link adaptation but TBF release.If the EGPRS traffic iscarried through Abis satellitel link or Ater satellite link, in case whereEGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE < TBF_MCS_DL then the lossof consecutive EGPRS Packet DL ACK/NACK will not trigger linkadaptation but TBF release.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1091 / 1176

Page 1092: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.300 (TBF_MCS_UL) - (TBF_MCS_UL)

HMI Name TBF_MCS_ULParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_MCS_UL

Definition Threshold defining the maximum number of consecutive times thenetwork receives an invalid UL RLC data block or nothing from theMS having a monoslot EGPRS TBF before changing the codingscheme to MCS1. For a multislot EGPRS TBF, TBF_MCS_UL_limit:= TBF_MCS_UL x n_allocated_timeslots.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 192 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / E-GPRS

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1092 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1093: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.301 (TBF_UL_INIT_CS) - (TBF_UL_INIT_CS)

HMI Name TBF_UL_INIT_CSParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_UL_INIT_CS

Definition Value of the uplink coding scheme when the link adaptation algorithmis disabled or initial value of the coding scheme otherwise.

Coding rules 0 : CS1, 1 : CS2, 2 : CS3, 3 : CS4

Mandatory rules TBF_UL_INIT_CS <= MAX_GPRS_CS

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 4 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment Exception cases apply for uplink TBF establishment on PACCH whenlink adaptation is enabled.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1093 / 1176

Page 1094: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.302 (THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING) - (THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING)

HMI Name THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKINGParameter Name

Logical Name THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING

Definition Threshold above which the load of the serving cell is considered in ahigh load situation in the NC2 cell ranking process

Coding rules Step size of 10%0 : 0%; 1: 10%; . 10 : 100%

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 100 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter is only relevant if the parameterNETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to "2: NC2 modeof operation for R99 onwards MS" or "3: NC2 mode of operationfor all MS".The serving cell is considered in a low load situationwhen THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING = 0 %. The value of 0 %deactivates the load evaluation in the serving cell.The load situationof external cells is unknown in the serving cell. The BSS thencomputes the NC2 load of those cells as follows:- If the thresholdTHR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING is set to a value lower than 100 %,then the cell is considered in a low load situation.- If the thresholdTHR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING is set to 100 %, then the cell isconsidered in an high load situation

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1094 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1095: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.303 (TOM8_PRIORITY) - (TOM8_PRIORITY)

HMI Name TOM8_PRIORITYParameter Name

Logical Name TOM8_PRIORITY

Definition Defines the relative priority used for the pre-defined TOM8 PacketFlow Context

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 4 15 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1095 / 1176

Page 1096: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.304 (TX_EFFICIENCY_ACK_THR) - (TX_EFFICIENCY_ACK_THR)

HMI Name TX_EFFICIENCY_ACK_THRParameter Name

Logical Name TX_EFFICIENCY_ACK_THR

Definition Threshold below which the TBF is released because of a badtransmission efficiency in acknowledged mode.

Coding rules step size = 1%

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Reselection 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1096 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1097: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.305 (TX_EFFICIENCY_NACK_THR) - (TX_EFFICIENCY_NACK_THR)

HMI Name TX_EFFICIENCY_NACK_THRParameter Name

Logical Name TX_EFFICIENCY_NACK_THR

Definition Threshold below which the TBF is released because of a badtransmission efficiency in unacknowledged mode.

Coding rules step size = 1%

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 15

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Reselection 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1097 / 1176

Page 1098: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.306 (TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD) - (TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD)

HMI Name TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD

Definition Number of received RLC data blocks for GPRS TBF after whichTX_EFFICIENCY is computed.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 500 200

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Reselection 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1098 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1099: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.307 (TX_INT) - (TX_INT)

HMI Name TX_INTParameter Name

Logical Name TX_INT

Definition Number of PRACH timeslots to spread transmission of PACKETCHANNEL REQUEST.

Coding rules Possible values are : 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20, 25,32, 50, coded from 0000 to 1111

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules It is recommended to set TX_INT so that the correspondingspreading time is about 240 ms.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 2 50 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1099 / 1176

Page 1100: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.308 (TX_INTEGER) - (Tx_integer (MFS))

HMI Name TX_INTEGERParameter Name

Logical Name Tx_integer (MFS)

Definition Number of RACH timeslots that spread transmission of CHANNELREQUEST.

Coding rules Possible values are:3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 14, 16, 20, 25, 32,50 respectively binary coded from 0000 to 1111

Mandatory rules Equal to Tx_Integer (BSC)

Recommended rules When the GPRS is supported through Abis or Ater terrestriallinks, it is recommended to set:TX_INTEGER = 32 if the CCCHis not combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 0TX_INTEGER = 12 if theCCCH is combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 1.When the GPRS issupported through Abis or Ater satellite links, it is recommended toset:TX_INTEGER = 32 whatever the configuration of the CCCH.Thenumber of slots belonging to the MSs RACH between 2 successiveChannel Request messages is a random value drawn randomlyfor each new retransmission with uniform distribution in the set(S, S+1, ...,S+T-1). With T = Tx_Integer and S depending on theCCCH configuration as shown below:1) for non combined CCCH:-Tx_Integer = 3, 8, 14, 50 –> S = 55 RACH frames (i.e. 253.8ms)- Tx_Integer = 4, 9, 16 –> S = 76 RACH frames (i.e. 349.6ms)- Tx_Integer = 5, 10, 20 –> S = 109 RACH frames (i.e. 501.4ms)- Tx_Integer = 6, 11, 25 –> S = 163 RACH frames (i.e. 749.8ms)Tx_Integer = 7, 12, 32 –> S = 217 RACH frames (i.e. 998.2 ms)2)for combined CCCH:- Tx_Integer = 3, 8, 14, 50 –> S = 41 RACHframes (i.e. 357.5 ms)- Tx_Integer = 4, 9, 16 –> S = 52 RACH frames(i.e. 453.4 ms)- Tx_Integer = 5, 10, 20 –> S = 58 RACH frames (i.e.505.7 ms)- Tx_Integer = 6, 11, 25 –> S = 86 RACH frames (i.e.749.9 ms)- Tx_Integer = 7, 12, 32 –> S = 115 RACH frames (i.e.1002.8 ms)Note: - In the non-combined CCCH configuration, thereare 51 RACH frames per 51-multiframe- In the combined CCCHconfiguration, there are 27 RACH frames per 51-multiframe.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 3 50 32

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

1100 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1101: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment When EN_GPRS=1, it is recommended to set: TX_INTEGER = 32 ifthe CCCH is not combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 0TX_INTEGER =12 if the CCCH is combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1101 / 1176

Page 1102: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.309 (Wait Indication for Packet Access Reject) - (WI_PR)

HMI Name Wait Indication for Packet Access RejectParameter Name

Logical Name WI_PR

Definition Wait indication used in PACKET ACCESS REJECT.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 255 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1102 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1103: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.310 (Weight_P10) - (Weight_P10)

HMI Name Weight_P10Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P10

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 10

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 6

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1103 / 1176

Page 1104: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.311 (Weight_P11) - (Weight_P11)

HMI Name Weight_P11Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P11

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 11

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 5

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1104 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1105: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.312 (Weight_P12) - (Weight_P12)

HMI Name Weight_P12Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P12

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 12

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 4

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1105 / 1176

Page 1106: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.313 (Weight_P13) - (Weight_P13)

HMI Name Weight_P13Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P13

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 13

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1106 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1107: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.314 (Weight_P14) - (Weight_P14)

HMI Name Weight_P14Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P14

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 14

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1107 / 1176

Page 1108: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.315 (Weight_P15) - (Weight_P15)

HMI Name Weight_P15Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P15

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 15

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1108 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1109: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.316 (Weight_P4) - (Weight_P4)

HMI Name Weight_P4Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P4

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 4

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 12

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1109 / 1176

Page 1110: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.317 (Weight_P5) - (Weight_P5)

HMI Name Weight_P5Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P5

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 5

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 11

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1110 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1111: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.318 (Weight_P6) - (Weight_P6)

HMI Name Weight_P6Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P6

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 6

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1111 / 1176

Page 1112: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.319 (Weight_P7) - (Weight_P7)

HMI Name Weight_P7Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P7

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 7

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 9

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1112 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1113: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.320 (Weight_P8) - (Weight_P8)

HMI Name Weight_P8Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P8

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 8

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1113 / 1176

Page 1114: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.321 (Weight_P9) - (Weight_P9)

HMI Name Weight_P9Parameter Name

Logical Name Weight_P9

Definition Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 9

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 15 7

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1114 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1115: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1115 / 1176

Page 1116: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.1 Network (CDE)

6.1.1 (EN_DL_RETRANS_BTS) - (EN_DL_RETRANS_BTS)

HMI Name EN_DL_RETRANS_BTSParameter Name

Logical Name EN_DL_RETRANS_BTS

Definition This flag enables / disables downlink retransmission in the BTS.

Coding rules 0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment DL retransmission in the BTS will be disabled by the MFS in thecells mapped to non Evolium BTSs or in cells having an Abis or anAter satellite link (whatever the TRE type G3 or G4). In a cell withterrestrial Abis and Ater links, this feature is disabled for G3 TREsonly.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1116 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1117: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.1.2 (MIN_THROUGHPUT_GAIN) - (MIN_THROUGHPUT_GAIN)

HMI Name MIN_THROUGHPUT_GAINParameter Name

Logical Name MIN_THROUGHPUT_GAIN

Definition Minimum throughput gain required to be provided to the MS whenperforming a T2 or T3 TBF reallocation.

Coding rules step size = 0,1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0,1 5 0,3

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Increasing the value of this parameter above 0,3 might block somereallocations for mobiles having a high multislot class (multislot class>= 30).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1117 / 1176

Page 1118: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.1.3 (N_GCH_FAST_PS_ACCESS) - (N_GCH_FAST_PS_ACCESS)

HMI Name N_GCH_FAST_PS_ACCESSParameter Name

Logical Name N_GCH_FAST_PS_ACCESS

Definition Two definitions are possible : - If EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS= "enabled" : number of GCHs required to beestablished due to the "Fast Initial PS Access" feature, - IfEN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = "disabled" : number of GCHsto keep established when there is no more (E)GPRS traffic in a cell(while the T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST timer is running). ThoseGCHs will be useful in case of (E)GPRS traffic resumption in the cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Network (CDE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance MFS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 5 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter is significant only for Evolium BTSs

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1118 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1119: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2 Site (CAE)

6.2.1 (ALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATION) -(ALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATION)

HMI Name ALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATIONParameter Name

Logical Name ALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATION

Definition Allows EDA operations for mobile stations in DTM mode.

Coding rules 0: the usage of EDA for mobile stations in DTM mode is not allowed,1:the usage of EDA for mobile stations in DTM mode is allowed.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This flag is relevant only if DTM and EDA are both activated.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1119 / 1176

Page 1120: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.2 (BEP_PERIOD) - (BEP_PERIOD)

HMI Name BEP_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name BEP_PERIOD

Definition Filter constant for EGPRS channel quality measurements.

Coding rules coded on 4 bits as follows:0: 11: 22: 33: 44: 55: 76: 107: 128: 159:2010: 2511: Reserved for future use12: Reserved for future use13:Reserved for future use14: Reserved for future use15: Reserved forfuture use

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 25 10

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment The BEP_PERIOD parameter defines the forgetting factor used inthe MEAN_BEP and CV_BEP averaging at the MS side.In case ofcell without frequency hopping and without "fast" mobiles (i.e. notmotorway or TGV coverage), it is advised to set a higher value (e.g.25) in order to avoid spurious MCS changes causing higher BLERand throughput loss.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1120 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1121: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.3 (E_TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD) - (E_TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD)

HMI Name E_TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIODParameter Name

Logical Name E_TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD

Definition Number of received radio blocks for an EGPRS TBF after whichE_TX_EFFICIENCY is computed.

Coding rules step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 500 200

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access Edit BSC / GPRS / E-GPRS

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1121 / 1176

Page 1122: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.4 (EDA_MS_ACTIVATION_LEVEL) - (EDA_MS_ACTIVATION_LEVEL)

HMI Name EDA_MS_ACTIVATION_LEVELParameter Name

Logical Name EDA_MS_ACTIVATION_LEVEL

Definition Activation level of Extended Dynamic Allocation (EDA).

Coding rules 0: EDA activated for all mobile stations (supporting the feature),1:EDA activated for R99-onwards mobile stations (supporting thefeature),2: EDA activated for Rel-4-onwards mobile stations(supporting the feature).

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 2 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment -This parameter is relevant only if EDA is activated (EN_EDAparameter).-The activation level may provide an artificial mean tolimit the inter-operability risks due to mobile stations with uncorrectEDA implementation (EDA is a R97 feature but has been completelyclarified in Rel-6). R99 is detected through the Revision LevelIndicator. A mobile station is assumed to be Rel-4-compliant ifit supports the GERAN Feature Package 1 (theoretically it is notpossible to precisely identify a Rel-4-compliant mobile station).

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1122 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1123: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.5 (EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT) - (EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT)

HMI Name EGPRS_N3105_LIMITParameter Name

Logical Name EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT

Definition For a DL EGPRS TBF, if the EGPRS traffic is carried through Abisterrestrial link and Ater terrestrial link, this parameter defines themaximum number of expected Packet Downlink ACK/NACK or PacketControl Acknowledgement messages consecutively lost on the radiointerface, before triggering an abnormal release of the DL TBF. Thisparameter is used in conjunction with the MIN_RLF_TIME_DL delayto decide if the DL TBF shall be released.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 32 20

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment If EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT < TBF_MCS_DL then the loss ofconsecutive packet DL ACK/NACK will not trigger link adaptation butTBF release. EGPRS_N3105_Limit has to be set in order not torelease a DL TBF in case of transient bad radio conditions.The pollingfrequency depends on Ack_factor, T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReport, MSmultislot class and on the number of TBFs per PDCH.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1123 / 1176

Page 1124: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.6 (EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE) -(EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE)

HMI Name EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITEParameter Name

Logical Name EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE

Definition For a DL EGPRS TBF, if the EGPRS traffic is carried through Abissatellite link or Ater satellite link, this parameter defines the maximumnumber of expected Packet Downlink ACK/NACK or Packet ControlAcknowledgement messages consecutively lost on the radiointerface, before triggering an abnormal release of the DL TBF. Thisparameter is used in conjunction with the MIN_RLF_TIME_DL delayto decide if the DL TBF shall be released.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 32 24

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access —

External Comment If EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE < TBF_MCS_DL then theloss of consecutive packet DL ACK/NACK will not trigger linkadaptation but TBF release. EGPRS_N3105_Limit_Satellite hasto be set in order not to release a DL TBF in case of transient badradio conditions.The polling frequency depends on Ack_factor,T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReport, MS multislot class and on the numberof TBFs per PDCH.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1124 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1125: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.7 (EN_EDA) - (EN_EDA)

HMI Name EN_EDAParameter Name

Logical Name EN_EDA

Definition Enables Extended Dynamic Allocation (EDA).

Coding rules 0: EDA not activated,1: EDA activated

Mandatory rules EN_EDA = 0 in case of not Evolium BTSEN_EDA = 0 in case ofextended cell

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment When EDA is activated, its activation domain isgiven by the EDA_MS_ACTIVATION_LEVEL andALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATION parameters.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1125 / 1176

Page 1126: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.8 (EN_IR_UL) - (EN_IR_UL_per_cell)

HMI Name EN_IR_ULParameter Name

Logical Name EN_IR_UL_per_cell

Definition Enables/Disables Incremental redundancy for the uplink TBF in theBSS.

Coding rules 0: Disable, 1: Enable

Mandatory rules Can be enabled only if BTS Generation = G4

Recommended rules Among the features Incremental Redundancy in uplink (EN_IR_UL)and RLC resegmentation in uplink (EN_RESEGMENTATION_UL),Alcatel recommends to enable first the Incremental Redundancy inUplink. The activation of both at the same time may reduce the gainof the Incremental Redundancy

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The Incremental Redundancy for the uplink TBF feature is supportedonly on G4 BTSs.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1126 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1127: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.9 (EN_MCS1_in_CRP) - (EN_MCS1_in_CRP)

HMI Name EN_MCS1_in_CRPParameter Name

Logical Name EN_MCS1_in_CRP

Definition Enables the forced usage of MCS-1 for uplink EGPRS TBF incontention resolution phase at one-phase access to make this phasemore robust.

Coding rules 0: the BSS does not force uplink EGPRS TBF to use MCS-1 duringthe contention resolution phase at one-phase access.1: the BSSforces uplink EGPRS TBF to use MCS-1 during the contentionresolution phase at one-phase access.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The forced usage of MCS-1 for uplink EGPRS TBF in contentionresolution phase at one-phase access corresponds to the behaviourin B9.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1127 / 1176

Page 1128: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.10 (EN_RESEGMENTATION_UL) -(EN_RESEGMENTATION_UL_per_cell)

HMI Name EN_RESEGMENTATION_ULParameter Name

Logical Name EN_RESEGMENTATION_UL_per_cell

Definition Enables/Disables the resegmentation for the uplink TBF in the cell, incase of RLC in acknowledged mode.

Coding rules 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules Among the features Incremental Redundancy in uplink (EN_IR_UL)and RLC resegmentation in uplink (EN_RESEGMENTATION_UL),Alcatel recommends to enable first the Incremental Redundancy inUplink. The activation of both at the same time may reduce the gainof the Incremental Redundancy

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1128 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1129: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.11 (N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU) - (N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU)

HMI Name N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPUParameter Name

Logical Name N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU

Definition Number of free 64k Ater TSs that are kept "in reserve" in order to beable to serve some prioritary requests in cells managed by the GPU.The prioritary requests are the GCH establishment requests launchedwhen the first TBF has to be established in a cell (useful to guaranteethat MM traffic will be supported in any cell at any time).Note : Incase of non-Evolium BTS, those are PDCHs that will be establishedinstead of GCHs.In case N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU = 0, then noAter margin is managed.In case N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU > 0,RRM will ensure that N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU 64k Ater TSs arealways free (i.e. not used by a GCH in the GPU). From then on, onlyprioritary requests will be allowed to establish some GCHs (EvoliumBTS) / PDCHs (non-Evolium BTS) with those Ater resources.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 10 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment - Increasing the value of N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU will makethe average number of unused Ater nibbles in the GPU increase.That corresponds to a loss of Ater resources on the field, as theon-going TBF traffic will never "benefit from the margin of Aterresources". But, on the other hand, the likelihood of not serving aprioritary request in the GPU will be become very low.- Decreasingthe value of N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU (to a non null value) willmake it possible that prioritary requests cannot be served in caseseveral such requests have to be served in a short period of time(i.e. before having had the time to "fill the Ater margin" up again),especially if the requests have to be served on several differentDSPs (one 64k Ater TS will be consumed by each DSP).- SettingN_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU to 0 will make it possible the caseswhere prioritary requests cannot be served at all.

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1129 / 1176

Page 1130: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1130 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1131: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.12 (N_UL_BIAS_FOR_EDA) - (N_UL_BIAS_FOR_EDA)

HMI Name N_UL_BIAS_FOR_EDAParameter Name

Logical Name N_UL_BIAS_FOR_EDA

Definition Minimum number of consecutive uplink bias observed during atransfer to allow a mobile station to use Extended Dynamic Allocation.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 64 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter can allow using EDA only in case of big UL transfers

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1131 / 1176

Page 1132: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.13 (T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReport) - (T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReport)

HMI Name T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReportParameter Name

Logical Name T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReport

Definition Time period to request for an EGPRS Packet Downlink Ack/Nackwith measurements.

Coding rules step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

ms 60 3000 200

Modifiable OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access ???

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1132 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1133: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.14 (TBF_DL_INIT_MCS) - (TBF_DL_INIT_MCS)

HMI Name TBF_DL_INIT_MCSParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_DL_INIT_MCS

Definition Value of the downlink modulation and coding scheme when the linkadaptation algorithm is disabled or initial value of the modulationand coding scheme otherwise.

Coding rules 0 : MCS-1 1 : MCS-2 2 : MCS-3 3 : MCS-4 4 : MCS-5 5 : MCS-6 6: MCS-7 7 : MCS-8 8 : MCS-9

Mandatory rules TBF_DL_INIT_MCS <= MAX_EGPRS_MCS

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 9 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment The parameter is significant only if EN_EGPRS is enabled

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1133 / 1176

Page 1134: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.15 (TBF_UL_INIT_MCS) - (TBF_UL_INIT_MCS)

HMI Name TBF_UL_INIT_MCSParameter Name

Logical Name TBF_UL_INIT_MCS

Definition Value of the uplink modulation and coding scheme when the linkadaptation algorithm is disabled or initial value of the modulationand coding scheme otherwise.

Coding rules 0 : MCS-1 1 : MCS-2 2 : MCS-3 3 : MCS-44 : MCS-55 : MCS-66 :MCS-77 : MCS-88 : MCS-9

Mandatory rules TBF_UL_INIT_MCS <= MAX_EGPRS_MCS

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 9 3

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment The parameter is significant only if EN_EGPRS is enabled. Exceptioncases apply for uplink TBF establishment on PACCH when linkadaptation is enabled.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1134 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1135: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

7 DTM Telecom Parameters

7 DTM Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1135 / 1176

Page 1136: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

7 DTM Telecom Parameters

7.1 Site (CAE)

7.1.1 (EN_DTM) - (EN_DTM)

HMI Name EN_DTMParameter Name

Logical Name EN_DTM

Definition Enables/disables the support of dual transfer mode

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules EN_DTM may be set to 1 only if :-The cell is mapped on an EvoliumBTS-CELL_RANGE = 0-MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD > 1

Recommended rules To get full benefit of DTM feature, a Gs interface shall be present,and Network_Operation_Mode shall be set to 1 (NMO 1). However,DTM is still possible with NMO2 or NMO3.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment ((E)GPRS is mandatory for DTM operation, and at least 2 PDCHsare required in the PS zone for allocation of DTM resources to (atleast) one DTM call, therefore, MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD shall atleast be equal to 2.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1136 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1137: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

7 DTM Telecom Parameters

7.1.2 (MAX_LAPDM) - (MAX_LAPDM)

HMI Name MAX_LAPDMParameter Name

Logical Name MAX_LAPDM

Definition Maximum number of LAPDm frames on which a layer 3 can besegmented into and be sent on the main DCCH.

Coding rules Coded on 3 bits:000 : 5001 : 6.111 : 12

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 5 12 7

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1137 / 1176

Page 1138: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

7 DTM Telecom Parameters

1138 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1139: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1139 / 1176

Page 1140: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.1 Network (CDE)

8.1.1 (CGI_3G_REQUIRED) - (CGI_3G_REQD)

HMI Name CGI_3G_REQUIREDParameter Name

Logical Name CGI_3G_REQD

Definition Controls format of 3G cell identifications sent to the MSC.

Coding rules 0: CGI not used, 1: CGI used

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules Alcatel recommend to set the CGI_3G_REQD parameter to 1provided that the MSC supports the CGI format. The CGI_3G_REQDparameter shall be set to 1 if the operator wants to allow inter-PLMN2G to 2G handovers. If this parameter needs to be changed, it isrecommended to change it during a migration phase to avoid anyadditional Telecom outage.

Category Network (CDE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Depends on MSC Type. The value indicated here is forimplementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1140 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1141: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2 Site (CAE)

8.2.1 (A_ECNO_HO) - (A_ECNO_HO)

HMI Name A_ECNO_HOParameter Name

Logical Name A_ECNO_HO

Definition Window size for Ec/No level averages for 2G to 3G handover

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

Samfr 1 31 8

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Single 8

Umbrella 8

Concentric 8

Concentric Umbrella 8

Microcell 4

Minicell 8

Extended inner cell 8

Cell Type Dependent

Extended outer cell 8

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1141 / 1176

Page 1142: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.2 (Cell Capacity Class) - (CELL_CAPACITY_CLASS)

HMI Name Cell Capacity ClassParameter Name

Logical Name CELL_CAPACITY_CLASS

Definition Capacity class of the cell, measured on a linear scale, ranging from 1to 100.

Coding rules binary value on 8 bits

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules the Cell Capacity Class shall follow the recommended rule: "In orderto fulfill the 3GPP requirement of having a linear scale in the capacityclass, ranging from 1 to 100:Cell Capacity Class is a linear functionof the Cell capacity: value 1 shall indicate the minimum capacityclass, and 100 shall indicate the maximum capacity class. Capacityclass should be measured on a linear scale.The default value of CellCapacity Class should depend on the number of available TCHs inthe cell and since there may be up to 126 TCH channels in one GSMcell:Cell_Capacity_Class = int{[(99/125) x (NTCH - 1)] + 1}whereNTCH is the number of all TCH channels in the Cell."

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 1 100 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1142 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1143: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.3 (CI_3G(n)) - (CI_3G(n))

HMI Name CI_3G(n)Parameter Name

Logical Name CI_3G(n)

Definition This parameter indicates the Cell Identifier of a 3G cell as definedin 3GPP TS 25.401

Coding rules Binary value on 16 bitsThe value of "-1" indicates that no cellidentifier is provided by the operator (the default value, indicatedhere, is for implementation purposes).

Mandatory rules MCC_3G(n), MNC_3G(n), RNC_ID(n) and CI_3G(n) shall togetheruniquely identify a 3G cellCI_3G(n) is a mandatory parameter (mustbe different from "-1")

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance 3G cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 65535 -1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The default value indicated here is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1143 / 1176

Page 1144: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.4 (EN_2G_3G_HO_NO_SERVICE_HO) -(EN_2G_3G_HO_NO_SERVICE_HO)

HMI Name EN_2G_3G_HO_NO_SERVICE_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_2G_3G_HO_NO_SERVICE_HO

Definition Allows handovers towards 3G cells for a given MS when I.E. ServiceHandover is missing and the load in the serving cell is high (seeTHR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REQ

Coding rules 0 : disable, 1 : enable

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1144 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1145: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.5 (EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION) -(EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION)

HMI Name EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTIONParameter Name

Logical Name EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION

Definition Enables/Disables the GSM to UTRAN FDD cell reselections anddefines the 3G search activation mode for MS in GMM Ready state.

Coding rules 0: Disabled1: Enabled with 3G search activated while the UE/MSis in GMM ready state,2: Enabled with 3G search deactivatedwhile the UE/MS is in GMM ready state.3: Enabled with 3Gsearch activated while the UE/MS is in GMM ready state, even ifNetwork_Control_Order > 1

Mandatory rules if EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION <> 0 andif EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION <>0, then EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION =EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION

Recommended rules The support of extended BCCH (parameter BCCH_EXT) is HIGHLYrecommended in cells having adjacent cells in several frequencybands and at least 18 adjacent frequencies within the sameband.Value 3 should be used only in case of good 3G FDD coverage.

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 3 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment If the NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to "NC2 mode ofoperation for R99 onwards MS" or "NC2 mode of operation for all MS",the 3G search is systematically deactivated when activating the NC2mode through the Packet Measurement Order [NC2] message. This3G search deactivation is then performed independently of the valueof the EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION parameter.Since thetotal number of ARFCN described in the BA list shall not exceed 32 inthe serving cell, the number of useful ARFCN (excluding the dummyARFCN) is limited to 32 1 = 31 if the Extended BCCH FrequencyList IE of the SI2ter message describes the dummy ARFCN. Thiscase occurs when there is no additional 2G frequency to encode inthe Extended BCCH Frequency List IE of the SI2ter message but theSI2ter message has to be present for 2G-to-3G cell reselections (fora serving cell handled by a Non Evolium serving cell)

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1145 / 1176

Page 1146: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1146 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1147: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.6 (EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION) -(EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION)

HMI Name EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTIONParameter Name

Logical Name EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION

Definition Enables/Disables the GSM to UTRAN TD-SCDMA cell reselectionsand defines the 3G search activation mode for MS in GMM Readystate.

Coding rules 0: Disabled1: Enabled with 3G search activated while the UE/MSis in GMM ready state,2: Enabled with 3G search deactivatedwhile the UE/MS is in GMM ready state.3: Enabled with 3Gsearch activated while the UE/MS is in GMM ready state, even ifNetwork_Control_Order > 1

Mandatory rules In front of non-Evolium cells, the parameter value shallbe forced to 0.if EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION<> 0 and if EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION<> 0, then EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION =EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION

Recommended rules The support of extended BCCH (parameter BCCH_EXT) is HIGHLYrecommended in cells

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 3 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment If EN_2G_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION < 3, and If theNETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to "NC2 mode of operationfor R99 onwards MS" or "NC2 mode of operation for Rel4 onwardsMS" or "NC2 mode of operation for all MS", the 3G search issystematically deactivated when activating the NC2 mode throughthe Packet Measurement Order [NC2] message. This 3G searchdeactivation is then performed independently of the value of theEN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION parameter.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1147 / 1176

Page 1148: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.7 (EN_3G_DIVERSITY(n)) - (EN_3G_DIVERSITY(n))

HMI Name EN_3G_DIVERSITY(n)Parameter Name

Logical Name EN_3G_DIVERSITY(n)

Definition This parameter indicates if diversity is applied for the cell

Coding rules 1 bit: 0 diversity is not applied, 1 diversity is applied

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance 3G cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1148 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1149: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.8 (EN_3G_HO) - (EN_3G_HO)

HMI Name EN_3G_HOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_3G_HO

Definition This flag enables/disables the 2G-3G handover

Coding rules 0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment 2G-3G Handover will be disabled by the BSS in cells mapped tonon Evolium BTSs

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1149 / 1176

Page 1150: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.9 (EN_COMPRESSED_INTER_RAT_INFO) -(EN_COMPRESSED_INTER_RAT_INFO)

HMI Name EN_COMPRESSED_INTER_RAT_INFOParameter Name

Logical Name EN_COMPRESSED_INTER_RAT_INFO

Definition Allows sending by the MS of Compressed Inter-RAT HO information

Coding rules 0 : disable, 1 : enable

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Shall be set to 1 only if all RNCs neighbour to this BSS support thefeature.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1150 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1151: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.10 (EN_CPICH_2G_3G_RESELECTION) -(EN_CPICH_2G_3G_RESELECTION)

HMI Name EN_CPICH_2G_3G_RESELECTIONParameter Name

Logical Name EN_CPICH_2G_3G_RESELECTION

Definition Defines the CPICH measurements used in the 2G to 3G cellreselection

Coding rules 0: Only 1 CPICH measurement is used1: CPICH Ec/No and RSCPmeasurements must be used

Mandatory rules This parameter can be set on 1 only if EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION <>0

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1151 / 1176

Page 1152: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.11 (EN_FAST_3G_RESELECTION) - (EN_FAST_3G_RESELECTION)

HMI Name EN_FAST_3G_RESELECTIONParameter Name

Logical Name EN_FAST_3G_RESELECTION

Definition Enables a fast 3G cell reselection at 2G CS call release.

Coding rules 0:fast 3G cell reselection at 2G CS call release is not used1:fast 3Gcell reselection at 2G CS call release is used

Mandatory rules This parameter can be set to 1 only ifEN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_ RESELECTION <>0 or ifEN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION <> 0

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Flag

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 1 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1152 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1153: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.12 (FDD_ARFCN) - (FDD_ARFCN(n))

HMI Name FDD_ARFCNParameter Name

Logical Name FDD_ARFCN(n)

Definition Downlink FDD UTRAN Absolute Radio Frequency Numbers(UARFCN)

Coding rules The value of "-1" indicates that no UARFCNis provided by theoperator (the default value, indicated here, is for implementationpurposes).

Mandatory rules For a given 2G cell, the maximum number of different FDD_ARFCN(n)among all 2G to 3G adjacencies for handover is 3 FDD_ARFCN(n) isa mandatory parameter (must be different from "-1")Only the followingdownlink UARFCN ranges are standardized: I) 10562-10838 and II)9662-9938 and III) 1162-1513 and IV) 1537-1738 andV) 4357-4458andVI) 4387-4413 andVII) 2237- 2563 andVIII) 2937-3088 andIX)9237-9387

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance 3G cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 16383 -1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The default value indicated here is for implementation purposes.TheFDD UTRAN frequencies are coded as the UTRAN Absolute RadioFrequency Numbers (UARFCN) on the Air interface.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1153 / 1176

Page 1154: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.13 (FDD_ARFCN_LIST) - (FDD_ARFCN_LIST(BSC))

HMI Name FDD_ARFCN_LISTParameter Name

Logical Name FDD_ARFCN_LIST(BSC)

Definition List of neighbour Downlink FDD UTRAN Absolute Radio FrequencyNumbers (UARFCN)

Coding rules The value of "-1" indicates that no UARFCN is provided.

Mandatory rules The defined frequencies (i.e. not set to -1) in the set shall be different.Only the following downlink UARFCN ranges are standardized:I) 10562-10838 and II) 9662-9938 and III) 1162-1513 and IV)1537-1738 andV) 4357-4458 andVI) 4387-4413 andVII) 2237- 2563andVIII) 2937-3088 andIX) 9237-9387

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type List of numbers

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 16383 -1

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access Edit BSC / UMTS

External Comment The FDD UTRAN frequencies are coded as the UTRAN AbsoluteRadio Frequency Numbers (UARFCN) on the Air interface.The FDDUARFCN of the 3G neighbour cells are broadcast on BCCH and onPBCCH if there is a PBCCH allocated in the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1154 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1155: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.14 (FDD_GPRS_Qoffset) - (FDD_GPRS_Qoffset)

HMI Name FDD_GPRS_QoffsetParameter Name

Logical Name FDD_GPRS_Qoffset

Definition Offset added to the received level average of the serving cell and ofthe neighbour GSM cells for UTRAN FDD cell re-selection in GPRS

Coding rules Coded value (binary): Value (dB): Text displayed at the OMC0: -32:Always select a 3G cell if possible1: -28: -28 dB2: -24: -24 dB3:-20: -20 dB4: -16: -16 dB5: -12: -12 dB6: -8: -8 dB7: -4: -4 dB8:0: 0 dB9: 4: 4 dB10: 8: 8 dB11: 12: 12 dB12: 16: 16 dB13: 20: 20dB14: 24: 24 dB15: 28: 28 dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -32 28 -32

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter is broadcast on PBCCH if there is a PBCCH allocatedin the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1155 / 1176

Page 1156: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.15 (FDD_MULTIRAT_REPORTING) - (FDD_MULTIRAT_REPORTING)

HMI Name FDD_MULTIRAT_REPORTINGParameter Name

Logical Name FDD_MULTIRAT_REPORTING

Definition Number of the strongest 3G cells to be reported by the MS in themeasurement report message

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 3 2

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter is broadcast on BCCH and on PBCCH if there is aPBCCH allocated in the serving cell.This parameter is meaningfulonly if EN_3G_HO is set to enabled. If disabled, this parameter isconsidered as equal to zero (the MS shall report only 2G cells).Thisparameter is also broadcast on SACCH.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1156 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1157: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.16 (FDD_Qmin) - (FDD_Qmin(BSC))

HMI Name FDD_QminParameter Name

Logical Name FDD_Qmin(BSC)

Definition Minimum threshold for Ec/Io for UTRAN FDD cell re-selection.

Coding rules 0 = -20 dB1 = -6 dB2 = -18 dB3 = -8dB4 = -16dB5 = -10dB6 =-14dB7 = -12dB

Mandatory rules Equal to FDD_Qmin(MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -20 -6 -12

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit cell / UMTS

External Comment This parameter is broadcast on BCCH and on PBCCH if there is aPBCCH allocated in the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1157 / 1176

Page 1158: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.17 (FDD_Qmin_Offset) - (FDD_Qmin_Offset)

HMI Name FDD_Qmin_OffsetParameter Name

Logical Name FDD_Qmin_Offset

Definition Applies an offset to FDD_Qmin value

Coding rules coded on 3 bits:0 = 0 dB, 1 = 2 dB, 2 = 4 dB, 3 = 6 dB, 4 = 8 dB, 5= 10 dB, 6 = 12 dB, 7 = 14 dB.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB 0 14 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Available only if EN_CPICH_2G_3G_Reselection = 1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1158 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1159: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.18 (FDD_Qoffset) - (FDD_Qoffset (BSC))

HMI Name FDD_QoffsetParameter Name

Logical Name FDD_Qoffset (BSC)

Definition Offset added to the received level average of the serving cell and ofthe neighbour GSM cells for UTRAN FDD cell re-selection.

Coding rules Coded value (binary): Value (dB): Text displayed at the OMC0: -32:Always select a 3G cell if possible1: -28: -28 dB2: -24: -24 dB3:-20: -20 dB4: -16: -16 dB5: -12: -12 dB6: -8: -8 dB7: -4: -4 dB8:0: 0 dB9: 4: 4 dB10: 8: 8 dB11: 12: 12 dB12: 16: 16 dB13: 20: 20dB14: 24: 24 dB15: 28: 28 dB

Mandatory rules Equal to FDD_Qoffset(MFS)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -32 28 -32

Modifiable OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access Edit cell / UMTS

External Comment This parameter is broadcast on BCCH and on PBCCH if there is aPBCCH allocated in the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1159 / 1176

Page 1160: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.19 (FDD_RSCPmin) - (FDD_RSCPmin)

HMI Name FDD_RSCPminParameter Name

Logical Name FDD_RSCPmin

Definition Minimum threshold of RSCP for UTRAN FDD cell re-selection.

Coding rules coded on 4bits:0 = -114 dBm, 1 = -112 dBm, 2 = -110 dBm, 3 = -108dBm, 4 = -106 dBm, 5 = -104 dBm, 6 = -102 dBm, 7 = -100 dBm, 8 =-98 dBm, 9 = -96 dBm, 10 = -94 dBm, 11 = -92 dBm, 12 = -90 dBm,13 = -88 dBm, 14 = -86 dBm, 15 = -84 dBm.

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -114 -84 -102

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Available only if EN_CPICH_2G_3G_Reselection=1

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1160 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1161: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.20 (LAC_3G(n)) - (LAC_3G(n))

HMI Name LAC_3G(n)Parameter Name

Logical Name LAC_3G(n)

Definition This parameter indicates the Location Area Code as defined in 3GPPTS 24.008. It is used in the HANDOVER COMMAND message

Coding rules binary value on 16 bitsThe value of "-1" indicates that no LAC isprovided by the operator (the default value, indicated here, is forimplementation purposes).

Mandatory rules LAC_3G(n) is a mandatory parameter (must be different from "-1")

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance 3G cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 65535 -1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The default value indicated here is for implementation purposes

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1161 / 1176

Page 1162: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.21 (Qsearch_C) - (Qsearch_C)

HMI Name Qsearch_CParameter Name

Logical Name Qsearch_C

Definition Threshold for searching for 3G cells in dedicated mode dependingwhether the received signal level of the serving cell is below or abovethe threshold.

Coding rules Coded value (binary): Value (dBm): Text displayed at the OMC0:-98: -98 dBm (below)1: -94: -94 dBm (below)2: -90: -90dBm(below)3: -86: -86dBm (below)4: -82: -82 dBm (below)5: -78: -78dBm (below)6: -74: -74 dBm (below)7: -70: Always search for 3Gneighbour cells8: -78: -78 dBm (above)9: -74: -74 dBm (above)10:-70: -70 dBm (above)11: -66: -66 dBm (above)12: -62: -62 dBm(above)13: -58: -58 dBm (above)14: -54: -54 dBm (above)15: -50:Never search for 3G neighbour cells

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In a cell where at least one 2G to 3G adjacency has been defined,Qsearch_C =-70, i.e. always search for 3G neighbour cells

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -98 -50 -70

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This threshold is used to search for 3G cells if the received signallevel is below (-98 dBm to "always search for 3G neighbour cells")or above (-78 dBm to "never search for neighbour cells") thethreshold.This parameter is broadcast on SACCH

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1162 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1163: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.22 (Qsearch_I) - (Qsearch_I)

HMI Name Qsearch_IParameter Name

Logical Name Qsearch_I

Definition Threshold for searching for 3G cells depending whether the receivedlevel average of the serving cell is below or above the threshold.

Coding rules Coded value (binary): Value (dBm): Text displayed at the OMC0:-98: -98 dBm (below)1: -94: -94 dBm (below)2: -90: -90dBm(below)3: -86: -86dBm (below)4: -82: -82 dBm (below)5: -78: -78dBm (below)6: -74: -74 dBm (below)7: -70: Always search for 3Gneighbour cells8: -78: -78 dBm (above)9: -74: -74 dBm (above)10:-70: -70 dBm (above)11: -66: -66 dBm (above)12: -62: -62 dBm(above)13: -58: -58 dBm (above)14: -54: -54 dBm (above)15: -50:Never search for 3G neighbour cells

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In a cell with FDD_ARFCN_list not empty, Qsearch_I =-70, i.e.always search for 3G neighbour cells

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -98 -50 -50

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This threshold is used to search for 3G cells if the received signallevel is below (-98 dBm to "always search for 3G neighbour cells")or above (-78 dBm to "never search for neighbour cells") thethreshold.This parameter is broadcast on BCCH

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1163 / 1176

Page 1164: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.23 (Qsearch_P) - (Qsearch_P)

HMI Name Qsearch_PParameter Name

Logical Name Qsearch_P

Definition Threshold for searching for 3G cells in GPRS depending whetherthe received level average of the serving cell is below or above thethreshold

Coding rules Coded value (binary): Value (dBm): Text displayed at the OMC0:-98: -98 dBm (below)1: -94: -94 dBm (below)2: -90: -90dBm(below)3: -86: -86dBm (below)4: -82: -82 dBm (below)5: -78: -78dBm (below)6: -74: -74 dBm (below)7: -70: Always search for 3Gneighbour cells8: -78: -78 dBm (above)9: -74: -74 dBm (above)10:-70: -70 dBm (above)11: -66: -66 dBm (above)12: -62: -62 dBm(above)13: -58: -58 dBm (above)14: -54: -54 dBm (above)15: -50:Never search for 3G neighbour cells

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules In a cell with FDD_ARFCN_list not empty, Qsearch_P =-70, i.e.always search for 3G neighbour cells

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -98 -50 -50

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This threshold is used to search for 3G cells if the received signallevel is below (-98 dBm to "always search for 3G neighbour cells") orabove (-78 dBm to "never search for neighbour cells") the thresholdin GPRS.This parameter is broadcast on BCCH and on PBCCH ifthere is a PBCCH allocated in the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1164 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1165: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.24 (Qsearch_P_PTM) - (Qsearch_P_PTM)

HMI Name Qsearch_P_PTMParameter Name

Logical Name Qsearch_P_PTM

Definition Threshold for searching for 3G cells in GPRS packet transfer modedepending whether the received level average of the serving cellis below or above the threshold

Coding rules Coded value (binary): Value (dBm): Text displayed at the OMC0:-98: -98 dBm (below)1: -94: -94 dBm (below)2: -90: -90dBm(below)3: -86: -86dBm (below)4: -82: -82 dBm (below)5: -78: -78dBm (below)6: -74: -74 dBm (below)7: -70: Always search for 3Gneighbour cells8: -78: -78 dBm (above)9: -74: -74 dBm (above)10:-70: -70 dBm (above)11: -66: -66 dBm (above)12: -62: -62 dBm(above)13: -58: -58 dBm (above)14: -54: -54 dBm (above)15: -50:Never search for 3G neighbour cells

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem MFS

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dBm -98 -50 -50

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This threshold is used to search for 3G cells if the received signallevel is below (-98 dBm to "always search for 3G neighbour cells") orabove (-78 dBm to "never search for neighbour cells") the thresholdin GPRS packet transfer mode.This parameter is sent in PacketMeasurement Order on PACCH.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1165 / 1176

Page 1166: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.25 (RNC_ID(n)) - (RNC_ID(n))

HMI Name RNC_ID(n)Parameter Name

Logical Name RNC_ID(n)

Definition This parameter indicates the RNC Identifier as defined in 3GPP TS25.401. It is used in HO Required message sent to the MSC.

Coding rules binary value on 12 bits.The value of "-1" indicates that no RNCid isprovided by the operator (the default value, indicated here, is forimplementation purposes).

Mandatory rules MCC_3G(n), MNC_3G(n), RNC_ID(n) and CI_3G(n) shall togetheruniquely identify a 3G cellRNC_ID(n) is a mandatory parameter(must be different from "-1")

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance 3G cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 4095 -1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The default value indicated here is for implementation purposes

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1166 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1167: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.26 (SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n)) - (SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n))

HMI Name SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n)Parameter Name

Logical Name SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n)

Definition This parameter indicates the Primary Scrambling Code as definedin 3GPP TS 25.213

Coding rules binary value on 9 bits.The value of "-1" indicates that no scramblingcode is provided by the operator (the default value, indicated here,is for implementation purposes).

Mandatory rules EN_3G_DIVERSITY(n) can be True only ifSCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n) <> "-1"SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n)is a mandatory parameter (must be different from "-1")In any servingcell there shall be only one 3G target cell defined with the coupleFDD_ARFCN(n) SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n)

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance 3G cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 0 511 -1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The default value indicated here is for implementation purposes

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1167 / 1176

Page 1168: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.27 (T3121) - (T3121)

HMI Name T3121Parameter Name

Logical Name T3121

Definition This timer is started by sending an INTER SYSTEM TO UTRANHANDOVER message to the MS and is normally stopped when theMS has correctly seized the UTRAN channel(s). Its purpose is tokeep the old channels sufficiently long for the MS to be able to returnto the old channels, and to release the channels if the MS is lost.

Coding rules step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Timer

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSC

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

sec 0 25.5 14

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1168 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1169: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.28 (TDD_FREQUENCY_LIST) - (TDD_ARFCN_LIST)

HMI Name TDD_FREQUENCY_LISTParameter Name

Logical Name TDD_ARFCN_LIST

Definition List of neighbour TDD UTRAN frequencies (TD-SCDMA)

Coding rules 0 = 0.0 MHz, 1 = 0.2 MHz, ... , 16383 = 3276.6 MHz. The value of"-1" indicates that no UTRAN TDD frequency is provided.

Mandatory rules The defined frequencies (i.e. not set to -1) in the set shall bedifferent.Only following frequency bands are standardised : a) 19001920 MHz (UL/DL), 2010 2025 MHz (UL/DL) b) 1850 1910 MHz(UL/DL), 1930 1990 MHz (UL/DL) c) 1910 1930 MHz (UL/DL).Bands b) and c) are defined only for ITU region 2 (Americas).

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type List of numbers

SubSystem BSC

Instance BSS

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

MHz 0 16383 -1

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment The TDD UTRAN frequencies are coded as the UTRAN AbsoluteRadio Frequency Numbers (ARFCN) on the Air interface.The TDDUTRAN frequencies of the 3G neighbour cells are broadcast onBCCH.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1169 / 1176

Page 1170: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.29 (TDD_Qoffset) - (TDD_Qoffset)

HMI Name TDD_QoffsetParameter Name

Logical Name TDD_Qoffset

Definition Offset added to the received level average of the serving cell and ofthe neighbour GSM cells for UTRAN TDD cell re-selection.

Coding rules Coded value (binary): Value (dB): Text displayed at the OMC0: -32:Always select a 3G cell if possible1: -28: -28 dB2: -24: -24 dB3:-20: -20 dB4: -16: -16 dB5: -12: -12 dB6: -8: -8 dB7: -4: -4 dB8:0: 0 dB9: 4: 4 dB10: 8: 8 dB11: 12: 12 dB12: 16: 16 dB13: 20: 20dB14: 24: 24 dB15: 28: 28 dB

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -32 28 -32

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment This parameter is broadcast on BCCH.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1170 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1171: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.30 (THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECT) -(THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECT)

HMI Name THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECTParameter Name

Logical Name THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECT

Definition Load threshold determining whether a 3G to 2G handover requestshall be rejected in load situation; the feature is deactivated by settingTHR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECT to its maximum value 100%.

Coding rules binary value on 8 bits

Mandatory rules THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECT shall be lower than the 2G loadthresholds HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD or equal to 100%.

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Number

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 100

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1171 / 1176

Page 1172: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.31 (THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REQ) - (THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REQ)

HMI Name THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REQParameter Name

Logical Name THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REQ

Definition Load threshold on the serving cell below which handovers towards3G cells are forbidden when I.E. Service Handover is missing(whatever EN_2G_3G_HO_NO_SERVICE_HO value)

Coding rules Step size = 1

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

% 0 100 0

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Value 0 disables the feature.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1172 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1173: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.32 (THR_ECNO_HO) - (THR_ECNO_HO)

HMI Name THR_ECNO_HOParameter Name

Logical Name THR_ECNO_HO

Definition Ec/No threshold above which a handover to UTRAN may be triggered

Coding rules step size = 0.5 dB, coded over 6 bits0: "HO to 3G attempted whateverthe Ec/No", 1: -24.0,2: -23.5,3: -23, ...,48: -0.5,49: 0.0

Mandatory rules –

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Threshold

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

dB -24.5 0 -15

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment –

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1173 / 1176

Page 1174: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

1174 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08

Page 1175: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

9 – Telecom Parameters

9 – Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08 1175 / 1176

Page 1176: ALUMS PARAMETER DICTIONARY_telecomb10

9 – Telecom Parameters

9.1 Site (CAE)

9.1.1 (LAC) - (LAC(n)(BSC))

HMI Name LACParameter Name

Logical Name LAC(n)(BSC)

Definition Location Area Code of adjacent cell.

Coding rules –

Mandatory rules LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual toLAC(n)(MFS)A couple of mate extended cells (Extended inner +extended outer) shall have the same

Recommended rules –

Category Site (CAE)

Type Reference

SubSystem BSC

Instance cell

Unit Minimum Maximum DefaultValue

None 1 65535 65535

Modifiable OMC Changes: – RNO Changes: –

Parameter Access –

External Comment Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated hereis for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent No

Nb of TRX Dependent No

1176 / 1176 3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.08